gdb: add type::num_fields / type::set_num_fields
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / ada-lang.c
1 /* Ada language support routines for GDB, the GNU debugger.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1992-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GDB.
6
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
19
20
21 #include "defs.h"
22 #include <ctype.h>
23 #include "gdb_regex.h"
24 #include "frame.h"
25 #include "symtab.h"
26 #include "gdbtypes.h"
27 #include "gdbcmd.h"
28 #include "expression.h"
29 #include "parser-defs.h"
30 #include "language.h"
31 #include "varobj.h"
32 #include "inferior.h"
33 #include "symfile.h"
34 #include "objfiles.h"
35 #include "breakpoint.h"
36 #include "gdbcore.h"
37 #include "hashtab.h"
38 #include "gdb_obstack.h"
39 #include "ada-lang.h"
40 #include "completer.h"
41 #include "ui-out.h"
42 #include "block.h"
43 #include "infcall.h"
44 #include "annotate.h"
45 #include "valprint.h"
46 #include "source.h"
47 #include "observable.h"
48 #include "stack.h"
49 #include "typeprint.h"
50 #include "namespace.h"
51 #include "cli/cli-style.h"
52
53 #include "value.h"
54 #include "mi/mi-common.h"
55 #include "arch-utils.h"
56 #include "cli/cli-utils.h"
57 #include "gdbsupport/function-view.h"
58 #include "gdbsupport/byte-vector.h"
59 #include <algorithm>
60
61 /* Define whether or not the C operator '/' truncates towards zero for
62 differently signed operands (truncation direction is undefined in C).
63 Copied from valarith.c. */
64
65 #ifndef TRUNCATION_TOWARDS_ZERO
66 #define TRUNCATION_TOWARDS_ZERO ((-5 / 2) == -2)
67 #endif
68
69 static struct type *desc_base_type (struct type *);
70
71 static struct type *desc_bounds_type (struct type *);
72
73 static struct value *desc_bounds (struct value *);
74
75 static int fat_pntr_bounds_bitpos (struct type *);
76
77 static int fat_pntr_bounds_bitsize (struct type *);
78
79 static struct type *desc_data_target_type (struct type *);
80
81 static struct value *desc_data (struct value *);
82
83 static int fat_pntr_data_bitpos (struct type *);
84
85 static int fat_pntr_data_bitsize (struct type *);
86
87 static struct value *desc_one_bound (struct value *, int, int);
88
89 static int desc_bound_bitpos (struct type *, int, int);
90
91 static int desc_bound_bitsize (struct type *, int, int);
92
93 static struct type *desc_index_type (struct type *, int);
94
95 static int desc_arity (struct type *);
96
97 static int ada_type_match (struct type *, struct type *, int);
98
99 static int ada_args_match (struct symbol *, struct value **, int);
100
101 static struct value *make_array_descriptor (struct type *, struct value *);
102
103 static void ada_add_block_symbols (struct obstack *,
104 const struct block *,
105 const lookup_name_info &lookup_name,
106 domain_enum, struct objfile *);
107
108 static void ada_add_all_symbols (struct obstack *, const struct block *,
109 const lookup_name_info &lookup_name,
110 domain_enum, int, int *);
111
112 static int is_nonfunction (struct block_symbol *, int);
113
114 static void add_defn_to_vec (struct obstack *, struct symbol *,
115 const struct block *);
116
117 static int num_defns_collected (struct obstack *);
118
119 static struct block_symbol *defns_collected (struct obstack *, int);
120
121 static struct value *resolve_subexp (expression_up *, int *, int,
122 struct type *, int,
123 innermost_block_tracker *);
124
125 static void replace_operator_with_call (expression_up *, int, int, int,
126 struct symbol *, const struct block *);
127
128 static int possible_user_operator_p (enum exp_opcode, struct value **);
129
130 static const char *ada_op_name (enum exp_opcode);
131
132 static const char *ada_decoded_op_name (enum exp_opcode);
133
134 static int numeric_type_p (struct type *);
135
136 static int integer_type_p (struct type *);
137
138 static int scalar_type_p (struct type *);
139
140 static int discrete_type_p (struct type *);
141
142 static struct type *ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (struct type *, const char *,
143 int, int);
144
145 static struct value *evaluate_subexp_type (struct expression *, int *);
146
147 static struct type *ada_find_parallel_type_with_name (struct type *,
148 const char *);
149
150 static int is_dynamic_field (struct type *, int);
151
152 static struct type *to_fixed_variant_branch_type (struct type *,
153 const gdb_byte *,
154 CORE_ADDR, struct value *);
155
156 static struct type *to_fixed_array_type (struct type *, struct value *, int);
157
158 static struct type *to_fixed_range_type (struct type *, struct value *);
159
160 static struct type *to_static_fixed_type (struct type *);
161 static struct type *static_unwrap_type (struct type *type);
162
163 static struct value *unwrap_value (struct value *);
164
165 static struct type *constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *, long *);
166
167 static struct type *decode_constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *);
168
169 static long decode_packed_array_bitsize (struct type *);
170
171 static struct value *decode_constrained_packed_array (struct value *);
172
173 static int ada_is_packed_array_type (struct type *);
174
175 static int ada_is_unconstrained_packed_array_type (struct type *);
176
177 static struct value *value_subscript_packed (struct value *, int,
178 struct value **);
179
180 static struct value *coerce_unspec_val_to_type (struct value *,
181 struct type *);
182
183 static int lesseq_defined_than (struct symbol *, struct symbol *);
184
185 static int equiv_types (struct type *, struct type *);
186
187 static int is_name_suffix (const char *);
188
189 static int advance_wild_match (const char **, const char *, int);
190
191 static bool wild_match (const char *name, const char *patn);
192
193 static struct value *ada_coerce_ref (struct value *);
194
195 static LONGEST pos_atr (struct value *);
196
197 static struct value *value_pos_atr (struct type *, struct value *);
198
199 static struct value *value_val_atr (struct type *, struct value *);
200
201 static struct symbol *standard_lookup (const char *, const struct block *,
202 domain_enum);
203
204 static struct value *ada_search_struct_field (const char *, struct value *, int,
205 struct type *);
206
207 static int find_struct_field (const char *, struct type *, int,
208 struct type **, int *, int *, int *, int *);
209
210 static int ada_resolve_function (struct block_symbol *, int,
211 struct value **, int, const char *,
212 struct type *, int);
213
214 static int ada_is_direct_array_type (struct type *);
215
216 static void ada_language_arch_info (struct gdbarch *,
217 struct language_arch_info *);
218
219 static struct value *ada_index_struct_field (int, struct value *, int,
220 struct type *);
221
222 static struct value *assign_aggregate (struct value *, struct value *,
223 struct expression *,
224 int *, enum noside);
225
226 static void aggregate_assign_from_choices (struct value *, struct value *,
227 struct expression *,
228 int *, LONGEST *, int *,
229 int, LONGEST, LONGEST);
230
231 static void aggregate_assign_positional (struct value *, struct value *,
232 struct expression *,
233 int *, LONGEST *, int *, int,
234 LONGEST, LONGEST);
235
236
237 static void aggregate_assign_others (struct value *, struct value *,
238 struct expression *,
239 int *, LONGEST *, int, LONGEST, LONGEST);
240
241
242 static void add_component_interval (LONGEST, LONGEST, LONGEST *, int *, int);
243
244
245 static struct value *ada_evaluate_subexp (struct type *, struct expression *,
246 int *, enum noside);
247
248 static void ada_forward_operator_length (struct expression *, int, int *,
249 int *);
250
251 static struct type *ada_find_any_type (const char *name);
252
253 static symbol_name_matcher_ftype *ada_get_symbol_name_matcher
254 (const lookup_name_info &lookup_name);
255
256 \f
257
258 /* The result of a symbol lookup to be stored in our symbol cache. */
259
260 struct cache_entry
261 {
262 /* The name used to perform the lookup. */
263 const char *name;
264 /* The namespace used during the lookup. */
265 domain_enum domain;
266 /* The symbol returned by the lookup, or NULL if no matching symbol
267 was found. */
268 struct symbol *sym;
269 /* The block where the symbol was found, or NULL if no matching
270 symbol was found. */
271 const struct block *block;
272 /* A pointer to the next entry with the same hash. */
273 struct cache_entry *next;
274 };
275
276 /* The Ada symbol cache, used to store the result of Ada-mode symbol
277 lookups in the course of executing the user's commands.
278
279 The cache is implemented using a simple, fixed-sized hash.
280 The size is fixed on the grounds that there are not likely to be
281 all that many symbols looked up during any given session, regardless
282 of the size of the symbol table. If we decide to go to a resizable
283 table, let's just use the stuff from libiberty instead. */
284
285 #define HASH_SIZE 1009
286
287 struct ada_symbol_cache
288 {
289 /* An obstack used to store the entries in our cache. */
290 struct obstack cache_space;
291
292 /* The root of the hash table used to implement our symbol cache. */
293 struct cache_entry *root[HASH_SIZE];
294 };
295
296 static void ada_free_symbol_cache (struct ada_symbol_cache *sym_cache);
297
298 /* Maximum-sized dynamic type. */
299 static unsigned int varsize_limit;
300
301 static const char ada_completer_word_break_characters[] =
302 #ifdef VMS
303 " \t\n!@#%^&*()+=|~`}{[]\";:?/,-";
304 #else
305 " \t\n!@#$%^&*()+=|~`}{[]\";:?/,-";
306 #endif
307
308 /* The name of the symbol to use to get the name of the main subprogram. */
309 static const char ADA_MAIN_PROGRAM_SYMBOL_NAME[]
310 = "__gnat_ada_main_program_name";
311
312 /* Limit on the number of warnings to raise per expression evaluation. */
313 static int warning_limit = 2;
314
315 /* Number of warning messages issued; reset to 0 by cleanups after
316 expression evaluation. */
317 static int warnings_issued = 0;
318
319 static const char *known_runtime_file_name_patterns[] = {
320 ADA_KNOWN_RUNTIME_FILE_NAME_PATTERNS NULL
321 };
322
323 static const char *known_auxiliary_function_name_patterns[] = {
324 ADA_KNOWN_AUXILIARY_FUNCTION_NAME_PATTERNS NULL
325 };
326
327 /* Maintenance-related settings for this module. */
328
329 static struct cmd_list_element *maint_set_ada_cmdlist;
330 static struct cmd_list_element *maint_show_ada_cmdlist;
331
332 /* The "maintenance ada set/show ignore-descriptive-type" value. */
333
334 static bool ada_ignore_descriptive_types_p = false;
335
336 /* Inferior-specific data. */
337
338 /* Per-inferior data for this module. */
339
340 struct ada_inferior_data
341 {
342 /* The ada__tags__type_specific_data type, which is used when decoding
343 tagged types. With older versions of GNAT, this type was directly
344 accessible through a component ("tsd") in the object tag. But this
345 is no longer the case, so we cache it for each inferior. */
346 struct type *tsd_type = nullptr;
347
348 /* The exception_support_info data. This data is used to determine
349 how to implement support for Ada exception catchpoints in a given
350 inferior. */
351 const struct exception_support_info *exception_info = nullptr;
352 };
353
354 /* Our key to this module's inferior data. */
355 static const struct inferior_key<ada_inferior_data> ada_inferior_data;
356
357 /* Return our inferior data for the given inferior (INF).
358
359 This function always returns a valid pointer to an allocated
360 ada_inferior_data structure. If INF's inferior data has not
361 been previously set, this functions creates a new one with all
362 fields set to zero, sets INF's inferior to it, and then returns
363 a pointer to that newly allocated ada_inferior_data. */
364
365 static struct ada_inferior_data *
366 get_ada_inferior_data (struct inferior *inf)
367 {
368 struct ada_inferior_data *data;
369
370 data = ada_inferior_data.get (inf);
371 if (data == NULL)
372 data = ada_inferior_data.emplace (inf);
373
374 return data;
375 }
376
377 /* Perform all necessary cleanups regarding our module's inferior data
378 that is required after the inferior INF just exited. */
379
380 static void
381 ada_inferior_exit (struct inferior *inf)
382 {
383 ada_inferior_data.clear (inf);
384 }
385
386
387 /* program-space-specific data. */
388
389 /* This module's per-program-space data. */
390 struct ada_pspace_data
391 {
392 ~ada_pspace_data ()
393 {
394 if (sym_cache != NULL)
395 ada_free_symbol_cache (sym_cache);
396 }
397
398 /* The Ada symbol cache. */
399 struct ada_symbol_cache *sym_cache = nullptr;
400 };
401
402 /* Key to our per-program-space data. */
403 static const struct program_space_key<ada_pspace_data> ada_pspace_data_handle;
404
405 /* Return this module's data for the given program space (PSPACE).
406 If not is found, add a zero'ed one now.
407
408 This function always returns a valid object. */
409
410 static struct ada_pspace_data *
411 get_ada_pspace_data (struct program_space *pspace)
412 {
413 struct ada_pspace_data *data;
414
415 data = ada_pspace_data_handle.get (pspace);
416 if (data == NULL)
417 data = ada_pspace_data_handle.emplace (pspace);
418
419 return data;
420 }
421
422 /* Utilities */
423
424 /* If TYPE is a TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF type, return the target type after
425 all typedef layers have been peeled. Otherwise, return TYPE.
426
427 Normally, we really expect a typedef type to only have 1 typedef layer.
428 In other words, we really expect the target type of a typedef type to be
429 a non-typedef type. This is particularly true for Ada units, because
430 the language does not have a typedef vs not-typedef distinction.
431 In that respect, the Ada compiler has been trying to eliminate as many
432 typedef definitions in the debugging information, since they generally
433 do not bring any extra information (we still use typedef under certain
434 circumstances related mostly to the GNAT encoding).
435
436 Unfortunately, we have seen situations where the debugging information
437 generated by the compiler leads to such multiple typedef layers. For
438 instance, consider the following example with stabs:
439
440 .stabs "pck__float_array___XUP:Tt(0,46)=s16P_ARRAY:(0,47)=[...]"[...]
441 .stabs "pck__float_array___XUP:t(0,36)=(0,46)",128,0,6,0
442
443 This is an error in the debugging information which causes type
444 pck__float_array___XUP to be defined twice, and the second time,
445 it is defined as a typedef of a typedef.
446
447 This is on the fringe of legality as far as debugging information is
448 concerned, and certainly unexpected. But it is easy to handle these
449 situations correctly, so we can afford to be lenient in this case. */
450
451 static struct type *
452 ada_typedef_target_type (struct type *type)
453 {
454 while (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
455 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
456 return type;
457 }
458
459 /* Given DECODED_NAME a string holding a symbol name in its
460 decoded form (ie using the Ada dotted notation), returns
461 its unqualified name. */
462
463 static const char *
464 ada_unqualified_name (const char *decoded_name)
465 {
466 const char *result;
467
468 /* If the decoded name starts with '<', it means that the encoded
469 name does not follow standard naming conventions, and thus that
470 it is not your typical Ada symbol name. Trying to unqualify it
471 is therefore pointless and possibly erroneous. */
472 if (decoded_name[0] == '<')
473 return decoded_name;
474
475 result = strrchr (decoded_name, '.');
476 if (result != NULL)
477 result++; /* Skip the dot... */
478 else
479 result = decoded_name;
480
481 return result;
482 }
483
484 /* Return a string starting with '<', followed by STR, and '>'. */
485
486 static std::string
487 add_angle_brackets (const char *str)
488 {
489 return string_printf ("<%s>", str);
490 }
491
492 static const char *
493 ada_get_gdb_completer_word_break_characters (void)
494 {
495 return ada_completer_word_break_characters;
496 }
497
498 /* Print an array element index using the Ada syntax. */
499
500 static void
501 ada_print_array_index (struct value *index_value, struct ui_file *stream,
502 const struct value_print_options *options)
503 {
504 LA_VALUE_PRINT (index_value, stream, options);
505 fprintf_filtered (stream, " => ");
506 }
507
508 /* la_watch_location_expression for Ada. */
509
510 static gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char>
511 ada_watch_location_expression (struct type *type, CORE_ADDR addr)
512 {
513 type = check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (check_typedef (type)));
514 std::string name = type_to_string (type);
515 return gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char>
516 (xstrprintf ("{%s} %s", name.c_str (), core_addr_to_string (addr)));
517 }
518
519 /* Assuming V points to an array of S objects, make sure that it contains at
520 least M objects, updating V and S as necessary. */
521
522 #define GROW_VECT(v, s, m) \
523 if ((s) < (m)) (v) = (char *) grow_vect (v, &(s), m, sizeof *(v));
524
525 /* Assuming VECT points to an array of *SIZE objects of size
526 ELEMENT_SIZE, grow it to contain at least MIN_SIZE objects,
527 updating *SIZE as necessary and returning the (new) array. */
528
529 static void *
530 grow_vect (void *vect, size_t *size, size_t min_size, int element_size)
531 {
532 if (*size < min_size)
533 {
534 *size *= 2;
535 if (*size < min_size)
536 *size = min_size;
537 vect = xrealloc (vect, *size * element_size);
538 }
539 return vect;
540 }
541
542 /* True (non-zero) iff TARGET matches FIELD_NAME up to any trailing
543 suffix of FIELD_NAME beginning "___". */
544
545 static int
546 field_name_match (const char *field_name, const char *target)
547 {
548 int len = strlen (target);
549
550 return
551 (strncmp (field_name, target, len) == 0
552 && (field_name[len] == '\0'
553 || (startswith (field_name + len, "___")
554 && strcmp (field_name + strlen (field_name) - 6,
555 "___XVN") != 0)));
556 }
557
558
559 /* Assuming TYPE is a TYPE_CODE_STRUCT or a TYPE_CODE_TYPDEF to
560 a TYPE_CODE_STRUCT, find the field whose name matches FIELD_NAME,
561 and return its index. This function also handles fields whose name
562 have ___ suffixes because the compiler sometimes alters their name
563 by adding such a suffix to represent fields with certain constraints.
564 If the field could not be found, return a negative number if
565 MAYBE_MISSING is set. Otherwise raise an error. */
566
567 int
568 ada_get_field_index (const struct type *type, const char *field_name,
569 int maybe_missing)
570 {
571 int fieldno;
572 struct type *struct_type = check_typedef ((struct type *) type);
573
574 for (fieldno = 0; fieldno < TYPE_NFIELDS (struct_type); fieldno++)
575 if (field_name_match (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (struct_type, fieldno), field_name))
576 return fieldno;
577
578 if (!maybe_missing)
579 error (_("Unable to find field %s in struct %s. Aborting"),
580 field_name, struct_type->name ());
581
582 return -1;
583 }
584
585 /* The length of the prefix of NAME prior to any "___" suffix. */
586
587 int
588 ada_name_prefix_len (const char *name)
589 {
590 if (name == NULL)
591 return 0;
592 else
593 {
594 const char *p = strstr (name, "___");
595
596 if (p == NULL)
597 return strlen (name);
598 else
599 return p - name;
600 }
601 }
602
603 /* Return non-zero if SUFFIX is a suffix of STR.
604 Return zero if STR is null. */
605
606 static int
607 is_suffix (const char *str, const char *suffix)
608 {
609 int len1, len2;
610
611 if (str == NULL)
612 return 0;
613 len1 = strlen (str);
614 len2 = strlen (suffix);
615 return (len1 >= len2 && strcmp (str + len1 - len2, suffix) == 0);
616 }
617
618 /* The contents of value VAL, treated as a value of type TYPE. The
619 result is an lval in memory if VAL is. */
620
621 static struct value *
622 coerce_unspec_val_to_type (struct value *val, struct type *type)
623 {
624 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
625 if (value_type (val) == type)
626 return val;
627 else
628 {
629 struct value *result;
630
631 /* Make sure that the object size is not unreasonable before
632 trying to allocate some memory for it. */
633 ada_ensure_varsize_limit (type);
634
635 if (value_lazy (val)
636 || TYPE_LENGTH (type) > TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (val)))
637 result = allocate_value_lazy (type);
638 else
639 {
640 result = allocate_value (type);
641 value_contents_copy_raw (result, 0, val, 0, TYPE_LENGTH (type));
642 }
643 set_value_component_location (result, val);
644 set_value_bitsize (result, value_bitsize (val));
645 set_value_bitpos (result, value_bitpos (val));
646 if (VALUE_LVAL (result) == lval_memory)
647 set_value_address (result, value_address (val));
648 return result;
649 }
650 }
651
652 static const gdb_byte *
653 cond_offset_host (const gdb_byte *valaddr, long offset)
654 {
655 if (valaddr == NULL)
656 return NULL;
657 else
658 return valaddr + offset;
659 }
660
661 static CORE_ADDR
662 cond_offset_target (CORE_ADDR address, long offset)
663 {
664 if (address == 0)
665 return 0;
666 else
667 return address + offset;
668 }
669
670 /* Issue a warning (as for the definition of warning in utils.c, but
671 with exactly one argument rather than ...), unless the limit on the
672 number of warnings has passed during the evaluation of the current
673 expression. */
674
675 /* FIXME: cagney/2004-10-10: This function is mimicking the behavior
676 provided by "complaint". */
677 static void lim_warning (const char *format, ...) ATTRIBUTE_PRINTF (1, 2);
678
679 static void
680 lim_warning (const char *format, ...)
681 {
682 va_list args;
683
684 va_start (args, format);
685 warnings_issued += 1;
686 if (warnings_issued <= warning_limit)
687 vwarning (format, args);
688
689 va_end (args);
690 }
691
692 /* Issue an error if the size of an object of type T is unreasonable,
693 i.e. if it would be a bad idea to allocate a value of this type in
694 GDB. */
695
696 void
697 ada_ensure_varsize_limit (const struct type *type)
698 {
699 if (TYPE_LENGTH (type) > varsize_limit)
700 error (_("object size is larger than varsize-limit"));
701 }
702
703 /* Maximum value of a SIZE-byte signed integer type. */
704 static LONGEST
705 max_of_size (int size)
706 {
707 LONGEST top_bit = (LONGEST) 1 << (size * 8 - 2);
708
709 return top_bit | (top_bit - 1);
710 }
711
712 /* Minimum value of a SIZE-byte signed integer type. */
713 static LONGEST
714 min_of_size (int size)
715 {
716 return -max_of_size (size) - 1;
717 }
718
719 /* Maximum value of a SIZE-byte unsigned integer type. */
720 static ULONGEST
721 umax_of_size (int size)
722 {
723 ULONGEST top_bit = (ULONGEST) 1 << (size * 8 - 1);
724
725 return top_bit | (top_bit - 1);
726 }
727
728 /* Maximum value of integral type T, as a signed quantity. */
729 static LONGEST
730 max_of_type (struct type *t)
731 {
732 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (t))
733 return (LONGEST) umax_of_size (TYPE_LENGTH (t));
734 else
735 return max_of_size (TYPE_LENGTH (t));
736 }
737
738 /* Minimum value of integral type T, as a signed quantity. */
739 static LONGEST
740 min_of_type (struct type *t)
741 {
742 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (t))
743 return 0;
744 else
745 return min_of_size (TYPE_LENGTH (t));
746 }
747
748 /* The largest value in the domain of TYPE, a discrete type, as an integer. */
749 LONGEST
750 ada_discrete_type_high_bound (struct type *type)
751 {
752 type = resolve_dynamic_type (type, {}, 0);
753 switch (type->code ())
754 {
755 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
756 return TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (type);
757 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
758 return TYPE_FIELD_ENUMVAL (type, TYPE_NFIELDS (type) - 1);
759 case TYPE_CODE_BOOL:
760 return 1;
761 case TYPE_CODE_CHAR:
762 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
763 return max_of_type (type);
764 default:
765 error (_("Unexpected type in ada_discrete_type_high_bound."));
766 }
767 }
768
769 /* The smallest value in the domain of TYPE, a discrete type, as an integer. */
770 LONGEST
771 ada_discrete_type_low_bound (struct type *type)
772 {
773 type = resolve_dynamic_type (type, {}, 0);
774 switch (type->code ())
775 {
776 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
777 return TYPE_LOW_BOUND (type);
778 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
779 return TYPE_FIELD_ENUMVAL (type, 0);
780 case TYPE_CODE_BOOL:
781 return 0;
782 case TYPE_CODE_CHAR:
783 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
784 return min_of_type (type);
785 default:
786 error (_("Unexpected type in ada_discrete_type_low_bound."));
787 }
788 }
789
790 /* The identity on non-range types. For range types, the underlying
791 non-range scalar type. */
792
793 static struct type *
794 get_base_type (struct type *type)
795 {
796 while (type != NULL && type->code () == TYPE_CODE_RANGE)
797 {
798 if (type == TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) || TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) == NULL)
799 return type;
800 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
801 }
802 return type;
803 }
804
805 /* Return a decoded version of the given VALUE. This means returning
806 a value whose type is obtained by applying all the GNAT-specific
807 encodings, making the resulting type a static but standard description
808 of the initial type. */
809
810 struct value *
811 ada_get_decoded_value (struct value *value)
812 {
813 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (value));
814
815 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type)
816 || (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type)
817 && type->code () != TYPE_CODE_PTR))
818 {
819 if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF) /* array access type. */
820 value = ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (value);
821 else
822 value = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (value);
823 }
824 else
825 value = ada_to_fixed_value (value);
826
827 return value;
828 }
829
830 /* Same as ada_get_decoded_value, but with the given TYPE.
831 Because there is no associated actual value for this type,
832 the resulting type might be a best-effort approximation in
833 the case of dynamic types. */
834
835 struct type *
836 ada_get_decoded_type (struct type *type)
837 {
838 type = to_static_fixed_type (type);
839 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type))
840 type = ada_coerce_to_simple_array_type (type);
841 return type;
842 }
843
844 \f
845
846 /* Language Selection */
847
848 /* If the main program is in Ada, return language_ada, otherwise return LANG
849 (the main program is in Ada iif the adainit symbol is found). */
850
851 static enum language
852 ada_update_initial_language (enum language lang)
853 {
854 if (lookup_minimal_symbol ("adainit", NULL, NULL).minsym != NULL)
855 return language_ada;
856
857 return lang;
858 }
859
860 /* If the main procedure is written in Ada, then return its name.
861 The result is good until the next call. Return NULL if the main
862 procedure doesn't appear to be in Ada. */
863
864 char *
865 ada_main_name (void)
866 {
867 struct bound_minimal_symbol msym;
868 static gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> main_program_name;
869
870 /* For Ada, the name of the main procedure is stored in a specific
871 string constant, generated by the binder. Look for that symbol,
872 extract its address, and then read that string. If we didn't find
873 that string, then most probably the main procedure is not written
874 in Ada. */
875 msym = lookup_minimal_symbol (ADA_MAIN_PROGRAM_SYMBOL_NAME, NULL, NULL);
876
877 if (msym.minsym != NULL)
878 {
879 CORE_ADDR main_program_name_addr;
880 int err_code;
881
882 main_program_name_addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (msym);
883 if (main_program_name_addr == 0)
884 error (_("Invalid address for Ada main program name."));
885
886 target_read_string (main_program_name_addr, &main_program_name,
887 1024, &err_code);
888
889 if (err_code != 0)
890 return NULL;
891 return main_program_name.get ();
892 }
893
894 /* The main procedure doesn't seem to be in Ada. */
895 return NULL;
896 }
897 \f
898 /* Symbols */
899
900 /* Table of Ada operators and their GNAT-encoded names. Last entry is pair
901 of NULLs. */
902
903 const struct ada_opname_map ada_opname_table[] = {
904 {"Oadd", "\"+\"", BINOP_ADD},
905 {"Osubtract", "\"-\"", BINOP_SUB},
906 {"Omultiply", "\"*\"", BINOP_MUL},
907 {"Odivide", "\"/\"", BINOP_DIV},
908 {"Omod", "\"mod\"", BINOP_MOD},
909 {"Orem", "\"rem\"", BINOP_REM},
910 {"Oexpon", "\"**\"", BINOP_EXP},
911 {"Olt", "\"<\"", BINOP_LESS},
912 {"Ole", "\"<=\"", BINOP_LEQ},
913 {"Ogt", "\">\"", BINOP_GTR},
914 {"Oge", "\">=\"", BINOP_GEQ},
915 {"Oeq", "\"=\"", BINOP_EQUAL},
916 {"One", "\"/=\"", BINOP_NOTEQUAL},
917 {"Oand", "\"and\"", BINOP_BITWISE_AND},
918 {"Oor", "\"or\"", BINOP_BITWISE_IOR},
919 {"Oxor", "\"xor\"", BINOP_BITWISE_XOR},
920 {"Oconcat", "\"&\"", BINOP_CONCAT},
921 {"Oabs", "\"abs\"", UNOP_ABS},
922 {"Onot", "\"not\"", UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT},
923 {"Oadd", "\"+\"", UNOP_PLUS},
924 {"Osubtract", "\"-\"", UNOP_NEG},
925 {NULL, NULL}
926 };
927
928 /* The "encoded" form of DECODED, according to GNAT conventions. The
929 result is valid until the next call to ada_encode. If
930 THROW_ERRORS, throw an error if invalid operator name is found.
931 Otherwise, return NULL in that case. */
932
933 static char *
934 ada_encode_1 (const char *decoded, bool throw_errors)
935 {
936 static char *encoding_buffer = NULL;
937 static size_t encoding_buffer_size = 0;
938 const char *p;
939 int k;
940
941 if (decoded == NULL)
942 return NULL;
943
944 GROW_VECT (encoding_buffer, encoding_buffer_size,
945 2 * strlen (decoded) + 10);
946
947 k = 0;
948 for (p = decoded; *p != '\0'; p += 1)
949 {
950 if (*p == '.')
951 {
952 encoding_buffer[k] = encoding_buffer[k + 1] = '_';
953 k += 2;
954 }
955 else if (*p == '"')
956 {
957 const struct ada_opname_map *mapping;
958
959 for (mapping = ada_opname_table;
960 mapping->encoded != NULL
961 && !startswith (p, mapping->decoded); mapping += 1)
962 ;
963 if (mapping->encoded == NULL)
964 {
965 if (throw_errors)
966 error (_("invalid Ada operator name: %s"), p);
967 else
968 return NULL;
969 }
970 strcpy (encoding_buffer + k, mapping->encoded);
971 k += strlen (mapping->encoded);
972 break;
973 }
974 else
975 {
976 encoding_buffer[k] = *p;
977 k += 1;
978 }
979 }
980
981 encoding_buffer[k] = '\0';
982 return encoding_buffer;
983 }
984
985 /* The "encoded" form of DECODED, according to GNAT conventions.
986 The result is valid until the next call to ada_encode. */
987
988 char *
989 ada_encode (const char *decoded)
990 {
991 return ada_encode_1 (decoded, true);
992 }
993
994 /* Return NAME folded to lower case, or, if surrounded by single
995 quotes, unfolded, but with the quotes stripped away. Result good
996 to next call. */
997
998 static char *
999 ada_fold_name (gdb::string_view name)
1000 {
1001 static char *fold_buffer = NULL;
1002 static size_t fold_buffer_size = 0;
1003
1004 int len = name.size ();
1005 GROW_VECT (fold_buffer, fold_buffer_size, len + 1);
1006
1007 if (name[0] == '\'')
1008 {
1009 strncpy (fold_buffer, name.data () + 1, len - 2);
1010 fold_buffer[len - 2] = '\000';
1011 }
1012 else
1013 {
1014 int i;
1015
1016 for (i = 0; i <= len; i += 1)
1017 fold_buffer[i] = tolower (name[i]);
1018 }
1019
1020 return fold_buffer;
1021 }
1022
1023 /* Return nonzero if C is either a digit or a lowercase alphabet character. */
1024
1025 static int
1026 is_lower_alphanum (const char c)
1027 {
1028 return (isdigit (c) || (isalpha (c) && islower (c)));
1029 }
1030
1031 /* ENCODED is the linkage name of a symbol and LEN contains its length.
1032 This function saves in LEN the length of that same symbol name but
1033 without either of these suffixes:
1034 . .{DIGIT}+
1035 . ${DIGIT}+
1036 . ___{DIGIT}+
1037 . __{DIGIT}+.
1038
1039 These are suffixes introduced by the compiler for entities such as
1040 nested subprogram for instance, in order to avoid name clashes.
1041 They do not serve any purpose for the debugger. */
1042
1043 static void
1044 ada_remove_trailing_digits (const char *encoded, int *len)
1045 {
1046 if (*len > 1 && isdigit (encoded[*len - 1]))
1047 {
1048 int i = *len - 2;
1049
1050 while (i > 0 && isdigit (encoded[i]))
1051 i--;
1052 if (i >= 0 && encoded[i] == '.')
1053 *len = i;
1054 else if (i >= 0 && encoded[i] == '$')
1055 *len = i;
1056 else if (i >= 2 && startswith (encoded + i - 2, "___"))
1057 *len = i - 2;
1058 else if (i >= 1 && startswith (encoded + i - 1, "__"))
1059 *len = i - 1;
1060 }
1061 }
1062
1063 /* Remove the suffix introduced by the compiler for protected object
1064 subprograms. */
1065
1066 static void
1067 ada_remove_po_subprogram_suffix (const char *encoded, int *len)
1068 {
1069 /* Remove trailing N. */
1070
1071 /* Protected entry subprograms are broken into two
1072 separate subprograms: The first one is unprotected, and has
1073 a 'N' suffix; the second is the protected version, and has
1074 the 'P' suffix. The second calls the first one after handling
1075 the protection. Since the P subprograms are internally generated,
1076 we leave these names undecoded, giving the user a clue that this
1077 entity is internal. */
1078
1079 if (*len > 1
1080 && encoded[*len - 1] == 'N'
1081 && (isdigit (encoded[*len - 2]) || islower (encoded[*len - 2])))
1082 *len = *len - 1;
1083 }
1084
1085 /* If ENCODED follows the GNAT entity encoding conventions, then return
1086 the decoded form of ENCODED. Otherwise, return "<%s>" where "%s" is
1087 replaced by ENCODED. */
1088
1089 std::string
1090 ada_decode (const char *encoded)
1091 {
1092 int i, j;
1093 int len0;
1094 const char *p;
1095 int at_start_name;
1096 std::string decoded;
1097
1098 /* With function descriptors on PPC64, the value of a symbol named
1099 ".FN", if it exists, is the entry point of the function "FN". */
1100 if (encoded[0] == '.')
1101 encoded += 1;
1102
1103 /* The name of the Ada main procedure starts with "_ada_".
1104 This prefix is not part of the decoded name, so skip this part
1105 if we see this prefix. */
1106 if (startswith (encoded, "_ada_"))
1107 encoded += 5;
1108
1109 /* If the name starts with '_', then it is not a properly encoded
1110 name, so do not attempt to decode it. Similarly, if the name
1111 starts with '<', the name should not be decoded. */
1112 if (encoded[0] == '_' || encoded[0] == '<')
1113 goto Suppress;
1114
1115 len0 = strlen (encoded);
1116
1117 ada_remove_trailing_digits (encoded, &len0);
1118 ada_remove_po_subprogram_suffix (encoded, &len0);
1119
1120 /* Remove the ___X.* suffix if present. Do not forget to verify that
1121 the suffix is located before the current "end" of ENCODED. We want
1122 to avoid re-matching parts of ENCODED that have previously been
1123 marked as discarded (by decrementing LEN0). */
1124 p = strstr (encoded, "___");
1125 if (p != NULL && p - encoded < len0 - 3)
1126 {
1127 if (p[3] == 'X')
1128 len0 = p - encoded;
1129 else
1130 goto Suppress;
1131 }
1132
1133 /* Remove any trailing TKB suffix. It tells us that this symbol
1134 is for the body of a task, but that information does not actually
1135 appear in the decoded name. */
1136
1137 if (len0 > 3 && startswith (encoded + len0 - 3, "TKB"))
1138 len0 -= 3;
1139
1140 /* Remove any trailing TB suffix. The TB suffix is slightly different
1141 from the TKB suffix because it is used for non-anonymous task
1142 bodies. */
1143
1144 if (len0 > 2 && startswith (encoded + len0 - 2, "TB"))
1145 len0 -= 2;
1146
1147 /* Remove trailing "B" suffixes. */
1148 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-04-19: Not sure what this are used for... */
1149
1150 if (len0 > 1 && startswith (encoded + len0 - 1, "B"))
1151 len0 -= 1;
1152
1153 /* Make decoded big enough for possible expansion by operator name. */
1154
1155 decoded.resize (2 * len0 + 1, 'X');
1156
1157 /* Remove trailing __{digit}+ or trailing ${digit}+. */
1158
1159 if (len0 > 1 && isdigit (encoded[len0 - 1]))
1160 {
1161 i = len0 - 2;
1162 while ((i >= 0 && isdigit (encoded[i]))
1163 || (i >= 1 && encoded[i] == '_' && isdigit (encoded[i - 1])))
1164 i -= 1;
1165 if (i > 1 && encoded[i] == '_' && encoded[i - 1] == '_')
1166 len0 = i - 1;
1167 else if (encoded[i] == '$')
1168 len0 = i;
1169 }
1170
1171 /* The first few characters that are not alphabetic are not part
1172 of any encoding we use, so we can copy them over verbatim. */
1173
1174 for (i = 0, j = 0; i < len0 && !isalpha (encoded[i]); i += 1, j += 1)
1175 decoded[j] = encoded[i];
1176
1177 at_start_name = 1;
1178 while (i < len0)
1179 {
1180 /* Is this a symbol function? */
1181 if (at_start_name && encoded[i] == 'O')
1182 {
1183 int k;
1184
1185 for (k = 0; ada_opname_table[k].encoded != NULL; k += 1)
1186 {
1187 int op_len = strlen (ada_opname_table[k].encoded);
1188 if ((strncmp (ada_opname_table[k].encoded + 1, encoded + i + 1,
1189 op_len - 1) == 0)
1190 && !isalnum (encoded[i + op_len]))
1191 {
1192 strcpy (&decoded.front() + j, ada_opname_table[k].decoded);
1193 at_start_name = 0;
1194 i += op_len;
1195 j += strlen (ada_opname_table[k].decoded);
1196 break;
1197 }
1198 }
1199 if (ada_opname_table[k].encoded != NULL)
1200 continue;
1201 }
1202 at_start_name = 0;
1203
1204 /* Replace "TK__" with "__", which will eventually be translated
1205 into "." (just below). */
1206
1207 if (i < len0 - 4 && startswith (encoded + i, "TK__"))
1208 i += 2;
1209
1210 /* Replace "__B_{DIGITS}+__" sequences by "__", which will eventually
1211 be translated into "." (just below). These are internal names
1212 generated for anonymous blocks inside which our symbol is nested. */
1213
1214 if (len0 - i > 5 && encoded [i] == '_' && encoded [i+1] == '_'
1215 && encoded [i+2] == 'B' && encoded [i+3] == '_'
1216 && isdigit (encoded [i+4]))
1217 {
1218 int k = i + 5;
1219
1220 while (k < len0 && isdigit (encoded[k]))
1221 k++; /* Skip any extra digit. */
1222
1223 /* Double-check that the "__B_{DIGITS}+" sequence we found
1224 is indeed followed by "__". */
1225 if (len0 - k > 2 && encoded [k] == '_' && encoded [k+1] == '_')
1226 i = k;
1227 }
1228
1229 /* Remove _E{DIGITS}+[sb] */
1230
1231 /* Just as for protected object subprograms, there are 2 categories
1232 of subprograms created by the compiler for each entry. The first
1233 one implements the actual entry code, and has a suffix following
1234 the convention above; the second one implements the barrier and
1235 uses the same convention as above, except that the 'E' is replaced
1236 by a 'B'.
1237
1238 Just as above, we do not decode the name of barrier functions
1239 to give the user a clue that the code he is debugging has been
1240 internally generated. */
1241
1242 if (len0 - i > 3 && encoded [i] == '_' && encoded[i+1] == 'E'
1243 && isdigit (encoded[i+2]))
1244 {
1245 int k = i + 3;
1246
1247 while (k < len0 && isdigit (encoded[k]))
1248 k++;
1249
1250 if (k < len0
1251 && (encoded[k] == 'b' || encoded[k] == 's'))
1252 {
1253 k++;
1254 /* Just as an extra precaution, make sure that if this
1255 suffix is followed by anything else, it is a '_'.
1256 Otherwise, we matched this sequence by accident. */
1257 if (k == len0
1258 || (k < len0 && encoded[k] == '_'))
1259 i = k;
1260 }
1261 }
1262
1263 /* Remove trailing "N" in [a-z0-9]+N__. The N is added by
1264 the GNAT front-end in protected object subprograms. */
1265
1266 if (i < len0 + 3
1267 && encoded[i] == 'N' && encoded[i+1] == '_' && encoded[i+2] == '_')
1268 {
1269 /* Backtrack a bit up until we reach either the begining of
1270 the encoded name, or "__". Make sure that we only find
1271 digits or lowercase characters. */
1272 const char *ptr = encoded + i - 1;
1273
1274 while (ptr >= encoded && is_lower_alphanum (ptr[0]))
1275 ptr--;
1276 if (ptr < encoded
1277 || (ptr > encoded && ptr[0] == '_' && ptr[-1] == '_'))
1278 i++;
1279 }
1280
1281 if (encoded[i] == 'X' && i != 0 && isalnum (encoded[i - 1]))
1282 {
1283 /* This is a X[bn]* sequence not separated from the previous
1284 part of the name with a non-alpha-numeric character (in other
1285 words, immediately following an alpha-numeric character), then
1286 verify that it is placed at the end of the encoded name. If
1287 not, then the encoding is not valid and we should abort the
1288 decoding. Otherwise, just skip it, it is used in body-nested
1289 package names. */
1290 do
1291 i += 1;
1292 while (i < len0 && (encoded[i] == 'b' || encoded[i] == 'n'));
1293 if (i < len0)
1294 goto Suppress;
1295 }
1296 else if (i < len0 - 2 && encoded[i] == '_' && encoded[i + 1] == '_')
1297 {
1298 /* Replace '__' by '.'. */
1299 decoded[j] = '.';
1300 at_start_name = 1;
1301 i += 2;
1302 j += 1;
1303 }
1304 else
1305 {
1306 /* It's a character part of the decoded name, so just copy it
1307 over. */
1308 decoded[j] = encoded[i];
1309 i += 1;
1310 j += 1;
1311 }
1312 }
1313 decoded.resize (j);
1314
1315 /* Decoded names should never contain any uppercase character.
1316 Double-check this, and abort the decoding if we find one. */
1317
1318 for (i = 0; i < decoded.length(); ++i)
1319 if (isupper (decoded[i]) || decoded[i] == ' ')
1320 goto Suppress;
1321
1322 return decoded;
1323
1324 Suppress:
1325 if (encoded[0] == '<')
1326 decoded = encoded;
1327 else
1328 decoded = '<' + std::string(encoded) + '>';
1329 return decoded;
1330
1331 }
1332
1333 /* Table for keeping permanent unique copies of decoded names. Once
1334 allocated, names in this table are never released. While this is a
1335 storage leak, it should not be significant unless there are massive
1336 changes in the set of decoded names in successive versions of a
1337 symbol table loaded during a single session. */
1338 static struct htab *decoded_names_store;
1339
1340 /* Returns the decoded name of GSYMBOL, as for ada_decode, caching it
1341 in the language-specific part of GSYMBOL, if it has not been
1342 previously computed. Tries to save the decoded name in the same
1343 obstack as GSYMBOL, if possible, and otherwise on the heap (so that,
1344 in any case, the decoded symbol has a lifetime at least that of
1345 GSYMBOL).
1346 The GSYMBOL parameter is "mutable" in the C++ sense: logically
1347 const, but nevertheless modified to a semantically equivalent form
1348 when a decoded name is cached in it. */
1349
1350 const char *
1351 ada_decode_symbol (const struct general_symbol_info *arg)
1352 {
1353 struct general_symbol_info *gsymbol = (struct general_symbol_info *) arg;
1354 const char **resultp =
1355 &gsymbol->language_specific.demangled_name;
1356
1357 if (!gsymbol->ada_mangled)
1358 {
1359 std::string decoded = ada_decode (gsymbol->linkage_name ());
1360 struct obstack *obstack = gsymbol->language_specific.obstack;
1361
1362 gsymbol->ada_mangled = 1;
1363
1364 if (obstack != NULL)
1365 *resultp = obstack_strdup (obstack, decoded.c_str ());
1366 else
1367 {
1368 /* Sometimes, we can't find a corresponding objfile, in
1369 which case, we put the result on the heap. Since we only
1370 decode when needed, we hope this usually does not cause a
1371 significant memory leak (FIXME). */
1372
1373 char **slot = (char **) htab_find_slot (decoded_names_store,
1374 decoded.c_str (), INSERT);
1375
1376 if (*slot == NULL)
1377 *slot = xstrdup (decoded.c_str ());
1378 *resultp = *slot;
1379 }
1380 }
1381
1382 return *resultp;
1383 }
1384
1385 static char *
1386 ada_la_decode (const char *encoded, int options)
1387 {
1388 return xstrdup (ada_decode (encoded).c_str ());
1389 }
1390
1391 /* Implement la_sniff_from_mangled_name for Ada. */
1392
1393 static int
1394 ada_sniff_from_mangled_name (const char *mangled, char **out)
1395 {
1396 std::string demangled = ada_decode (mangled);
1397
1398 *out = NULL;
1399
1400 if (demangled != mangled && demangled[0] != '<')
1401 {
1402 /* Set the gsymbol language to Ada, but still return 0.
1403 Two reasons for that:
1404
1405 1. For Ada, we prefer computing the symbol's decoded name
1406 on the fly rather than pre-compute it, in order to save
1407 memory (Ada projects are typically very large).
1408
1409 2. There are some areas in the definition of the GNAT
1410 encoding where, with a bit of bad luck, we might be able
1411 to decode a non-Ada symbol, generating an incorrect
1412 demangled name (Eg: names ending with "TB" for instance
1413 are identified as task bodies and so stripped from
1414 the decoded name returned).
1415
1416 Returning 1, here, but not setting *DEMANGLED, helps us get a
1417 little bit of the best of both worlds. Because we're last,
1418 we should not affect any of the other languages that were
1419 able to demangle the symbol before us; we get to correctly
1420 tag Ada symbols as such; and even if we incorrectly tagged a
1421 non-Ada symbol, which should be rare, any routing through the
1422 Ada language should be transparent (Ada tries to behave much
1423 like C/C++ with non-Ada symbols). */
1424 return 1;
1425 }
1426
1427 return 0;
1428 }
1429
1430 \f
1431
1432 /* Arrays */
1433
1434 /* Assuming that INDEX_DESC_TYPE is an ___XA structure, a structure
1435 generated by the GNAT compiler to describe the index type used
1436 for each dimension of an array, check whether it follows the latest
1437 known encoding. If not, fix it up to conform to the latest encoding.
1438 Otherwise, do nothing. This function also does nothing if
1439 INDEX_DESC_TYPE is NULL.
1440
1441 The GNAT encoding used to describe the array index type evolved a bit.
1442 Initially, the information would be provided through the name of each
1443 field of the structure type only, while the type of these fields was
1444 described as unspecified and irrelevant. The debugger was then expected
1445 to perform a global type lookup using the name of that field in order
1446 to get access to the full index type description. Because these global
1447 lookups can be very expensive, the encoding was later enhanced to make
1448 the global lookup unnecessary by defining the field type as being
1449 the full index type description.
1450
1451 The purpose of this routine is to allow us to support older versions
1452 of the compiler by detecting the use of the older encoding, and by
1453 fixing up the INDEX_DESC_TYPE to follow the new one (at this point,
1454 we essentially replace each field's meaningless type by the associated
1455 index subtype). */
1456
1457 void
1458 ada_fixup_array_indexes_type (struct type *index_desc_type)
1459 {
1460 int i;
1461
1462 if (index_desc_type == NULL)
1463 return;
1464 gdb_assert (TYPE_NFIELDS (index_desc_type) > 0);
1465
1466 /* Check if INDEX_DESC_TYPE follows the older encoding (it is sufficient
1467 to check one field only, no need to check them all). If not, return
1468 now.
1469
1470 If our INDEX_DESC_TYPE was generated using the older encoding,
1471 the field type should be a meaningless integer type whose name
1472 is not equal to the field name. */
1473 if (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_desc_type, 0)->name () != NULL
1474 && strcmp (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_desc_type, 0)->name (),
1475 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (index_desc_type, 0)) == 0)
1476 return;
1477
1478 /* Fixup each field of INDEX_DESC_TYPE. */
1479 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (index_desc_type); i++)
1480 {
1481 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (index_desc_type, i);
1482 struct type *raw_type = ada_check_typedef (ada_find_any_type (name));
1483
1484 if (raw_type)
1485 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_desc_type, i) = raw_type;
1486 }
1487 }
1488
1489 /* The desc_* routines return primitive portions of array descriptors
1490 (fat pointers). */
1491
1492 /* The descriptor or array type, if any, indicated by TYPE; removes
1493 level of indirection, if needed. */
1494
1495 static struct type *
1496 desc_base_type (struct type *type)
1497 {
1498 if (type == NULL)
1499 return NULL;
1500 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1501 if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
1502 type = ada_typedef_target_type (type);
1503
1504 if (type != NULL
1505 && (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR
1506 || type->code () == TYPE_CODE_REF))
1507 return ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
1508 else
1509 return type;
1510 }
1511
1512 /* True iff TYPE indicates a "thin" array pointer type. */
1513
1514 static int
1515 is_thin_pntr (struct type *type)
1516 {
1517 return
1518 is_suffix (ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type)), "___XUT")
1519 || is_suffix (ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type)), "___XUT___XVE");
1520 }
1521
1522 /* The descriptor type for thin pointer type TYPE. */
1523
1524 static struct type *
1525 thin_descriptor_type (struct type *type)
1526 {
1527 struct type *base_type = desc_base_type (type);
1528
1529 if (base_type == NULL)
1530 return NULL;
1531 if (is_suffix (ada_type_name (base_type), "___XVE"))
1532 return base_type;
1533 else
1534 {
1535 struct type *alt_type = ada_find_parallel_type (base_type, "___XVE");
1536
1537 if (alt_type == NULL)
1538 return base_type;
1539 else
1540 return alt_type;
1541 }
1542 }
1543
1544 /* A pointer to the array data for thin-pointer value VAL. */
1545
1546 static struct value *
1547 thin_data_pntr (struct value *val)
1548 {
1549 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (val));
1550 struct type *data_type = desc_data_target_type (thin_descriptor_type (type));
1551
1552 data_type = lookup_pointer_type (data_type);
1553
1554 if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
1555 return value_cast (data_type, value_copy (val));
1556 else
1557 return value_from_longest (data_type, value_address (val));
1558 }
1559
1560 /* True iff TYPE indicates a "thick" array pointer type. */
1561
1562 static int
1563 is_thick_pntr (struct type *type)
1564 {
1565 type = desc_base_type (type);
1566 return (type != NULL && type->code () == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1567 && lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_BOUNDS", 1) != NULL);
1568 }
1569
1570 /* If TYPE is the type of an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer) or a
1571 pointer to one, the type of its bounds data; otherwise, NULL. */
1572
1573 static struct type *
1574 desc_bounds_type (struct type *type)
1575 {
1576 struct type *r;
1577
1578 type = desc_base_type (type);
1579
1580 if (type == NULL)
1581 return NULL;
1582 else if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1583 {
1584 type = thin_descriptor_type (type);
1585 if (type == NULL)
1586 return NULL;
1587 r = lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "BOUNDS", 1);
1588 if (r != NULL)
1589 return ada_check_typedef (r);
1590 }
1591 else if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
1592 {
1593 r = lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_BOUNDS", 1);
1594 if (r != NULL)
1595 return ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ada_check_typedef (r)));
1596 }
1597 return NULL;
1598 }
1599
1600 /* If ARR is an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer), or pointer to
1601 one, a pointer to its bounds data. Otherwise NULL. */
1602
1603 static struct value *
1604 desc_bounds (struct value *arr)
1605 {
1606 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr));
1607
1608 if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1609 {
1610 struct type *bounds_type =
1611 desc_bounds_type (thin_descriptor_type (type));
1612 LONGEST addr;
1613
1614 if (bounds_type == NULL)
1615 error (_("Bad GNAT array descriptor"));
1616
1617 /* NOTE: The following calculation is not really kosher, but
1618 since desc_type is an XVE-encoded type (and shouldn't be),
1619 the correct calculation is a real pain. FIXME (and fix GCC). */
1620 if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
1621 addr = value_as_long (arr);
1622 else
1623 addr = value_address (arr);
1624
1625 return
1626 value_from_longest (lookup_pointer_type (bounds_type),
1627 addr - TYPE_LENGTH (bounds_type));
1628 }
1629
1630 else if (is_thick_pntr (type))
1631 {
1632 struct value *p_bounds = value_struct_elt (&arr, NULL, "P_BOUNDS", NULL,
1633 _("Bad GNAT array descriptor"));
1634 struct type *p_bounds_type = value_type (p_bounds);
1635
1636 if (p_bounds_type
1637 && p_bounds_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
1638 {
1639 struct type *target_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (p_bounds_type);
1640
1641 if (TYPE_STUB (target_type))
1642 p_bounds = value_cast (lookup_pointer_type
1643 (ada_check_typedef (target_type)),
1644 p_bounds);
1645 }
1646 else
1647 error (_("Bad GNAT array descriptor"));
1648
1649 return p_bounds;
1650 }
1651 else
1652 return NULL;
1653 }
1654
1655 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1656 position of the field containing the address of the bounds data. */
1657
1658 static int
1659 fat_pntr_bounds_bitpos (struct type *type)
1660 {
1661 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (desc_base_type (type), 1);
1662 }
1663
1664 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1665 size of the field containing the address of the bounds data. */
1666
1667 static int
1668 fat_pntr_bounds_bitsize (struct type *type)
1669 {
1670 type = desc_base_type (type);
1671
1672 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 1) > 0)
1673 return TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 1);
1674 else
1675 return 8 * TYPE_LENGTH (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 1)));
1676 }
1677
1678 /* If TYPE is the type of an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer) or a
1679 pointer to one, the type of its array data (a array-with-no-bounds type);
1680 otherwise, NULL. Use ada_type_of_array to get an array type with bounds
1681 data. */
1682
1683 static struct type *
1684 desc_data_target_type (struct type *type)
1685 {
1686 type = desc_base_type (type);
1687
1688 /* NOTE: The following is bogus; see comment in desc_bounds. */
1689 if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1690 return desc_base_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (thin_descriptor_type (type), 1));
1691 else if (is_thick_pntr (type))
1692 {
1693 struct type *data_type = lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_ARRAY", 1);
1694
1695 if (data_type
1696 && ada_check_typedef (data_type)->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
1697 return ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (data_type));
1698 }
1699
1700 return NULL;
1701 }
1702
1703 /* If ARR is an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer), a pointer to
1704 its array data. */
1705
1706 static struct value *
1707 desc_data (struct value *arr)
1708 {
1709 struct type *type = value_type (arr);
1710
1711 if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1712 return thin_data_pntr (arr);
1713 else if (is_thick_pntr (type))
1714 return value_struct_elt (&arr, NULL, "P_ARRAY", NULL,
1715 _("Bad GNAT array descriptor"));
1716 else
1717 return NULL;
1718 }
1719
1720
1721 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1722 position of the field containing the address of the data. */
1723
1724 static int
1725 fat_pntr_data_bitpos (struct type *type)
1726 {
1727 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (desc_base_type (type), 0);
1728 }
1729
1730 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1731 size of the field containing the address of the data. */
1732
1733 static int
1734 fat_pntr_data_bitsize (struct type *type)
1735 {
1736 type = desc_base_type (type);
1737
1738 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 0) > 0)
1739 return TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 0);
1740 else
1741 return TARGET_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 0));
1742 }
1743
1744 /* If BOUNDS is an array-bounds structure (or pointer to one), return
1745 the Ith lower bound stored in it, if WHICH is 0, and the Ith upper
1746 bound, if WHICH is 1. The first bound is I=1. */
1747
1748 static struct value *
1749 desc_one_bound (struct value *bounds, int i, int which)
1750 {
1751 char bound_name[20];
1752 xsnprintf (bound_name, sizeof (bound_name), "%cB%d",
1753 which ? 'U' : 'L', i - 1);
1754 return value_struct_elt (&bounds, NULL, bound_name, NULL,
1755 _("Bad GNAT array descriptor bounds"));
1756 }
1757
1758 /* If BOUNDS is an array-bounds structure type, return the bit position
1759 of the Ith lower bound stored in it, if WHICH is 0, and the Ith upper
1760 bound, if WHICH is 1. The first bound is I=1. */
1761
1762 static int
1763 desc_bound_bitpos (struct type *type, int i, int which)
1764 {
1765 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (desc_base_type (type), 2 * i + which - 2);
1766 }
1767
1768 /* If BOUNDS is an array-bounds structure type, return the bit field size
1769 of the Ith lower bound stored in it, if WHICH is 0, and the Ith upper
1770 bound, if WHICH is 1. The first bound is I=1. */
1771
1772 static int
1773 desc_bound_bitsize (struct type *type, int i, int which)
1774 {
1775 type = desc_base_type (type);
1776
1777 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 2 * i + which - 2) > 0)
1778 return TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 2 * i + which - 2);
1779 else
1780 return 8 * TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 2 * i + which - 2));
1781 }
1782
1783 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-bounds structure, the type of its
1784 Ith bound (numbering from 1). Otherwise, NULL. */
1785
1786 static struct type *
1787 desc_index_type (struct type *type, int i)
1788 {
1789 type = desc_base_type (type);
1790
1791 if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
1792 {
1793 char bound_name[20];
1794 xsnprintf (bound_name, sizeof (bound_name), "LB%d", i - 1);
1795 return lookup_struct_elt_type (type, bound_name, 1);
1796 }
1797 else
1798 return NULL;
1799 }
1800
1801 /* The number of index positions in the array-bounds type TYPE.
1802 Return 0 if TYPE is NULL. */
1803
1804 static int
1805 desc_arity (struct type *type)
1806 {
1807 type = desc_base_type (type);
1808
1809 if (type != NULL)
1810 return TYPE_NFIELDS (type) / 2;
1811 return 0;
1812 }
1813
1814 /* Non-zero iff TYPE is a simple array type (not a pointer to one) or
1815 an array descriptor type (representing an unconstrained array
1816 type). */
1817
1818 static int
1819 ada_is_direct_array_type (struct type *type)
1820 {
1821 if (type == NULL)
1822 return 0;
1823 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1824 return (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
1825 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type));
1826 }
1827
1828 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents any kind of array in Ada, or a pointer
1829 * to one. */
1830
1831 static int
1832 ada_is_array_type (struct type *type)
1833 {
1834 while (type != NULL
1835 && (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR
1836 || type->code () == TYPE_CODE_REF))
1837 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
1838 return ada_is_direct_array_type (type);
1839 }
1840
1841 /* Non-zero iff TYPE is a simple array type or pointer to one. */
1842
1843 int
1844 ada_is_simple_array_type (struct type *type)
1845 {
1846 if (type == NULL)
1847 return 0;
1848 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1849 return (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
1850 || (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR
1851 && (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type))->code ()
1852 == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)));
1853 }
1854
1855 /* Non-zero iff TYPE belongs to a GNAT array descriptor. */
1856
1857 int
1858 ada_is_array_descriptor_type (struct type *type)
1859 {
1860 struct type *data_type = desc_data_target_type (type);
1861
1862 if (type == NULL)
1863 return 0;
1864 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1865 return (data_type != NULL
1866 && data_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
1867 && desc_arity (desc_bounds_type (type)) > 0);
1868 }
1869
1870 /* Non-zero iff type is a partially mal-formed GNAT array
1871 descriptor. FIXME: This is to compensate for some problems with
1872 debugging output from GNAT. Re-examine periodically to see if it
1873 is still needed. */
1874
1875 int
1876 ada_is_bogus_array_descriptor (struct type *type)
1877 {
1878 return
1879 type != NULL
1880 && type->code () == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1881 && (lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_BOUNDS", 1) != NULL
1882 || lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_ARRAY", 1) != NULL)
1883 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type);
1884 }
1885
1886
1887 /* If ARR has a record type in the form of a standard GNAT array descriptor,
1888 (fat pointer) returns the type of the array data described---specifically,
1889 a pointer-to-array type. If BOUNDS is non-zero, the bounds data are filled
1890 in from the descriptor; otherwise, they are left unspecified. If
1891 the ARR denotes a null array descriptor and BOUNDS is non-zero,
1892 returns NULL. The result is simply the type of ARR if ARR is not
1893 a descriptor. */
1894
1895 static struct type *
1896 ada_type_of_array (struct value *arr, int bounds)
1897 {
1898 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1899 return decode_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr));
1900
1901 if (!ada_is_array_descriptor_type (value_type (arr)))
1902 return value_type (arr);
1903
1904 if (!bounds)
1905 {
1906 struct type *array_type =
1907 ada_check_typedef (desc_data_target_type (value_type (arr)));
1908
1909 if (ada_is_unconstrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1910 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (array_type, 0) =
1911 decode_packed_array_bitsize (value_type (arr));
1912
1913 return array_type;
1914 }
1915 else
1916 {
1917 struct type *elt_type;
1918 int arity;
1919 struct value *descriptor;
1920
1921 elt_type = ada_array_element_type (value_type (arr), -1);
1922 arity = ada_array_arity (value_type (arr));
1923
1924 if (elt_type == NULL || arity == 0)
1925 return ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr));
1926
1927 descriptor = desc_bounds (arr);
1928 if (value_as_long (descriptor) == 0)
1929 return NULL;
1930 while (arity > 0)
1931 {
1932 struct type *range_type = alloc_type_copy (value_type (arr));
1933 struct type *array_type = alloc_type_copy (value_type (arr));
1934 struct value *low = desc_one_bound (descriptor, arity, 0);
1935 struct value *high = desc_one_bound (descriptor, arity, 1);
1936
1937 arity -= 1;
1938 create_static_range_type (range_type, value_type (low),
1939 longest_to_int (value_as_long (low)),
1940 longest_to_int (value_as_long (high)));
1941 elt_type = create_array_type (array_type, elt_type, range_type);
1942
1943 if (ada_is_unconstrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1944 {
1945 /* We need to store the element packed bitsize, as well as
1946 recompute the array size, because it was previously
1947 computed based on the unpacked element size. */
1948 LONGEST lo = value_as_long (low);
1949 LONGEST hi = value_as_long (high);
1950
1951 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0) =
1952 decode_packed_array_bitsize (value_type (arr));
1953 /* If the array has no element, then the size is already
1954 zero, and does not need to be recomputed. */
1955 if (lo < hi)
1956 {
1957 int array_bitsize =
1958 (hi - lo + 1) * TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0);
1959
1960 TYPE_LENGTH (array_type) = (array_bitsize + 7) / 8;
1961 }
1962 }
1963 }
1964
1965 return lookup_pointer_type (elt_type);
1966 }
1967 }
1968
1969 /* If ARR does not represent an array, returns ARR unchanged.
1970 Otherwise, returns either a standard GDB array with bounds set
1971 appropriately or, if ARR is a non-null fat pointer, a pointer to a standard
1972 GDB array. Returns NULL if ARR is a null fat pointer. */
1973
1974 struct value *
1975 ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (struct value *arr)
1976 {
1977 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (value_type (arr)))
1978 {
1979 struct type *arrType = ada_type_of_array (arr, 1);
1980
1981 if (arrType == NULL)
1982 return NULL;
1983 return value_cast (arrType, value_copy (desc_data (arr)));
1984 }
1985 else if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1986 return decode_constrained_packed_array (arr);
1987 else
1988 return arr;
1989 }
1990
1991 /* If ARR does not represent an array, returns ARR unchanged.
1992 Otherwise, returns a standard GDB array describing ARR (which may
1993 be ARR itself if it already is in the proper form). */
1994
1995 struct value *
1996 ada_coerce_to_simple_array (struct value *arr)
1997 {
1998 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (value_type (arr)))
1999 {
2000 struct value *arrVal = ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (arr);
2001
2002 if (arrVal == NULL)
2003 error (_("Bounds unavailable for null array pointer."));
2004 ada_ensure_varsize_limit (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (arrVal)));
2005 return value_ind (arrVal);
2006 }
2007 else if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
2008 return decode_constrained_packed_array (arr);
2009 else
2010 return arr;
2011 }
2012
2013 /* If TYPE represents a GNAT array type, return it translated to an
2014 ordinary GDB array type (possibly with BITSIZE fields indicating
2015 packing). For other types, is the identity. */
2016
2017 struct type *
2018 ada_coerce_to_simple_array_type (struct type *type)
2019 {
2020 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type))
2021 return decode_constrained_packed_array_type (type);
2022
2023 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type))
2024 return ada_check_typedef (desc_data_target_type (type));
2025
2026 return type;
2027 }
2028
2029 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents a standard GNAT packed-array type. */
2030
2031 static int
2032 ada_is_packed_array_type (struct type *type)
2033 {
2034 if (type == NULL)
2035 return 0;
2036 type = desc_base_type (type);
2037 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
2038 return
2039 ada_type_name (type) != NULL
2040 && strstr (ada_type_name (type), "___XP") != NULL;
2041 }
2042
2043 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents a standard GNAT constrained
2044 packed-array type. */
2045
2046 int
2047 ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *type)
2048 {
2049 return ada_is_packed_array_type (type)
2050 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type);
2051 }
2052
2053 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents an array descriptor for a
2054 unconstrained packed-array type. */
2055
2056 static int
2057 ada_is_unconstrained_packed_array_type (struct type *type)
2058 {
2059 return ada_is_packed_array_type (type)
2060 && ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type);
2061 }
2062
2063 /* Given that TYPE encodes a packed array type (constrained or unconstrained),
2064 return the size of its elements in bits. */
2065
2066 static long
2067 decode_packed_array_bitsize (struct type *type)
2068 {
2069 const char *raw_name;
2070 const char *tail;
2071 long bits;
2072
2073 /* Access to arrays implemented as fat pointers are encoded as a typedef
2074 of the fat pointer type. We need the name of the fat pointer type
2075 to do the decoding, so strip the typedef layer. */
2076 if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
2077 type = ada_typedef_target_type (type);
2078
2079 raw_name = ada_type_name (ada_check_typedef (type));
2080 if (!raw_name)
2081 raw_name = ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type));
2082
2083 if (!raw_name)
2084 return 0;
2085
2086 tail = strstr (raw_name, "___XP");
2087 gdb_assert (tail != NULL);
2088
2089 if (sscanf (tail + sizeof ("___XP") - 1, "%ld", &bits) != 1)
2090 {
2091 lim_warning
2092 (_("could not understand bit size information on packed array"));
2093 return 0;
2094 }
2095
2096 return bits;
2097 }
2098
2099 /* Given that TYPE is a standard GDB array type with all bounds filled
2100 in, and that the element size of its ultimate scalar constituents
2101 (that is, either its elements, or, if it is an array of arrays, its
2102 elements' elements, etc.) is *ELT_BITS, return an identical type,
2103 but with the bit sizes of its elements (and those of any
2104 constituent arrays) recorded in the BITSIZE components of its
2105 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE values, and with *ELT_BITS set to its total size
2106 in bits.
2107
2108 Note that, for arrays whose index type has an XA encoding where
2109 a bound references a record discriminant, getting that discriminant,
2110 and therefore the actual value of that bound, is not possible
2111 because none of the given parameters gives us access to the record.
2112 This function assumes that it is OK in the context where it is being
2113 used to return an array whose bounds are still dynamic and where
2114 the length is arbitrary. */
2115
2116 static struct type *
2117 constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *type, long *elt_bits)
2118 {
2119 struct type *new_elt_type;
2120 struct type *new_type;
2121 struct type *index_type_desc;
2122 struct type *index_type;
2123 LONGEST low_bound, high_bound;
2124
2125 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
2126 if (type->code () != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2127 return type;
2128
2129 index_type_desc = ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XA");
2130 if (index_type_desc)
2131 index_type = to_fixed_range_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_type_desc, 0),
2132 NULL);
2133 else
2134 index_type = TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type);
2135
2136 new_type = alloc_type_copy (type);
2137 new_elt_type =
2138 constrained_packed_array_type (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)),
2139 elt_bits);
2140 create_array_type (new_type, new_elt_type, index_type);
2141 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (new_type, 0) = *elt_bits;
2142 new_type->set_name (ada_type_name (type));
2143
2144 if ((check_typedef (index_type)->code () == TYPE_CODE_RANGE
2145 && is_dynamic_type (check_typedef (index_type)))
2146 || get_discrete_bounds (index_type, &low_bound, &high_bound) < 0)
2147 low_bound = high_bound = 0;
2148 if (high_bound < low_bound)
2149 *elt_bits = TYPE_LENGTH (new_type) = 0;
2150 else
2151 {
2152 *elt_bits *= (high_bound - low_bound + 1);
2153 TYPE_LENGTH (new_type) =
2154 (*elt_bits + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2155 }
2156
2157 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (new_type) = 1;
2158 return new_type;
2159 }
2160
2161 /* The array type encoded by TYPE, where
2162 ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (TYPE). */
2163
2164 static struct type *
2165 decode_constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *type)
2166 {
2167 const char *raw_name = ada_type_name (ada_check_typedef (type));
2168 char *name;
2169 const char *tail;
2170 struct type *shadow_type;
2171 long bits;
2172
2173 if (!raw_name)
2174 raw_name = ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type));
2175
2176 if (!raw_name)
2177 return NULL;
2178
2179 name = (char *) alloca (strlen (raw_name) + 1);
2180 tail = strstr (raw_name, "___XP");
2181 type = desc_base_type (type);
2182
2183 memcpy (name, raw_name, tail - raw_name);
2184 name[tail - raw_name] = '\000';
2185
2186 shadow_type = ada_find_parallel_type_with_name (type, name);
2187
2188 if (shadow_type == NULL)
2189 {
2190 lim_warning (_("could not find bounds information on packed array"));
2191 return NULL;
2192 }
2193 shadow_type = check_typedef (shadow_type);
2194
2195 if (shadow_type->code () != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2196 {
2197 lim_warning (_("could not understand bounds "
2198 "information on packed array"));
2199 return NULL;
2200 }
2201
2202 bits = decode_packed_array_bitsize (type);
2203 return constrained_packed_array_type (shadow_type, &bits);
2204 }
2205
2206 /* Given that ARR is a struct value *indicating a GNAT constrained packed
2207 array, returns a simple array that denotes that array. Its type is a
2208 standard GDB array type except that the BITSIZEs of the array
2209 target types are set to the number of bits in each element, and the
2210 type length is set appropriately. */
2211
2212 static struct value *
2213 decode_constrained_packed_array (struct value *arr)
2214 {
2215 struct type *type;
2216
2217 /* If our value is a pointer, then dereference it. Likewise if
2218 the value is a reference. Make sure that this operation does not
2219 cause the target type to be fixed, as this would indirectly cause
2220 this array to be decoded. The rest of the routine assumes that
2221 the array hasn't been decoded yet, so we use the basic "coerce_ref"
2222 and "value_ind" routines to perform the dereferencing, as opposed
2223 to using "ada_coerce_ref" or "ada_value_ind". */
2224 arr = coerce_ref (arr);
2225 if (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr))->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
2226 arr = value_ind (arr);
2227
2228 type = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr));
2229 if (type == NULL)
2230 {
2231 error (_("can't unpack array"));
2232 return NULL;
2233 }
2234
2235 if (type_byte_order (value_type (arr)) == BFD_ENDIAN_BIG
2236 && ada_is_modular_type (value_type (arr)))
2237 {
2238 /* This is a (right-justified) modular type representing a packed
2239 array with no wrapper. In order to interpret the value through
2240 the (left-justified) packed array type we just built, we must
2241 first left-justify it. */
2242 int bit_size, bit_pos;
2243 ULONGEST mod;
2244
2245 mod = ada_modulus (value_type (arr)) - 1;
2246 bit_size = 0;
2247 while (mod > 0)
2248 {
2249 bit_size += 1;
2250 mod >>= 1;
2251 }
2252 bit_pos = HOST_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (arr)) - bit_size;
2253 arr = ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arr, NULL,
2254 bit_pos / HOST_CHAR_BIT,
2255 bit_pos % HOST_CHAR_BIT,
2256 bit_size,
2257 type);
2258 }
2259
2260 return coerce_unspec_val_to_type (arr, type);
2261 }
2262
2263
2264 /* The value of the element of packed array ARR at the ARITY indices
2265 given in IND. ARR must be a simple array. */
2266
2267 static struct value *
2268 value_subscript_packed (struct value *arr, int arity, struct value **ind)
2269 {
2270 int i;
2271 int bits, elt_off, bit_off;
2272 long elt_total_bit_offset;
2273 struct type *elt_type;
2274 struct value *v;
2275
2276 bits = 0;
2277 elt_total_bit_offset = 0;
2278 elt_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr));
2279 for (i = 0; i < arity; i += 1)
2280 {
2281 if (elt_type->code () != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
2282 || TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0) == 0)
2283 error
2284 (_("attempt to do packed indexing of "
2285 "something other than a packed array"));
2286 else
2287 {
2288 struct type *range_type = TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (elt_type);
2289 LONGEST lowerbound, upperbound;
2290 LONGEST idx;
2291
2292 if (get_discrete_bounds (range_type, &lowerbound, &upperbound) < 0)
2293 {
2294 lim_warning (_("don't know bounds of array"));
2295 lowerbound = upperbound = 0;
2296 }
2297
2298 idx = pos_atr (ind[i]);
2299 if (idx < lowerbound || idx > upperbound)
2300 lim_warning (_("packed array index %ld out of bounds"),
2301 (long) idx);
2302 bits = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0);
2303 elt_total_bit_offset += (idx - lowerbound) * bits;
2304 elt_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type));
2305 }
2306 }
2307 elt_off = elt_total_bit_offset / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2308 bit_off = elt_total_bit_offset % HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2309
2310 v = ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arr, NULL, elt_off, bit_off,
2311 bits, elt_type);
2312 return v;
2313 }
2314
2315 /* Non-zero iff TYPE includes negative integer values. */
2316
2317 static int
2318 has_negatives (struct type *type)
2319 {
2320 switch (type->code ())
2321 {
2322 default:
2323 return 0;
2324 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
2325 return !TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
2326 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
2327 return TYPE_LOW_BOUND (type) - TYPE_RANGE_DATA (type)->bias < 0;
2328 }
2329 }
2330
2331 /* With SRC being a buffer containing BIT_SIZE bits of data at BIT_OFFSET,
2332 unpack that data into UNPACKED. UNPACKED_LEN is the size in bytes of
2333 the unpacked buffer.
2334
2335 The size of the unpacked buffer (UNPACKED_LEN) is expected to be large
2336 enough to contain at least BIT_OFFSET bits. If not, an error is raised.
2337
2338 IS_BIG_ENDIAN is nonzero if the data is stored in big endian mode,
2339 zero otherwise.
2340
2341 IS_SIGNED_TYPE is nonzero if the data corresponds to a signed type.
2342
2343 IS_SCALAR is nonzero if the data corresponds to a signed type. */
2344
2345 static void
2346 ada_unpack_from_contents (const gdb_byte *src, int bit_offset, int bit_size,
2347 gdb_byte *unpacked, int unpacked_len,
2348 int is_big_endian, int is_signed_type,
2349 int is_scalar)
2350 {
2351 int src_len = (bit_size + bit_offset + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / 8;
2352 int src_idx; /* Index into the source area */
2353 int src_bytes_left; /* Number of source bytes left to process. */
2354 int srcBitsLeft; /* Number of source bits left to move */
2355 int unusedLS; /* Number of bits in next significant
2356 byte of source that are unused */
2357
2358 int unpacked_idx; /* Index into the unpacked buffer */
2359 int unpacked_bytes_left; /* Number of bytes left to set in unpacked. */
2360
2361 unsigned long accum; /* Staging area for bits being transferred */
2362 int accumSize; /* Number of meaningful bits in accum */
2363 unsigned char sign;
2364
2365 /* Transmit bytes from least to most significant; delta is the direction
2366 the indices move. */
2367 int delta = is_big_endian ? -1 : 1;
2368
2369 /* Make sure that unpacked is large enough to receive the BIT_SIZE
2370 bits from SRC. .*/
2371 if ((bit_size + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT > unpacked_len)
2372 error (_("Cannot unpack %d bits into buffer of %d bytes"),
2373 bit_size, unpacked_len);
2374
2375 srcBitsLeft = bit_size;
2376 src_bytes_left = src_len;
2377 unpacked_bytes_left = unpacked_len;
2378 sign = 0;
2379
2380 if (is_big_endian)
2381 {
2382 src_idx = src_len - 1;
2383 if (is_signed_type
2384 && ((src[0] << bit_offset) & (1 << (HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1))))
2385 sign = ~0;
2386
2387 unusedLS =
2388 (HOST_CHAR_BIT - (bit_size + bit_offset) % HOST_CHAR_BIT)
2389 % HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2390
2391 if (is_scalar)
2392 {
2393 accumSize = 0;
2394 unpacked_idx = unpacked_len - 1;
2395 }
2396 else
2397 {
2398 /* Non-scalar values must be aligned at a byte boundary... */
2399 accumSize =
2400 (HOST_CHAR_BIT - bit_size % HOST_CHAR_BIT) % HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2401 /* ... And are placed at the beginning (most-significant) bytes
2402 of the target. */
2403 unpacked_idx = (bit_size + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1;
2404 unpacked_bytes_left = unpacked_idx + 1;
2405 }
2406 }
2407 else
2408 {
2409 int sign_bit_offset = (bit_size + bit_offset - 1) % 8;
2410
2411 src_idx = unpacked_idx = 0;
2412 unusedLS = bit_offset;
2413 accumSize = 0;
2414
2415 if (is_signed_type && (src[src_len - 1] & (1 << sign_bit_offset)))
2416 sign = ~0;
2417 }
2418
2419 accum = 0;
2420 while (src_bytes_left > 0)
2421 {
2422 /* Mask for removing bits of the next source byte that are not
2423 part of the value. */
2424 unsigned int unusedMSMask =
2425 (1 << (srcBitsLeft >= HOST_CHAR_BIT ? HOST_CHAR_BIT : srcBitsLeft)) -
2426 1;
2427 /* Sign-extend bits for this byte. */
2428 unsigned int signMask = sign & ~unusedMSMask;
2429
2430 accum |=
2431 (((src[src_idx] >> unusedLS) & unusedMSMask) | signMask) << accumSize;
2432 accumSize += HOST_CHAR_BIT - unusedLS;
2433 if (accumSize >= HOST_CHAR_BIT)
2434 {
2435 unpacked[unpacked_idx] = accum & ~(~0UL << HOST_CHAR_BIT);
2436 accumSize -= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2437 accum >>= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2438 unpacked_bytes_left -= 1;
2439 unpacked_idx += delta;
2440 }
2441 srcBitsLeft -= HOST_CHAR_BIT - unusedLS;
2442 unusedLS = 0;
2443 src_bytes_left -= 1;
2444 src_idx += delta;
2445 }
2446 while (unpacked_bytes_left > 0)
2447 {
2448 accum |= sign << accumSize;
2449 unpacked[unpacked_idx] = accum & ~(~0UL << HOST_CHAR_BIT);
2450 accumSize -= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2451 if (accumSize < 0)
2452 accumSize = 0;
2453 accum >>= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2454 unpacked_bytes_left -= 1;
2455 unpacked_idx += delta;
2456 }
2457 }
2458
2459 /* Create a new value of type TYPE from the contents of OBJ starting
2460 at byte OFFSET, and bit offset BIT_OFFSET within that byte,
2461 proceeding for BIT_SIZE bits. If OBJ is an lval in memory, then
2462 assigning through the result will set the field fetched from.
2463 VALADDR is ignored unless OBJ is NULL, in which case,
2464 VALADDR+OFFSET must address the start of storage containing the
2465 packed value. The value returned in this case is never an lval.
2466 Assumes 0 <= BIT_OFFSET < HOST_CHAR_BIT. */
2467
2468 struct value *
2469 ada_value_primitive_packed_val (struct value *obj, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
2470 long offset, int bit_offset, int bit_size,
2471 struct type *type)
2472 {
2473 struct value *v;
2474 const gdb_byte *src; /* First byte containing data to unpack */
2475 gdb_byte *unpacked;
2476 const int is_scalar = is_scalar_type (type);
2477 const int is_big_endian = type_byte_order (type) == BFD_ENDIAN_BIG;
2478 gdb::byte_vector staging;
2479
2480 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
2481
2482 if (obj == NULL)
2483 src = valaddr + offset;
2484 else
2485 src = value_contents (obj) + offset;
2486
2487 if (is_dynamic_type (type))
2488 {
2489 /* The length of TYPE might by dynamic, so we need to resolve
2490 TYPE in order to know its actual size, which we then use
2491 to create the contents buffer of the value we return.
2492 The difficulty is that the data containing our object is
2493 packed, and therefore maybe not at a byte boundary. So, what
2494 we do, is unpack the data into a byte-aligned buffer, and then
2495 use that buffer as our object's value for resolving the type. */
2496 int staging_len = (bit_size + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2497 staging.resize (staging_len);
2498
2499 ada_unpack_from_contents (src, bit_offset, bit_size,
2500 staging.data (), staging.size (),
2501 is_big_endian, has_negatives (type),
2502 is_scalar);
2503 type = resolve_dynamic_type (type, staging, 0);
2504 if (TYPE_LENGTH (type) < (bit_size + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT)
2505 {
2506 /* This happens when the length of the object is dynamic,
2507 and is actually smaller than the space reserved for it.
2508 For instance, in an array of variant records, the bit_size
2509 we're given is the array stride, which is constant and
2510 normally equal to the maximum size of its element.
2511 But, in reality, each element only actually spans a portion
2512 of that stride. */
2513 bit_size = TYPE_LENGTH (type) * HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2514 }
2515 }
2516
2517 if (obj == NULL)
2518 {
2519 v = allocate_value (type);
2520 src = valaddr + offset;
2521 }
2522 else if (VALUE_LVAL (obj) == lval_memory && value_lazy (obj))
2523 {
2524 int src_len = (bit_size + bit_offset + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / 8;
2525 gdb_byte *buf;
2526
2527 v = value_at (type, value_address (obj) + offset);
2528 buf = (gdb_byte *) alloca (src_len);
2529 read_memory (value_address (v), buf, src_len);
2530 src = buf;
2531 }
2532 else
2533 {
2534 v = allocate_value (type);
2535 src = value_contents (obj) + offset;
2536 }
2537
2538 if (obj != NULL)
2539 {
2540 long new_offset = offset;
2541
2542 set_value_component_location (v, obj);
2543 set_value_bitpos (v, bit_offset + value_bitpos (obj));
2544 set_value_bitsize (v, bit_size);
2545 if (value_bitpos (v) >= HOST_CHAR_BIT)
2546 {
2547 ++new_offset;
2548 set_value_bitpos (v, value_bitpos (v) - HOST_CHAR_BIT);
2549 }
2550 set_value_offset (v, new_offset);
2551
2552 /* Also set the parent value. This is needed when trying to
2553 assign a new value (in inferior memory). */
2554 set_value_parent (v, obj);
2555 }
2556 else
2557 set_value_bitsize (v, bit_size);
2558 unpacked = value_contents_writeable (v);
2559
2560 if (bit_size == 0)
2561 {
2562 memset (unpacked, 0, TYPE_LENGTH (type));
2563 return v;
2564 }
2565
2566 if (staging.size () == TYPE_LENGTH (type))
2567 {
2568 /* Small short-cut: If we've unpacked the data into a buffer
2569 of the same size as TYPE's length, then we can reuse that,
2570 instead of doing the unpacking again. */
2571 memcpy (unpacked, staging.data (), staging.size ());
2572 }
2573 else
2574 ada_unpack_from_contents (src, bit_offset, bit_size,
2575 unpacked, TYPE_LENGTH (type),
2576 is_big_endian, has_negatives (type), is_scalar);
2577
2578 return v;
2579 }
2580
2581 /* Store the contents of FROMVAL into the location of TOVAL.
2582 Return a new value with the location of TOVAL and contents of
2583 FROMVAL. Handles assignment into packed fields that have
2584 floating-point or non-scalar types. */
2585
2586 static struct value *
2587 ada_value_assign (struct value *toval, struct value *fromval)
2588 {
2589 struct type *type = value_type (toval);
2590 int bits = value_bitsize (toval);
2591
2592 toval = ada_coerce_ref (toval);
2593 fromval = ada_coerce_ref (fromval);
2594
2595 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (toval)))
2596 toval = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (toval);
2597 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (fromval)))
2598 fromval = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (fromval);
2599
2600 if (!deprecated_value_modifiable (toval))
2601 error (_("Left operand of assignment is not a modifiable lvalue."));
2602
2603 if (VALUE_LVAL (toval) == lval_memory
2604 && bits > 0
2605 && (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_FLT
2606 || type->code () == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT))
2607 {
2608 int len = (value_bitpos (toval)
2609 + bits + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2610 int from_size;
2611 gdb_byte *buffer = (gdb_byte *) alloca (len);
2612 struct value *val;
2613 CORE_ADDR to_addr = value_address (toval);
2614
2615 if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_FLT)
2616 fromval = value_cast (type, fromval);
2617
2618 read_memory (to_addr, buffer, len);
2619 from_size = value_bitsize (fromval);
2620 if (from_size == 0)
2621 from_size = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (fromval)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
2622
2623 const int is_big_endian = type_byte_order (type) == BFD_ENDIAN_BIG;
2624 ULONGEST from_offset = 0;
2625 if (is_big_endian && is_scalar_type (value_type (fromval)))
2626 from_offset = from_size - bits;
2627 copy_bitwise (buffer, value_bitpos (toval),
2628 value_contents (fromval), from_offset,
2629 bits, is_big_endian);
2630 write_memory_with_notification (to_addr, buffer, len);
2631
2632 val = value_copy (toval);
2633 memcpy (value_contents_raw (val), value_contents (fromval),
2634 TYPE_LENGTH (type));
2635 deprecated_set_value_type (val, type);
2636
2637 return val;
2638 }
2639
2640 return value_assign (toval, fromval);
2641 }
2642
2643
2644 /* Given that COMPONENT is a memory lvalue that is part of the lvalue
2645 CONTAINER, assign the contents of VAL to COMPONENTS's place in
2646 CONTAINER. Modifies the VALUE_CONTENTS of CONTAINER only, not
2647 COMPONENT, and not the inferior's memory. The current contents
2648 of COMPONENT are ignored.
2649
2650 Although not part of the initial design, this function also works
2651 when CONTAINER and COMPONENT are not_lval's: it works as if CONTAINER
2652 had a null address, and COMPONENT had an address which is equal to
2653 its offset inside CONTAINER. */
2654
2655 static void
2656 value_assign_to_component (struct value *container, struct value *component,
2657 struct value *val)
2658 {
2659 LONGEST offset_in_container =
2660 (LONGEST) (value_address (component) - value_address (container));
2661 int bit_offset_in_container =
2662 value_bitpos (component) - value_bitpos (container);
2663 int bits;
2664
2665 val = value_cast (value_type (component), val);
2666
2667 if (value_bitsize (component) == 0)
2668 bits = TARGET_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (component));
2669 else
2670 bits = value_bitsize (component);
2671
2672 if (type_byte_order (value_type (container)) == BFD_ENDIAN_BIG)
2673 {
2674 int src_offset;
2675
2676 if (is_scalar_type (check_typedef (value_type (component))))
2677 src_offset
2678 = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (component)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT - bits;
2679 else
2680 src_offset = 0;
2681 copy_bitwise (value_contents_writeable (container) + offset_in_container,
2682 value_bitpos (container) + bit_offset_in_container,
2683 value_contents (val), src_offset, bits, 1);
2684 }
2685 else
2686 copy_bitwise (value_contents_writeable (container) + offset_in_container,
2687 value_bitpos (container) + bit_offset_in_container,
2688 value_contents (val), 0, bits, 0);
2689 }
2690
2691 /* Determine if TYPE is an access to an unconstrained array. */
2692
2693 bool
2694 ada_is_access_to_unconstrained_array (struct type *type)
2695 {
2696 return (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
2697 && is_thick_pntr (ada_typedef_target_type (type)));
2698 }
2699
2700 /* The value of the element of array ARR at the ARITY indices given in IND.
2701 ARR may be either a simple array, GNAT array descriptor, or pointer
2702 thereto. */
2703
2704 struct value *
2705 ada_value_subscript (struct value *arr, int arity, struct value **ind)
2706 {
2707 int k;
2708 struct value *elt;
2709 struct type *elt_type;
2710
2711 elt = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arr);
2712
2713 elt_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (elt));
2714 if (elt_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
2715 && TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0) > 0)
2716 return value_subscript_packed (elt, arity, ind);
2717
2718 for (k = 0; k < arity; k += 1)
2719 {
2720 struct type *saved_elt_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type);
2721
2722 if (elt_type->code () != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2723 error (_("too many subscripts (%d expected)"), k);
2724
2725 elt = value_subscript (elt, pos_atr (ind[k]));
2726
2727 if (ada_is_access_to_unconstrained_array (saved_elt_type)
2728 && value_type (elt)->code () != TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
2729 {
2730 /* The element is a typedef to an unconstrained array,
2731 except that the value_subscript call stripped the
2732 typedef layer. The typedef layer is GNAT's way to
2733 specify that the element is, at the source level, an
2734 access to the unconstrained array, rather than the
2735 unconstrained array. So, we need to restore that
2736 typedef layer, which we can do by forcing the element's
2737 type back to its original type. Otherwise, the returned
2738 value is going to be printed as the array, rather
2739 than as an access. Another symptom of the same issue
2740 would be that an expression trying to dereference the
2741 element would also be improperly rejected. */
2742 deprecated_set_value_type (elt, saved_elt_type);
2743 }
2744
2745 elt_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (elt));
2746 }
2747
2748 return elt;
2749 }
2750
2751 /* Assuming ARR is a pointer to a GDB array, the value of the element
2752 of *ARR at the ARITY indices given in IND.
2753 Does not read the entire array into memory.
2754
2755 Note: Unlike what one would expect, this function is used instead of
2756 ada_value_subscript for basically all non-packed array types. The reason
2757 for this is that a side effect of doing our own pointer arithmetics instead
2758 of relying on value_subscript is that there is no implicit typedef peeling.
2759 This is important for arrays of array accesses, where it allows us to
2760 preserve the fact that the array's element is an array access, where the
2761 access part os encoded in a typedef layer. */
2762
2763 static struct value *
2764 ada_value_ptr_subscript (struct value *arr, int arity, struct value **ind)
2765 {
2766 int k;
2767 struct value *array_ind = ada_value_ind (arr);
2768 struct type *type
2769 = check_typedef (value_enclosing_type (array_ind));
2770
2771 if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
2772 && TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 0) > 0)
2773 return value_subscript_packed (array_ind, arity, ind);
2774
2775 for (k = 0; k < arity; k += 1)
2776 {
2777 LONGEST lwb, upb;
2778 struct value *lwb_value;
2779
2780 if (type->code () != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2781 error (_("too many subscripts (%d expected)"), k);
2782 arr = value_cast (lookup_pointer_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)),
2783 value_copy (arr));
2784 get_discrete_bounds (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type), &lwb, &upb);
2785 lwb_value = value_from_longest (value_type (ind[k]), lwb);
2786 arr = value_ptradd (arr, pos_atr (ind[k]) - pos_atr (lwb_value));
2787 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
2788 }
2789
2790 return value_ind (arr);
2791 }
2792
2793 /* Given that ARRAY_PTR is a pointer or reference to an array of type TYPE (the
2794 actual type of ARRAY_PTR is ignored), returns the Ada slice of
2795 HIGH'Pos-LOW'Pos+1 elements starting at index LOW. The lower bound of
2796 this array is LOW, as per Ada rules. */
2797 static struct value *
2798 ada_value_slice_from_ptr (struct value *array_ptr, struct type *type,
2799 int low, int high)
2800 {
2801 struct type *type0 = ada_check_typedef (type);
2802 struct type *base_index_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type0));
2803 struct type *index_type
2804 = create_static_range_type (NULL, base_index_type, low, high);
2805 struct type *slice_type = create_array_type_with_stride
2806 (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0), index_type,
2807 type0->dyn_prop (DYN_PROP_BYTE_STRIDE),
2808 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type0, 0));
2809 int base_low = ada_discrete_type_low_bound (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type0));
2810 LONGEST base_low_pos, low_pos;
2811 CORE_ADDR base;
2812
2813 if (!discrete_position (base_index_type, low, &low_pos)
2814 || !discrete_position (base_index_type, base_low, &base_low_pos))
2815 {
2816 warning (_("unable to get positions in slice, use bounds instead"));
2817 low_pos = low;
2818 base_low_pos = base_low;
2819 }
2820
2821 base = value_as_address (array_ptr)
2822 + ((low_pos - base_low_pos)
2823 * TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0)));
2824 return value_at_lazy (slice_type, base);
2825 }
2826
2827
2828 static struct value *
2829 ada_value_slice (struct value *array, int low, int high)
2830 {
2831 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (array));
2832 struct type *base_index_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type));
2833 struct type *index_type
2834 = create_static_range_type (NULL, TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type), low, high);
2835 struct type *slice_type = create_array_type_with_stride
2836 (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), index_type,
2837 type->dyn_prop (DYN_PROP_BYTE_STRIDE),
2838 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 0));
2839 LONGEST low_pos, high_pos;
2840
2841 if (!discrete_position (base_index_type, low, &low_pos)
2842 || !discrete_position (base_index_type, high, &high_pos))
2843 {
2844 warning (_("unable to get positions in slice, use bounds instead"));
2845 low_pos = low;
2846 high_pos = high;
2847 }
2848
2849 return value_cast (slice_type,
2850 value_slice (array, low, high_pos - low_pos + 1));
2851 }
2852
2853 /* If type is a record type in the form of a standard GNAT array
2854 descriptor, returns the number of dimensions for type. If arr is a
2855 simple array, returns the number of "array of"s that prefix its
2856 type designation. Otherwise, returns 0. */
2857
2858 int
2859 ada_array_arity (struct type *type)
2860 {
2861 int arity;
2862
2863 if (type == NULL)
2864 return 0;
2865
2866 type = desc_base_type (type);
2867
2868 arity = 0;
2869 if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
2870 return desc_arity (desc_bounds_type (type));
2871 else
2872 while (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2873 {
2874 arity += 1;
2875 type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
2876 }
2877
2878 return arity;
2879 }
2880
2881 /* If TYPE is a record type in the form of a standard GNAT array
2882 descriptor or a simple array type, returns the element type for
2883 TYPE after indexing by NINDICES indices, or by all indices if
2884 NINDICES is -1. Otherwise, returns NULL. */
2885
2886 struct type *
2887 ada_array_element_type (struct type *type, int nindices)
2888 {
2889 type = desc_base_type (type);
2890
2891 if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
2892 {
2893 int k;
2894 struct type *p_array_type;
2895
2896 p_array_type = desc_data_target_type (type);
2897
2898 k = ada_array_arity (type);
2899 if (k == 0)
2900 return NULL;
2901
2902 /* Initially p_array_type = elt_type(*)[]...(k times)...[]. */
2903 if (nindices >= 0 && k > nindices)
2904 k = nindices;
2905 while (k > 0 && p_array_type != NULL)
2906 {
2907 p_array_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (p_array_type));
2908 k -= 1;
2909 }
2910 return p_array_type;
2911 }
2912 else if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2913 {
2914 while (nindices != 0 && type->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2915 {
2916 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
2917 nindices -= 1;
2918 }
2919 return type;
2920 }
2921
2922 return NULL;
2923 }
2924
2925 /* The type of nth index in arrays of given type (n numbering from 1).
2926 Does not examine memory. Throws an error if N is invalid or TYPE
2927 is not an array type. NAME is the name of the Ada attribute being
2928 evaluated ('range, 'first, 'last, or 'length); it is used in building
2929 the error message. */
2930
2931 static struct type *
2932 ada_index_type (struct type *type, int n, const char *name)
2933 {
2934 struct type *result_type;
2935
2936 type = desc_base_type (type);
2937
2938 if (n < 0 || n > ada_array_arity (type))
2939 error (_("invalid dimension number to '%s"), name);
2940
2941 if (ada_is_simple_array_type (type))
2942 {
2943 int i;
2944
2945 for (i = 1; i < n; i += 1)
2946 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
2947 result_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type));
2948 /* FIXME: The stabs type r(0,0);bound;bound in an array type
2949 has a target type of TYPE_CODE_UNDEF. We compensate here, but
2950 perhaps stabsread.c would make more sense. */
2951 if (result_type && result_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_UNDEF)
2952 result_type = NULL;
2953 }
2954 else
2955 {
2956 result_type = desc_index_type (desc_bounds_type (type), n);
2957 if (result_type == NULL)
2958 error (_("attempt to take bound of something that is not an array"));
2959 }
2960
2961 return result_type;
2962 }
2963
2964 /* Given that arr is an array type, returns the lower bound of the
2965 Nth index (numbering from 1) if WHICH is 0, and the upper bound if
2966 WHICH is 1. This returns bounds 0 .. -1 if ARR_TYPE is an
2967 array-descriptor type. It works for other arrays with bounds supplied
2968 by run-time quantities other than discriminants. */
2969
2970 static LONGEST
2971 ada_array_bound_from_type (struct type *arr_type, int n, int which)
2972 {
2973 struct type *type, *index_type_desc, *index_type;
2974 int i;
2975
2976 gdb_assert (which == 0 || which == 1);
2977
2978 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (arr_type))
2979 arr_type = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (arr_type);
2980
2981 if (arr_type == NULL || !ada_is_simple_array_type (arr_type))
2982 return (LONGEST) - which;
2983
2984 if (arr_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
2985 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (arr_type);
2986 else
2987 type = arr_type;
2988
2989 if (TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type))
2990 {
2991 /* The array has already been fixed, so we do not need to
2992 check the parallel ___XA type again. That encoding has
2993 already been applied, so ignore it now. */
2994 index_type_desc = NULL;
2995 }
2996 else
2997 {
2998 index_type_desc = ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XA");
2999 ada_fixup_array_indexes_type (index_type_desc);
3000 }
3001
3002 if (index_type_desc != NULL)
3003 index_type = to_fixed_range_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_type_desc, n - 1),
3004 NULL);
3005 else
3006 {
3007 struct type *elt_type = check_typedef (type);
3008
3009 for (i = 1; i < n; i++)
3010 elt_type = check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type));
3011
3012 index_type = TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (elt_type);
3013 }
3014
3015 return
3016 (LONGEST) (which == 0
3017 ? ada_discrete_type_low_bound (index_type)
3018 : ada_discrete_type_high_bound (index_type));
3019 }
3020
3021 /* Given that arr is an array value, returns the lower bound of the
3022 nth index (numbering from 1) if WHICH is 0, and the upper bound if
3023 WHICH is 1. This routine will also work for arrays with bounds
3024 supplied by run-time quantities other than discriminants. */
3025
3026 static LONGEST
3027 ada_array_bound (struct value *arr, int n, int which)
3028 {
3029 struct type *arr_type;
3030
3031 if (check_typedef (value_type (arr))->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
3032 arr = value_ind (arr);
3033 arr_type = value_enclosing_type (arr);
3034
3035 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (arr_type))
3036 return ada_array_bound (decode_constrained_packed_array (arr), n, which);
3037 else if (ada_is_simple_array_type (arr_type))
3038 return ada_array_bound_from_type (arr_type, n, which);
3039 else
3040 return value_as_long (desc_one_bound (desc_bounds (arr), n, which));
3041 }
3042
3043 /* Given that arr is an array value, returns the length of the
3044 nth index. This routine will also work for arrays with bounds
3045 supplied by run-time quantities other than discriminants.
3046 Does not work for arrays indexed by enumeration types with representation
3047 clauses at the moment. */
3048
3049 static LONGEST
3050 ada_array_length (struct value *arr, int n)
3051 {
3052 struct type *arr_type, *index_type;
3053 int low, high;
3054
3055 if (check_typedef (value_type (arr))->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
3056 arr = value_ind (arr);
3057 arr_type = value_enclosing_type (arr);
3058
3059 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (arr_type))
3060 return ada_array_length (decode_constrained_packed_array (arr), n);
3061
3062 if (ada_is_simple_array_type (arr_type))
3063 {
3064 low = ada_array_bound_from_type (arr_type, n, 0);
3065 high = ada_array_bound_from_type (arr_type, n, 1);
3066 }
3067 else
3068 {
3069 low = value_as_long (desc_one_bound (desc_bounds (arr), n, 0));
3070 high = value_as_long (desc_one_bound (desc_bounds (arr), n, 1));
3071 }
3072
3073 arr_type = check_typedef (arr_type);
3074 index_type = ada_index_type (arr_type, n, "length");
3075 if (index_type != NULL)
3076 {
3077 struct type *base_type;
3078 if (index_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_RANGE)
3079 base_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (index_type);
3080 else
3081 base_type = index_type;
3082
3083 low = pos_atr (value_from_longest (base_type, low));
3084 high = pos_atr (value_from_longest (base_type, high));
3085 }
3086 return high - low + 1;
3087 }
3088
3089 /* An array whose type is that of ARR_TYPE (an array type), with
3090 bounds LOW to HIGH, but whose contents are unimportant. If HIGH is
3091 less than LOW, then LOW-1 is used. */
3092
3093 static struct value *
3094 empty_array (struct type *arr_type, int low, int high)
3095 {
3096 struct type *arr_type0 = ada_check_typedef (arr_type);
3097 struct type *index_type
3098 = create_static_range_type
3099 (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (arr_type0)), low,
3100 high < low ? low - 1 : high);
3101 struct type *elt_type = ada_array_element_type (arr_type0, 1);
3102
3103 return allocate_value (create_array_type (NULL, elt_type, index_type));
3104 }
3105 \f
3106
3107 /* Name resolution */
3108
3109 /* The "decoded" name for the user-definable Ada operator corresponding
3110 to OP. */
3111
3112 static const char *
3113 ada_decoded_op_name (enum exp_opcode op)
3114 {
3115 int i;
3116
3117 for (i = 0; ada_opname_table[i].encoded != NULL; i += 1)
3118 {
3119 if (ada_opname_table[i].op == op)
3120 return ada_opname_table[i].decoded;
3121 }
3122 error (_("Could not find operator name for opcode"));
3123 }
3124
3125 /* Returns true (non-zero) iff decoded name N0 should appear before N1
3126 in a listing of choices during disambiguation (see sort_choices, below).
3127 The idea is that overloadings of a subprogram name from the
3128 same package should sort in their source order. We settle for ordering
3129 such symbols by their trailing number (__N or $N). */
3130
3131 static int
3132 encoded_ordered_before (const char *N0, const char *N1)
3133 {
3134 if (N1 == NULL)
3135 return 0;
3136 else if (N0 == NULL)
3137 return 1;
3138 else
3139 {
3140 int k0, k1;
3141
3142 for (k0 = strlen (N0) - 1; k0 > 0 && isdigit (N0[k0]); k0 -= 1)
3143 ;
3144 for (k1 = strlen (N1) - 1; k1 > 0 && isdigit (N1[k1]); k1 -= 1)
3145 ;
3146 if ((N0[k0] == '_' || N0[k0] == '$') && N0[k0 + 1] != '\000'
3147 && (N1[k1] == '_' || N1[k1] == '$') && N1[k1 + 1] != '\000')
3148 {
3149 int n0, n1;
3150
3151 n0 = k0;
3152 while (N0[n0] == '_' && n0 > 0 && N0[n0 - 1] == '_')
3153 n0 -= 1;
3154 n1 = k1;
3155 while (N1[n1] == '_' && n1 > 0 && N1[n1 - 1] == '_')
3156 n1 -= 1;
3157 if (n0 == n1 && strncmp (N0, N1, n0) == 0)
3158 return (atoi (N0 + k0 + 1) < atoi (N1 + k1 + 1));
3159 }
3160 return (strcmp (N0, N1) < 0);
3161 }
3162 }
3163
3164 /* Sort SYMS[0..NSYMS-1] to put the choices in a canonical order by the
3165 encoded names. */
3166
3167 static void
3168 sort_choices (struct block_symbol syms[], int nsyms)
3169 {
3170 int i;
3171
3172 for (i = 1; i < nsyms; i += 1)
3173 {
3174 struct block_symbol sym = syms[i];
3175 int j;
3176
3177 for (j = i - 1; j >= 0; j -= 1)
3178 {
3179 if (encoded_ordered_before (syms[j].symbol->linkage_name (),
3180 sym.symbol->linkage_name ()))
3181 break;
3182 syms[j + 1] = syms[j];
3183 }
3184 syms[j + 1] = sym;
3185 }
3186 }
3187
3188 /* Whether GDB should display formals and return types for functions in the
3189 overloads selection menu. */
3190 static bool print_signatures = true;
3191
3192 /* Print the signature for SYM on STREAM according to the FLAGS options. For
3193 all but functions, the signature is just the name of the symbol. For
3194 functions, this is the name of the function, the list of types for formals
3195 and the return type (if any). */
3196
3197 static void
3198 ada_print_symbol_signature (struct ui_file *stream, struct symbol *sym,
3199 const struct type_print_options *flags)
3200 {
3201 struct type *type = SYMBOL_TYPE (sym);
3202
3203 fprintf_filtered (stream, "%s", sym->print_name ());
3204 if (!print_signatures
3205 || type == NULL
3206 || type->code () != TYPE_CODE_FUNC)
3207 return;
3208
3209 if (TYPE_NFIELDS (type) > 0)
3210 {
3211 int i;
3212
3213 fprintf_filtered (stream, " (");
3214 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); ++i)
3215 {
3216 if (i > 0)
3217 fprintf_filtered (stream, "; ");
3218 ada_print_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i), NULL, stream, -1, 0,
3219 flags);
3220 }
3221 fprintf_filtered (stream, ")");
3222 }
3223 if (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) != NULL
3224 && TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)->code () != TYPE_CODE_VOID)
3225 {
3226 fprintf_filtered (stream, " return ");
3227 ada_print_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), NULL, stream, -1, 0, flags);
3228 }
3229 }
3230
3231 /* Read and validate a set of numeric choices from the user in the
3232 range 0 .. N_CHOICES-1. Place the results in increasing
3233 order in CHOICES[0 .. N-1], and return N.
3234
3235 The user types choices as a sequence of numbers on one line
3236 separated by blanks, encoding them as follows:
3237
3238 + A choice of 0 means to cancel the selection, throwing an error.
3239 + If IS_ALL_CHOICE, a choice of 1 selects the entire set 0 .. N_CHOICES-1.
3240 + The user chooses k by typing k+IS_ALL_CHOICE+1.
3241
3242 The user is not allowed to choose more than MAX_RESULTS values.
3243
3244 ANNOTATION_SUFFIX, if present, is used to annotate the input
3245 prompts (for use with the -f switch). */
3246
3247 static int
3248 get_selections (int *choices, int n_choices, int max_results,
3249 int is_all_choice, const char *annotation_suffix)
3250 {
3251 const char *args;
3252 const char *prompt;
3253 int n_chosen;
3254 int first_choice = is_all_choice ? 2 : 1;
3255
3256 prompt = getenv ("PS2");
3257 if (prompt == NULL)
3258 prompt = "> ";
3259
3260 args = command_line_input (prompt, annotation_suffix);
3261
3262 if (args == NULL)
3263 error_no_arg (_("one or more choice numbers"));
3264
3265 n_chosen = 0;
3266
3267 /* Set choices[0 .. n_chosen-1] to the users' choices in ascending
3268 order, as given in args. Choices are validated. */
3269 while (1)
3270 {
3271 char *args2;
3272 int choice, j;
3273
3274 args = skip_spaces (args);
3275 if (*args == '\0' && n_chosen == 0)
3276 error_no_arg (_("one or more choice numbers"));
3277 else if (*args == '\0')
3278 break;
3279
3280 choice = strtol (args, &args2, 10);
3281 if (args == args2 || choice < 0
3282 || choice > n_choices + first_choice - 1)
3283 error (_("Argument must be choice number"));
3284 args = args2;
3285
3286 if (choice == 0)
3287 error (_("cancelled"));
3288
3289 if (choice < first_choice)
3290 {
3291 n_chosen = n_choices;
3292 for (j = 0; j < n_choices; j += 1)
3293 choices[j] = j;
3294 break;
3295 }
3296 choice -= first_choice;
3297
3298 for (j = n_chosen - 1; j >= 0 && choice < choices[j]; j -= 1)
3299 {
3300 }
3301
3302 if (j < 0 || choice != choices[j])
3303 {
3304 int k;
3305
3306 for (k = n_chosen - 1; k > j; k -= 1)
3307 choices[k + 1] = choices[k];
3308 choices[j + 1] = choice;
3309 n_chosen += 1;
3310 }
3311 }
3312
3313 if (n_chosen > max_results)
3314 error (_("Select no more than %d of the above"), max_results);
3315
3316 return n_chosen;
3317 }
3318
3319 /* Given a list of NSYMS symbols in SYMS, select up to MAX_RESULTS>0
3320 by asking the user (if necessary), returning the number selected,
3321 and setting the first elements of SYMS items. Error if no symbols
3322 selected. */
3323
3324 /* NOTE: Adapted from decode_line_2 in symtab.c, with which it ought
3325 to be re-integrated one of these days. */
3326
3327 static int
3328 user_select_syms (struct block_symbol *syms, int nsyms, int max_results)
3329 {
3330 int i;
3331 int *chosen = XALLOCAVEC (int , nsyms);
3332 int n_chosen;
3333 int first_choice = (max_results == 1) ? 1 : 2;
3334 const char *select_mode = multiple_symbols_select_mode ();
3335
3336 if (max_results < 1)
3337 error (_("Request to select 0 symbols!"));
3338 if (nsyms <= 1)
3339 return nsyms;
3340
3341 if (select_mode == multiple_symbols_cancel)
3342 error (_("\
3343 canceled because the command is ambiguous\n\
3344 See set/show multiple-symbol."));
3345
3346 /* If select_mode is "all", then return all possible symbols.
3347 Only do that if more than one symbol can be selected, of course.
3348 Otherwise, display the menu as usual. */
3349 if (select_mode == multiple_symbols_all && max_results > 1)
3350 return nsyms;
3351
3352 printf_filtered (_("[0] cancel\n"));
3353 if (max_results > 1)
3354 printf_filtered (_("[1] all\n"));
3355
3356 sort_choices (syms, nsyms);
3357
3358 for (i = 0; i < nsyms; i += 1)
3359 {
3360 if (syms[i].symbol == NULL)
3361 continue;
3362
3363 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].symbol) == LOC_BLOCK)
3364 {
3365 struct symtab_and_line sal =
3366 find_function_start_sal (syms[i].symbol, 1);
3367
3368 printf_filtered ("[%d] ", i + first_choice);
3369 ada_print_symbol_signature (gdb_stdout, syms[i].symbol,
3370 &type_print_raw_options);
3371 if (sal.symtab == NULL)
3372 printf_filtered (_(" at %p[<no source file available>%p]:%d\n"),
3373 metadata_style.style ().ptr (), nullptr, sal.line);
3374 else
3375 printf_filtered
3376 (_(" at %ps:%d\n"),
3377 styled_string (file_name_style.style (),
3378 symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal.symtab)),
3379 sal.line);
3380 continue;
3381 }
3382 else
3383 {
3384 int is_enumeral =
3385 (SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].symbol) == LOC_CONST
3386 && SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].symbol) != NULL
3387 && SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].symbol)->code () == TYPE_CODE_ENUM);
3388 struct symtab *symtab = NULL;
3389
3390 if (SYMBOL_OBJFILE_OWNED (syms[i].symbol))
3391 symtab = symbol_symtab (syms[i].symbol);
3392
3393 if (SYMBOL_LINE (syms[i].symbol) != 0 && symtab != NULL)
3394 {
3395 printf_filtered ("[%d] ", i + first_choice);
3396 ada_print_symbol_signature (gdb_stdout, syms[i].symbol,
3397 &type_print_raw_options);
3398 printf_filtered (_(" at %s:%d\n"),
3399 symtab_to_filename_for_display (symtab),
3400 SYMBOL_LINE (syms[i].symbol));
3401 }
3402 else if (is_enumeral
3403 && SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].symbol)->name () != NULL)
3404 {
3405 printf_filtered (("[%d] "), i + first_choice);
3406 ada_print_type (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].symbol), NULL,
3407 gdb_stdout, -1, 0, &type_print_raw_options);
3408 printf_filtered (_("'(%s) (enumeral)\n"),
3409 syms[i].symbol->print_name ());
3410 }
3411 else
3412 {
3413 printf_filtered ("[%d] ", i + first_choice);
3414 ada_print_symbol_signature (gdb_stdout, syms[i].symbol,
3415 &type_print_raw_options);
3416
3417 if (symtab != NULL)
3418 printf_filtered (is_enumeral
3419 ? _(" in %s (enumeral)\n")
3420 : _(" at %s:?\n"),
3421 symtab_to_filename_for_display (symtab));
3422 else
3423 printf_filtered (is_enumeral
3424 ? _(" (enumeral)\n")
3425 : _(" at ?\n"));
3426 }
3427 }
3428 }
3429
3430 n_chosen = get_selections (chosen, nsyms, max_results, max_results > 1,
3431 "overload-choice");
3432
3433 for (i = 0; i < n_chosen; i += 1)
3434 syms[i] = syms[chosen[i]];
3435
3436 return n_chosen;
3437 }
3438
3439 /* Same as evaluate_type (*EXP), but resolves ambiguous symbol
3440 references (marked by OP_VAR_VALUE nodes in which the symbol has an
3441 undefined namespace) and converts operators that are
3442 user-defined into appropriate function calls. If CONTEXT_TYPE is
3443 non-null, it provides a preferred result type [at the moment, only
3444 type void has any effect---causing procedures to be preferred over
3445 functions in calls]. A null CONTEXT_TYPE indicates that a non-void
3446 return type is preferred. May change (expand) *EXP. */
3447
3448 static void
3449 resolve (expression_up *expp, int void_context_p, int parse_completion,
3450 innermost_block_tracker *tracker)
3451 {
3452 struct type *context_type = NULL;
3453 int pc = 0;
3454
3455 if (void_context_p)
3456 context_type = builtin_type ((*expp)->gdbarch)->builtin_void;
3457
3458 resolve_subexp (expp, &pc, 1, context_type, parse_completion, tracker);
3459 }
3460
3461 /* Resolve the operator of the subexpression beginning at
3462 position *POS of *EXPP. "Resolving" consists of replacing
3463 the symbols that have undefined namespaces in OP_VAR_VALUE nodes
3464 with their resolutions, replacing built-in operators with
3465 function calls to user-defined operators, where appropriate, and,
3466 when DEPROCEDURE_P is non-zero, converting function-valued variables
3467 into parameterless calls. May expand *EXPP. The CONTEXT_TYPE functions
3468 are as in ada_resolve, above. */
3469
3470 static struct value *
3471 resolve_subexp (expression_up *expp, int *pos, int deprocedure_p,
3472 struct type *context_type, int parse_completion,
3473 innermost_block_tracker *tracker)
3474 {
3475 int pc = *pos;
3476 int i;
3477 struct expression *exp; /* Convenience: == *expp. */
3478 enum exp_opcode op = (*expp)->elts[pc].opcode;
3479 struct value **argvec; /* Vector of operand types (alloca'ed). */
3480 int nargs; /* Number of operands. */
3481 int oplen;
3482
3483 argvec = NULL;
3484 nargs = 0;
3485 exp = expp->get ();
3486
3487 /* Pass one: resolve operands, saving their types and updating *pos,
3488 if needed. */
3489 switch (op)
3490 {
3491 case OP_FUNCALL:
3492 if (exp->elts[pc + 3].opcode == OP_VAR_VALUE
3493 && SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
3494 *pos += 7;
3495 else
3496 {
3497 *pos += 3;
3498 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 0, NULL, parse_completion, tracker);
3499 }
3500 nargs = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
3501 break;
3502
3503 case UNOP_ADDR:
3504 *pos += 1;
3505 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 0, NULL, parse_completion, tracker);
3506 break;
3507
3508 case UNOP_QUAL:
3509 *pos += 3;
3510 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 1].type),
3511 parse_completion, tracker);
3512 break;
3513
3514 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
3515 case OP_ATR_SIZE:
3516 case OP_ATR_TAG:
3517 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
3518 case OP_ATR_LAST:
3519 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
3520 case OP_ATR_POS:
3521 case OP_ATR_VAL:
3522 case OP_ATR_MIN:
3523 case OP_ATR_MAX:
3524 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
3525 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
3526 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
3527 case OP_AGGREGATE:
3528 case OP_OTHERS:
3529 case OP_CHOICES:
3530 case OP_POSITIONAL:
3531 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
3532 case OP_NAME:
3533 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, pc, &oplen, &nargs);
3534 *pos += oplen;
3535 break;
3536
3537 case BINOP_ASSIGN:
3538 {
3539 struct value *arg1;
3540
3541 *pos += 1;
3542 arg1 = resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 0, NULL, parse_completion, tracker);
3543 if (arg1 == NULL)
3544 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, NULL, parse_completion, tracker);
3545 else
3546 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, value_type (arg1), parse_completion,
3547 tracker);
3548 break;
3549 }
3550
3551 case UNOP_CAST:
3552 *pos += 3;
3553 nargs = 1;
3554 break;
3555
3556 case BINOP_ADD:
3557 case BINOP_SUB:
3558 case BINOP_MUL:
3559 case BINOP_DIV:
3560 case BINOP_REM:
3561 case BINOP_MOD:
3562 case BINOP_EXP:
3563 case BINOP_CONCAT:
3564 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND:
3565 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR:
3566 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
3567 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
3568 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
3569
3570 case BINOP_EQUAL:
3571 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
3572 case BINOP_LESS:
3573 case BINOP_GTR:
3574 case BINOP_LEQ:
3575 case BINOP_GEQ:
3576
3577 case BINOP_REPEAT:
3578 case BINOP_SUBSCRIPT:
3579 case BINOP_COMMA:
3580 *pos += 1;
3581 nargs = 2;
3582 break;
3583
3584 case UNOP_NEG:
3585 case UNOP_PLUS:
3586 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
3587 case UNOP_ABS:
3588 case UNOP_IND:
3589 *pos += 1;
3590 nargs = 1;
3591 break;
3592
3593 case OP_LONG:
3594 case OP_FLOAT:
3595 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
3596 case OP_VAR_MSYM_VALUE:
3597 *pos += 4;
3598 break;
3599
3600 case OP_TYPE:
3601 case OP_BOOL:
3602 case OP_LAST:
3603 case OP_INTERNALVAR:
3604 *pos += 3;
3605 break;
3606
3607 case UNOP_MEMVAL:
3608 *pos += 3;
3609 nargs = 1;
3610 break;
3611
3612 case OP_REGISTER:
3613 *pos += 4 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst + 1);
3614 break;
3615
3616 case STRUCTOP_STRUCT:
3617 *pos += 4 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst + 1);
3618 nargs = 1;
3619 break;
3620
3621 case TERNOP_SLICE:
3622 *pos += 1;
3623 nargs = 3;
3624 break;
3625
3626 case OP_STRING:
3627 break;
3628
3629 default:
3630 error (_("Unexpected operator during name resolution"));
3631 }
3632
3633 argvec = XALLOCAVEC (struct value *, nargs + 1);
3634 for (i = 0; i < nargs; i += 1)
3635 argvec[i] = resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, NULL, parse_completion,
3636 tracker);
3637 argvec[i] = NULL;
3638 exp = expp->get ();
3639
3640 /* Pass two: perform any resolution on principal operator. */
3641 switch (op)
3642 {
3643 default:
3644 break;
3645
3646 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
3647 if (SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
3648 {
3649 std::vector<struct block_symbol> candidates;
3650 int n_candidates;
3651
3652 n_candidates =
3653 ada_lookup_symbol_list (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol->linkage_name (),
3654 exp->elts[pc + 1].block, VAR_DOMAIN,
3655 &candidates);
3656
3657 if (n_candidates > 1)
3658 {
3659 /* Types tend to get re-introduced locally, so if there
3660 are any local symbols that are not types, first filter
3661 out all types. */
3662 int j;
3663 for (j = 0; j < n_candidates; j += 1)
3664 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (candidates[j].symbol))
3665 {
3666 case LOC_REGISTER:
3667 case LOC_ARG:
3668 case LOC_REF_ARG:
3669 case LOC_REGPARM_ADDR:
3670 case LOC_LOCAL:
3671 case LOC_COMPUTED:
3672 goto FoundNonType;
3673 default:
3674 break;
3675 }
3676 FoundNonType:
3677 if (j < n_candidates)
3678 {
3679 j = 0;
3680 while (j < n_candidates)
3681 {
3682 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (candidates[j].symbol) == LOC_TYPEDEF)
3683 {
3684 candidates[j] = candidates[n_candidates - 1];
3685 n_candidates -= 1;
3686 }
3687 else
3688 j += 1;
3689 }
3690 }
3691 }
3692
3693 if (n_candidates == 0)
3694 error (_("No definition found for %s"),
3695 exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol->print_name ());
3696 else if (n_candidates == 1)
3697 i = 0;
3698 else if (deprocedure_p
3699 && !is_nonfunction (candidates.data (), n_candidates))
3700 {
3701 i = ada_resolve_function
3702 (candidates.data (), n_candidates, NULL, 0,
3703 exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol->linkage_name (),
3704 context_type, parse_completion);
3705 if (i < 0)
3706 error (_("Could not find a match for %s"),
3707 exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol->print_name ());
3708 }
3709 else
3710 {
3711 printf_filtered (_("Multiple matches for %s\n"),
3712 exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol->print_name ());
3713 user_select_syms (candidates.data (), n_candidates, 1);
3714 i = 0;
3715 }
3716
3717 exp->elts[pc + 1].block = candidates[i].block;
3718 exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol = candidates[i].symbol;
3719 tracker->update (candidates[i]);
3720 }
3721
3722 if (deprocedure_p
3723 && (SYMBOL_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol)->code ()
3724 == TYPE_CODE_FUNC))
3725 {
3726 replace_operator_with_call (expp, pc, 0, 4,
3727 exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol,
3728 exp->elts[pc + 1].block);
3729 exp = expp->get ();
3730 }
3731 break;
3732
3733 case OP_FUNCALL:
3734 {
3735 if (exp->elts[pc + 3].opcode == OP_VAR_VALUE
3736 && SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
3737 {
3738 std::vector<struct block_symbol> candidates;
3739 int n_candidates;
3740
3741 n_candidates =
3742 ada_lookup_symbol_list (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol->linkage_name (),
3743 exp->elts[pc + 4].block, VAR_DOMAIN,
3744 &candidates);
3745
3746 if (n_candidates == 1)
3747 i = 0;
3748 else
3749 {
3750 i = ada_resolve_function
3751 (candidates.data (), n_candidates,
3752 argvec, nargs,
3753 exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol->linkage_name (),
3754 context_type, parse_completion);
3755 if (i < 0)
3756 error (_("Could not find a match for %s"),
3757 exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol->print_name ());
3758 }
3759
3760 exp->elts[pc + 4].block = candidates[i].block;
3761 exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol = candidates[i].symbol;
3762 tracker->update (candidates[i]);
3763 }
3764 }
3765 break;
3766 case BINOP_ADD:
3767 case BINOP_SUB:
3768 case BINOP_MUL:
3769 case BINOP_DIV:
3770 case BINOP_REM:
3771 case BINOP_MOD:
3772 case BINOP_CONCAT:
3773 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
3774 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
3775 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
3776 case BINOP_EQUAL:
3777 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
3778 case BINOP_LESS:
3779 case BINOP_GTR:
3780 case BINOP_LEQ:
3781 case BINOP_GEQ:
3782 case BINOP_EXP:
3783 case UNOP_NEG:
3784 case UNOP_PLUS:
3785 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
3786 case UNOP_ABS:
3787 if (possible_user_operator_p (op, argvec))
3788 {
3789 std::vector<struct block_symbol> candidates;
3790 int n_candidates;
3791
3792 n_candidates =
3793 ada_lookup_symbol_list (ada_decoded_op_name (op),
3794 NULL, VAR_DOMAIN,
3795 &candidates);
3796
3797 i = ada_resolve_function (candidates.data (), n_candidates, argvec,
3798 nargs, ada_decoded_op_name (op), NULL,
3799 parse_completion);
3800 if (i < 0)
3801 break;
3802
3803 replace_operator_with_call (expp, pc, nargs, 1,
3804 candidates[i].symbol,
3805 candidates[i].block);
3806 exp = expp->get ();
3807 }
3808 break;
3809
3810 case OP_TYPE:
3811 case OP_REGISTER:
3812 return NULL;
3813 }
3814
3815 *pos = pc;
3816 if (exp->elts[pc].opcode == OP_VAR_MSYM_VALUE)
3817 return evaluate_var_msym_value (EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS,
3818 exp->elts[pc + 1].objfile,
3819 exp->elts[pc + 2].msymbol);
3820 else
3821 return evaluate_subexp_type (exp, pos);
3822 }
3823
3824 /* Return non-zero if formal type FTYPE matches actual type ATYPE. If
3825 MAY_DEREF is non-zero, the formal may be a pointer and the actual
3826 a non-pointer. */
3827 /* The term "match" here is rather loose. The match is heuristic and
3828 liberal. */
3829
3830 static int
3831 ada_type_match (struct type *ftype, struct type *atype, int may_deref)
3832 {
3833 ftype = ada_check_typedef (ftype);
3834 atype = ada_check_typedef (atype);
3835
3836 if (ftype->code () == TYPE_CODE_REF)
3837 ftype = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ftype);
3838 if (atype->code () == TYPE_CODE_REF)
3839 atype = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (atype);
3840
3841 switch (ftype->code ())
3842 {
3843 default:
3844 return ftype->code () == atype->code ();
3845 case TYPE_CODE_PTR:
3846 if (atype->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
3847 return ada_type_match (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ftype),
3848 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (atype), 0);
3849 else
3850 return (may_deref
3851 && ada_type_match (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ftype), atype, 0));
3852 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3853 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
3854 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3855 switch (atype->code ())
3856 {
3857 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3858 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
3859 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3860 return 1;
3861 default:
3862 return 0;
3863 }
3864
3865 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
3866 return (atype->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
3867 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (atype));
3868
3869 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
3870 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (ftype))
3871 return (atype->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
3872 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (atype));
3873 else
3874 return (atype->code () == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
3875 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (atype));
3876
3877 case TYPE_CODE_UNION:
3878 case TYPE_CODE_FLT:
3879 return (atype->code () == ftype->code ());
3880 }
3881 }
3882
3883 /* Return non-zero if the formals of FUNC "sufficiently match" the
3884 vector of actual argument types ACTUALS of size N_ACTUALS. FUNC
3885 may also be an enumeral, in which case it is treated as a 0-
3886 argument function. */
3887
3888 static int
3889 ada_args_match (struct symbol *func, struct value **actuals, int n_actuals)
3890 {
3891 int i;
3892 struct type *func_type = SYMBOL_TYPE (func);
3893
3894 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (func) == LOC_CONST
3895 && func_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
3896 return (n_actuals == 0);
3897 else if (func_type == NULL || func_type->code () != TYPE_CODE_FUNC)
3898 return 0;
3899
3900 if (TYPE_NFIELDS (func_type) != n_actuals)
3901 return 0;
3902
3903 for (i = 0; i < n_actuals; i += 1)
3904 {
3905 if (actuals[i] == NULL)
3906 return 0;
3907 else
3908 {
3909 struct type *ftype = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (func_type,
3910 i));
3911 struct type *atype = ada_check_typedef (value_type (actuals[i]));
3912
3913 if (!ada_type_match (ftype, atype, 1))
3914 return 0;
3915 }
3916 }
3917 return 1;
3918 }
3919
3920 /* False iff function type FUNC_TYPE definitely does not produce a value
3921 compatible with type CONTEXT_TYPE. Conservatively returns 1 if
3922 FUNC_TYPE is not a valid function type with a non-null return type
3923 or an enumerated type. A null CONTEXT_TYPE indicates any non-void type. */
3924
3925 static int
3926 return_match (struct type *func_type, struct type *context_type)
3927 {
3928 struct type *return_type;
3929
3930 if (func_type == NULL)
3931 return 1;
3932
3933 if (func_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_FUNC)
3934 return_type = get_base_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (func_type));
3935 else
3936 return_type = get_base_type (func_type);
3937 if (return_type == NULL)
3938 return 1;
3939
3940 context_type = get_base_type (context_type);
3941
3942 if (return_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
3943 return context_type == NULL || return_type == context_type;
3944 else if (context_type == NULL)
3945 return return_type->code () != TYPE_CODE_VOID;
3946 else
3947 return return_type->code () == context_type->code ();
3948 }
3949
3950
3951 /* Returns the index in SYMS[0..NSYMS-1] that contains the symbol for the
3952 function (if any) that matches the types of the NARGS arguments in
3953 ARGS. If CONTEXT_TYPE is non-null and there is at least one match
3954 that returns that type, then eliminate matches that don't. If
3955 CONTEXT_TYPE is void and there is at least one match that does not
3956 return void, eliminate all matches that do.
3957
3958 Asks the user if there is more than one match remaining. Returns -1
3959 if there is no such symbol or none is selected. NAME is used
3960 solely for messages. May re-arrange and modify SYMS in
3961 the process; the index returned is for the modified vector. */
3962
3963 static int
3964 ada_resolve_function (struct block_symbol syms[],
3965 int nsyms, struct value **args, int nargs,
3966 const char *name, struct type *context_type,
3967 int parse_completion)
3968 {
3969 int fallback;
3970 int k;
3971 int m; /* Number of hits */
3972
3973 m = 0;
3974 /* In the first pass of the loop, we only accept functions matching
3975 context_type. If none are found, we add a second pass of the loop
3976 where every function is accepted. */
3977 for (fallback = 0; m == 0 && fallback < 2; fallback++)
3978 {
3979 for (k = 0; k < nsyms; k += 1)
3980 {
3981 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[k].symbol));
3982
3983 if (ada_args_match (syms[k].symbol, args, nargs)
3984 && (fallback || return_match (type, context_type)))
3985 {
3986 syms[m] = syms[k];
3987 m += 1;
3988 }
3989 }
3990 }
3991
3992 /* If we got multiple matches, ask the user which one to use. Don't do this
3993 interactive thing during completion, though, as the purpose of the
3994 completion is providing a list of all possible matches. Prompting the
3995 user to filter it down would be completely unexpected in this case. */
3996 if (m == 0)
3997 return -1;
3998 else if (m > 1 && !parse_completion)
3999 {
4000 printf_filtered (_("Multiple matches for %s\n"), name);
4001 user_select_syms (syms, m, 1);
4002 return 0;
4003 }
4004 return 0;
4005 }
4006
4007 /* Replace the operator of length OPLEN at position PC in *EXPP with a call
4008 on the function identified by SYM and BLOCK, and taking NARGS
4009 arguments. Update *EXPP as needed to hold more space. */
4010
4011 static void
4012 replace_operator_with_call (expression_up *expp, int pc, int nargs,
4013 int oplen, struct symbol *sym,
4014 const struct block *block)
4015 {
4016 /* A new expression, with 6 more elements (3 for funcall, 4 for function
4017 symbol, -oplen for operator being replaced). */
4018 struct expression *newexp = (struct expression *)
4019 xzalloc (sizeof (struct expression)
4020 + EXP_ELEM_TO_BYTES ((*expp)->nelts + 7 - oplen));
4021 struct expression *exp = expp->get ();
4022
4023 newexp->nelts = exp->nelts + 7 - oplen;
4024 newexp->language_defn = exp->language_defn;
4025 newexp->gdbarch = exp->gdbarch;
4026 memcpy (newexp->elts, exp->elts, EXP_ELEM_TO_BYTES (pc));
4027 memcpy (newexp->elts + pc + 7, exp->elts + pc + oplen,
4028 EXP_ELEM_TO_BYTES (exp->nelts - pc - oplen));
4029
4030 newexp->elts[pc].opcode = newexp->elts[pc + 2].opcode = OP_FUNCALL;
4031 newexp->elts[pc + 1].longconst = (LONGEST) nargs;
4032
4033 newexp->elts[pc + 3].opcode = newexp->elts[pc + 6].opcode = OP_VAR_VALUE;
4034 newexp->elts[pc + 4].block = block;
4035 newexp->elts[pc + 5].symbol = sym;
4036
4037 expp->reset (newexp);
4038 }
4039
4040 /* Type-class predicates */
4041
4042 /* True iff TYPE is numeric (i.e., an INT, RANGE (of numeric type),
4043 or FLOAT). */
4044
4045 static int
4046 numeric_type_p (struct type *type)
4047 {
4048 if (type == NULL)
4049 return 0;
4050 else
4051 {
4052 switch (type->code ())
4053 {
4054 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
4055 case TYPE_CODE_FLT:
4056 return 1;
4057 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
4058 return (type == TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)
4059 || numeric_type_p (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)));
4060 default:
4061 return 0;
4062 }
4063 }
4064 }
4065
4066 /* True iff TYPE is integral (an INT or RANGE of INTs). */
4067
4068 static int
4069 integer_type_p (struct type *type)
4070 {
4071 if (type == NULL)
4072 return 0;
4073 else
4074 {
4075 switch (type->code ())
4076 {
4077 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
4078 return 1;
4079 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
4080 return (type == TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)
4081 || integer_type_p (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)));
4082 default:
4083 return 0;
4084 }
4085 }
4086 }
4087
4088 /* True iff TYPE is scalar (INT, RANGE, FLOAT, ENUM). */
4089
4090 static int
4091 scalar_type_p (struct type *type)
4092 {
4093 if (type == NULL)
4094 return 0;
4095 else
4096 {
4097 switch (type->code ())
4098 {
4099 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
4100 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
4101 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
4102 case TYPE_CODE_FLT:
4103 return 1;
4104 default:
4105 return 0;
4106 }
4107 }
4108 }
4109
4110 /* True iff TYPE is discrete (INT, RANGE, ENUM). */
4111
4112 static int
4113 discrete_type_p (struct type *type)
4114 {
4115 if (type == NULL)
4116 return 0;
4117 else
4118 {
4119 switch (type->code ())
4120 {
4121 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
4122 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
4123 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
4124 case TYPE_CODE_BOOL:
4125 return 1;
4126 default:
4127 return 0;
4128 }
4129 }
4130 }
4131
4132 /* Returns non-zero if OP with operands in the vector ARGS could be
4133 a user-defined function. Errs on the side of pre-defined operators
4134 (i.e., result 0). */
4135
4136 static int
4137 possible_user_operator_p (enum exp_opcode op, struct value *args[])
4138 {
4139 struct type *type0 =
4140 (args[0] == NULL) ? NULL : ada_check_typedef (value_type (args[0]));
4141 struct type *type1 =
4142 (args[1] == NULL) ? NULL : ada_check_typedef (value_type (args[1]));
4143
4144 if (type0 == NULL)
4145 return 0;
4146
4147 switch (op)
4148 {
4149 default:
4150 return 0;
4151
4152 case BINOP_ADD:
4153 case BINOP_SUB:
4154 case BINOP_MUL:
4155 case BINOP_DIV:
4156 return (!(numeric_type_p (type0) && numeric_type_p (type1)));
4157
4158 case BINOP_REM:
4159 case BINOP_MOD:
4160 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
4161 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
4162 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
4163 return (!(integer_type_p (type0) && integer_type_p (type1)));
4164
4165 case BINOP_EQUAL:
4166 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
4167 case BINOP_LESS:
4168 case BINOP_GTR:
4169 case BINOP_LEQ:
4170 case BINOP_GEQ:
4171 return (!(scalar_type_p (type0) && scalar_type_p (type1)));
4172
4173 case BINOP_CONCAT:
4174 return !ada_is_array_type (type0) || !ada_is_array_type (type1);
4175
4176 case BINOP_EXP:
4177 return (!(numeric_type_p (type0) && integer_type_p (type1)));
4178
4179 case UNOP_NEG:
4180 case UNOP_PLUS:
4181 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
4182 case UNOP_ABS:
4183 return (!numeric_type_p (type0));
4184
4185 }
4186 }
4187 \f
4188 /* Renaming */
4189
4190 /* NOTES:
4191
4192 1. In the following, we assume that a renaming type's name may
4193 have an ___XD suffix. It would be nice if this went away at some
4194 point.
4195 2. We handle both the (old) purely type-based representation of
4196 renamings and the (new) variable-based encoding. At some point,
4197 it is devoutly to be hoped that the former goes away
4198 (FIXME: hilfinger-2007-07-09).
4199 3. Subprogram renamings are not implemented, although the XRS
4200 suffix is recognized (FIXME: hilfinger-2007-07-09). */
4201
4202 /* If SYM encodes a renaming,
4203
4204 <renaming> renames <renamed entity>,
4205
4206 sets *LEN to the length of the renamed entity's name,
4207 *RENAMED_ENTITY to that name (not null-terminated), and *RENAMING_EXPR to
4208 the string describing the subcomponent selected from the renamed
4209 entity. Returns ADA_NOT_RENAMING if SYM does not encode a renaming
4210 (in which case, the values of *RENAMED_ENTITY, *LEN, and *RENAMING_EXPR
4211 are undefined). Otherwise, returns a value indicating the category
4212 of entity renamed: an object (ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING), exception
4213 (ADA_EXCEPTION_RENAMING), package (ADA_PACKAGE_RENAMING), or
4214 subprogram (ADA_SUBPROGRAM_RENAMING). Does no allocation; the
4215 strings returned in *RENAMED_ENTITY and *RENAMING_EXPR should not be
4216 deallocated. The values of RENAMED_ENTITY, LEN, or RENAMING_EXPR
4217 may be NULL, in which case they are not assigned.
4218
4219 [Currently, however, GCC does not generate subprogram renamings.] */
4220
4221 enum ada_renaming_category
4222 ada_parse_renaming (struct symbol *sym,
4223 const char **renamed_entity, int *len,
4224 const char **renaming_expr)
4225 {
4226 enum ada_renaming_category kind;
4227 const char *info;
4228 const char *suffix;
4229
4230 if (sym == NULL)
4231 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
4232 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym))
4233 {
4234 default:
4235 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
4236 case LOC_LOCAL:
4237 case LOC_STATIC:
4238 case LOC_COMPUTED:
4239 case LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT:
4240 info = strstr (sym->linkage_name (), "___XR");
4241 if (info == NULL)
4242 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
4243 switch (info[5])
4244 {
4245 case '_':
4246 kind = ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING;
4247 info += 6;
4248 break;
4249 case 'E':
4250 kind = ADA_EXCEPTION_RENAMING;
4251 info += 7;
4252 break;
4253 case 'P':
4254 kind = ADA_PACKAGE_RENAMING;
4255 info += 7;
4256 break;
4257 case 'S':
4258 kind = ADA_SUBPROGRAM_RENAMING;
4259 info += 7;
4260 break;
4261 default:
4262 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
4263 }
4264 }
4265
4266 if (renamed_entity != NULL)
4267 *renamed_entity = info;
4268 suffix = strstr (info, "___XE");
4269 if (suffix == NULL || suffix == info)
4270 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
4271 if (len != NULL)
4272 *len = strlen (info) - strlen (suffix);
4273 suffix += 5;
4274 if (renaming_expr != NULL)
4275 *renaming_expr = suffix;
4276 return kind;
4277 }
4278
4279 /* Compute the value of the given RENAMING_SYM, which is expected to
4280 be a symbol encoding a renaming expression. BLOCK is the block
4281 used to evaluate the renaming. */
4282
4283 static struct value *
4284 ada_read_renaming_var_value (struct symbol *renaming_sym,
4285 const struct block *block)
4286 {
4287 const char *sym_name;
4288
4289 sym_name = renaming_sym->linkage_name ();
4290 expression_up expr = parse_exp_1 (&sym_name, 0, block, 0);
4291 return evaluate_expression (expr.get ());
4292 }
4293 \f
4294
4295 /* Evaluation: Function Calls */
4296
4297 /* Return an lvalue containing the value VAL. This is the identity on
4298 lvalues, and otherwise has the side-effect of allocating memory
4299 in the inferior where a copy of the value contents is copied. */
4300
4301 static struct value *
4302 ensure_lval (struct value *val)
4303 {
4304 if (VALUE_LVAL (val) == not_lval
4305 || VALUE_LVAL (val) == lval_internalvar)
4306 {
4307 int len = TYPE_LENGTH (ada_check_typedef (value_type (val)));
4308 const CORE_ADDR addr =
4309 value_as_long (value_allocate_space_in_inferior (len));
4310
4311 VALUE_LVAL (val) = lval_memory;
4312 set_value_address (val, addr);
4313 write_memory (addr, value_contents (val), len);
4314 }
4315
4316 return val;
4317 }
4318
4319 /* Given ARG, a value of type (pointer or reference to a)*
4320 structure/union, extract the component named NAME from the ultimate
4321 target structure/union and return it as a value with its
4322 appropriate type.
4323
4324 The routine searches for NAME among all members of the structure itself
4325 and (recursively) among all members of any wrapper members
4326 (e.g., '_parent').
4327
4328 If NO_ERR, then simply return NULL in case of error, rather than
4329 calling error. */
4330
4331 static struct value *
4332 ada_value_struct_elt (struct value *arg, const char *name, int no_err)
4333 {
4334 struct type *t, *t1;
4335 struct value *v;
4336 int check_tag;
4337
4338 v = NULL;
4339 t1 = t = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg));
4340 if (t->code () == TYPE_CODE_REF)
4341 {
4342 t1 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (t);
4343 if (t1 == NULL)
4344 goto BadValue;
4345 t1 = ada_check_typedef (t1);
4346 if (t1->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
4347 {
4348 arg = coerce_ref (arg);
4349 t = t1;
4350 }
4351 }
4352
4353 while (t->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
4354 {
4355 t1 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (t);
4356 if (t1 == NULL)
4357 goto BadValue;
4358 t1 = ada_check_typedef (t1);
4359 if (t1->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
4360 {
4361 arg = value_ind (arg);
4362 t = t1;
4363 }
4364 else
4365 break;
4366 }
4367
4368 if (t1->code () != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT && t1->code () != TYPE_CODE_UNION)
4369 goto BadValue;
4370
4371 if (t1 == t)
4372 v = ada_search_struct_field (name, arg, 0, t);
4373 else
4374 {
4375 int bit_offset, bit_size, byte_offset;
4376 struct type *field_type;
4377 CORE_ADDR address;
4378
4379 if (t->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
4380 address = value_address (ada_value_ind (arg));
4381 else
4382 address = value_address (ada_coerce_ref (arg));
4383
4384 /* Check to see if this is a tagged type. We also need to handle
4385 the case where the type is a reference to a tagged type, but
4386 we have to be careful to exclude pointers to tagged types.
4387 The latter should be shown as usual (as a pointer), whereas
4388 a reference should mostly be transparent to the user. */
4389
4390 if (ada_is_tagged_type (t1, 0)
4391 || (t1->code () == TYPE_CODE_REF
4392 && ada_is_tagged_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (t1), 0)))
4393 {
4394 /* We first try to find the searched field in the current type.
4395 If not found then let's look in the fixed type. */
4396
4397 if (!find_struct_field (name, t1, 0,
4398 &field_type, &byte_offset, &bit_offset,
4399 &bit_size, NULL))
4400 check_tag = 1;
4401 else
4402 check_tag = 0;
4403 }
4404 else
4405 check_tag = 0;
4406
4407 /* Convert to fixed type in all cases, so that we have proper
4408 offsets to each field in unconstrained record types. */
4409 t1 = ada_to_fixed_type (ada_get_base_type (t1), NULL,
4410 address, NULL, check_tag);
4411
4412 if (find_struct_field (name, t1, 0,
4413 &field_type, &byte_offset, &bit_offset,
4414 &bit_size, NULL))
4415 {
4416 if (bit_size != 0)
4417 {
4418 if (t->code () == TYPE_CODE_REF)
4419 arg = ada_coerce_ref (arg);
4420 else
4421 arg = ada_value_ind (arg);
4422 v = ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arg, NULL, byte_offset,
4423 bit_offset, bit_size,
4424 field_type);
4425 }
4426 else
4427 v = value_at_lazy (field_type, address + byte_offset);
4428 }
4429 }
4430
4431 if (v != NULL || no_err)
4432 return v;
4433 else
4434 error (_("There is no member named %s."), name);
4435
4436 BadValue:
4437 if (no_err)
4438 return NULL;
4439 else
4440 error (_("Attempt to extract a component of "
4441 "a value that is not a record."));
4442 }
4443
4444 /* Return the value ACTUAL, converted to be an appropriate value for a
4445 formal of type FORMAL_TYPE. Use *SP as a stack pointer for
4446 allocating any necessary descriptors (fat pointers), or copies of
4447 values not residing in memory, updating it as needed. */
4448
4449 struct value *
4450 ada_convert_actual (struct value *actual, struct type *formal_type0)
4451 {
4452 struct type *actual_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (actual));
4453 struct type *formal_type = ada_check_typedef (formal_type0);
4454 struct type *formal_target =
4455 formal_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR
4456 ? ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (formal_type)) : formal_type;
4457 struct type *actual_target =
4458 actual_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR
4459 ? ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (actual_type)) : actual_type;
4460
4461 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (formal_target)
4462 && actual_target->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
4463 return make_array_descriptor (formal_type, actual);
4464 else if (formal_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR
4465 || formal_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_REF)
4466 {
4467 struct value *result;
4468
4469 if (formal_target->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
4470 && ada_is_array_descriptor_type (actual_target))
4471 result = desc_data (actual);
4472 else if (formal_type->code () != TYPE_CODE_PTR)
4473 {
4474 if (VALUE_LVAL (actual) != lval_memory)
4475 {
4476 struct value *val;
4477
4478 actual_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (actual));
4479 val = allocate_value (actual_type);
4480 memcpy ((char *) value_contents_raw (val),
4481 (char *) value_contents (actual),
4482 TYPE_LENGTH (actual_type));
4483 actual = ensure_lval (val);
4484 }
4485 result = value_addr (actual);
4486 }
4487 else
4488 return actual;
4489 return value_cast_pointers (formal_type, result, 0);
4490 }
4491 else if (actual_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
4492 return ada_value_ind (actual);
4493 else if (ada_is_aligner_type (formal_type))
4494 {
4495 /* We need to turn this parameter into an aligner type
4496 as well. */
4497 struct value *aligner = allocate_value (formal_type);
4498 struct value *component = ada_value_struct_elt (aligner, "F", 0);
4499
4500 value_assign_to_component (aligner, component, actual);
4501 return aligner;
4502 }
4503
4504 return actual;
4505 }
4506
4507 /* Convert VALUE (which must be an address) to a CORE_ADDR that is a pointer of
4508 type TYPE. This is usually an inefficient no-op except on some targets
4509 (such as AVR) where the representation of a pointer and an address
4510 differs. */
4511
4512 static CORE_ADDR
4513 value_pointer (struct value *value, struct type *type)
4514 {
4515 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_type_arch (type);
4516 unsigned len = TYPE_LENGTH (type);
4517 gdb_byte *buf = (gdb_byte *) alloca (len);
4518 CORE_ADDR addr;
4519
4520 addr = value_address (value);
4521 gdbarch_address_to_pointer (gdbarch, type, buf, addr);
4522 addr = extract_unsigned_integer (buf, len, type_byte_order (type));
4523 return addr;
4524 }
4525
4526
4527 /* Push a descriptor of type TYPE for array value ARR on the stack at
4528 *SP, updating *SP to reflect the new descriptor. Return either
4529 an lvalue representing the new descriptor, or (if TYPE is a pointer-
4530 to-descriptor type rather than a descriptor type), a struct value *
4531 representing a pointer to this descriptor. */
4532
4533 static struct value *
4534 make_array_descriptor (struct type *type, struct value *arr)
4535 {
4536 struct type *bounds_type = desc_bounds_type (type);
4537 struct type *desc_type = desc_base_type (type);
4538 struct value *descriptor = allocate_value (desc_type);
4539 struct value *bounds = allocate_value (bounds_type);
4540 int i;
4541
4542 for (i = ada_array_arity (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr)));
4543 i > 0; i -= 1)
4544 {
4545 modify_field (value_type (bounds), value_contents_writeable (bounds),
4546 ada_array_bound (arr, i, 0),
4547 desc_bound_bitpos (bounds_type, i, 0),
4548 desc_bound_bitsize (bounds_type, i, 0));
4549 modify_field (value_type (bounds), value_contents_writeable (bounds),
4550 ada_array_bound (arr, i, 1),
4551 desc_bound_bitpos (bounds_type, i, 1),
4552 desc_bound_bitsize (bounds_type, i, 1));
4553 }
4554
4555 bounds = ensure_lval (bounds);
4556
4557 modify_field (value_type (descriptor),
4558 value_contents_writeable (descriptor),
4559 value_pointer (ensure_lval (arr),
4560 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (desc_type, 0)),
4561 fat_pntr_data_bitpos (desc_type),
4562 fat_pntr_data_bitsize (desc_type));
4563
4564 modify_field (value_type (descriptor),
4565 value_contents_writeable (descriptor),
4566 value_pointer (bounds,
4567 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (desc_type, 1)),
4568 fat_pntr_bounds_bitpos (desc_type),
4569 fat_pntr_bounds_bitsize (desc_type));
4570
4571 descriptor = ensure_lval (descriptor);
4572
4573 if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
4574 return value_addr (descriptor);
4575 else
4576 return descriptor;
4577 }
4578 \f
4579 /* Symbol Cache Module */
4580
4581 /* Performance measurements made as of 2010-01-15 indicate that
4582 this cache does bring some noticeable improvements. Depending
4583 on the type of entity being printed, the cache can make it as much
4584 as an order of magnitude faster than without it.
4585
4586 The descriptive type DWARF extension has significantly reduced
4587 the need for this cache, at least when DWARF is being used. However,
4588 even in this case, some expensive name-based symbol searches are still
4589 sometimes necessary - to find an XVZ variable, mostly. */
4590
4591 /* Initialize the contents of SYM_CACHE. */
4592
4593 static void
4594 ada_init_symbol_cache (struct ada_symbol_cache *sym_cache)
4595 {
4596 obstack_init (&sym_cache->cache_space);
4597 memset (sym_cache->root, '\000', sizeof (sym_cache->root));
4598 }
4599
4600 /* Free the memory used by SYM_CACHE. */
4601
4602 static void
4603 ada_free_symbol_cache (struct ada_symbol_cache *sym_cache)
4604 {
4605 obstack_free (&sym_cache->cache_space, NULL);
4606 xfree (sym_cache);
4607 }
4608
4609 /* Return the symbol cache associated to the given program space PSPACE.
4610 If not allocated for this PSPACE yet, allocate and initialize one. */
4611
4612 static struct ada_symbol_cache *
4613 ada_get_symbol_cache (struct program_space *pspace)
4614 {
4615 struct ada_pspace_data *pspace_data = get_ada_pspace_data (pspace);
4616
4617 if (pspace_data->sym_cache == NULL)
4618 {
4619 pspace_data->sym_cache = XCNEW (struct ada_symbol_cache);
4620 ada_init_symbol_cache (pspace_data->sym_cache);
4621 }
4622
4623 return pspace_data->sym_cache;
4624 }
4625
4626 /* Clear all entries from the symbol cache. */
4627
4628 static void
4629 ada_clear_symbol_cache (void)
4630 {
4631 struct ada_symbol_cache *sym_cache
4632 = ada_get_symbol_cache (current_program_space);
4633
4634 obstack_free (&sym_cache->cache_space, NULL);
4635 ada_init_symbol_cache (sym_cache);
4636 }
4637
4638 /* Search our cache for an entry matching NAME and DOMAIN.
4639 Return it if found, or NULL otherwise. */
4640
4641 static struct cache_entry **
4642 find_entry (const char *name, domain_enum domain)
4643 {
4644 struct ada_symbol_cache *sym_cache
4645 = ada_get_symbol_cache (current_program_space);
4646 int h = msymbol_hash (name) % HASH_SIZE;
4647 struct cache_entry **e;
4648
4649 for (e = &sym_cache->root[h]; *e != NULL; e = &(*e)->next)
4650 {
4651 if (domain == (*e)->domain && strcmp (name, (*e)->name) == 0)
4652 return e;
4653 }
4654 return NULL;
4655 }
4656
4657 /* Search the symbol cache for an entry matching NAME and DOMAIN.
4658 Return 1 if found, 0 otherwise.
4659
4660 If an entry was found and SYM is not NULL, set *SYM to the entry's
4661 SYM. Same principle for BLOCK if not NULL. */
4662
4663 static int
4664 lookup_cached_symbol (const char *name, domain_enum domain,
4665 struct symbol **sym, const struct block **block)
4666 {
4667 struct cache_entry **e = find_entry (name, domain);
4668
4669 if (e == NULL)
4670 return 0;
4671 if (sym != NULL)
4672 *sym = (*e)->sym;
4673 if (block != NULL)
4674 *block = (*e)->block;
4675 return 1;
4676 }
4677
4678 /* Assuming that (SYM, BLOCK) is the result of the lookup of NAME
4679 in domain DOMAIN, save this result in our symbol cache. */
4680
4681 static void
4682 cache_symbol (const char *name, domain_enum domain, struct symbol *sym,
4683 const struct block *block)
4684 {
4685 struct ada_symbol_cache *sym_cache
4686 = ada_get_symbol_cache (current_program_space);
4687 int h;
4688 struct cache_entry *e;
4689
4690 /* Symbols for builtin types don't have a block.
4691 For now don't cache such symbols. */
4692 if (sym != NULL && !SYMBOL_OBJFILE_OWNED (sym))
4693 return;
4694
4695 /* If the symbol is a local symbol, then do not cache it, as a search
4696 for that symbol depends on the context. To determine whether
4697 the symbol is local or not, we check the block where we found it
4698 against the global and static blocks of its associated symtab. */
4699 if (sym
4700 && BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (SYMTAB_BLOCKVECTOR (symbol_symtab (sym)),
4701 GLOBAL_BLOCK) != block
4702 && BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (SYMTAB_BLOCKVECTOR (symbol_symtab (sym)),
4703 STATIC_BLOCK) != block)
4704 return;
4705
4706 h = msymbol_hash (name) % HASH_SIZE;
4707 e = XOBNEW (&sym_cache->cache_space, cache_entry);
4708 e->next = sym_cache->root[h];
4709 sym_cache->root[h] = e;
4710 e->name = obstack_strdup (&sym_cache->cache_space, name);
4711 e->sym = sym;
4712 e->domain = domain;
4713 e->block = block;
4714 }
4715 \f
4716 /* Symbol Lookup */
4717
4718 /* Return the symbol name match type that should be used used when
4719 searching for all symbols matching LOOKUP_NAME.
4720
4721 LOOKUP_NAME is expected to be a symbol name after transformation
4722 for Ada lookups. */
4723
4724 static symbol_name_match_type
4725 name_match_type_from_name (const char *lookup_name)
4726 {
4727 return (strstr (lookup_name, "__") == NULL
4728 ? symbol_name_match_type::WILD
4729 : symbol_name_match_type::FULL);
4730 }
4731
4732 /* Return the result of a standard (literal, C-like) lookup of NAME in
4733 given DOMAIN, visible from lexical block BLOCK. */
4734
4735 static struct symbol *
4736 standard_lookup (const char *name, const struct block *block,
4737 domain_enum domain)
4738 {
4739 /* Initialize it just to avoid a GCC false warning. */
4740 struct block_symbol sym = {};
4741
4742 if (lookup_cached_symbol (name, domain, &sym.symbol, NULL))
4743 return sym.symbol;
4744 ada_lookup_encoded_symbol (name, block, domain, &sym);
4745 cache_symbol (name, domain, sym.symbol, sym.block);
4746 return sym.symbol;
4747 }
4748
4749
4750 /* Non-zero iff there is at least one non-function/non-enumeral symbol
4751 in the symbol fields of SYMS[0..N-1]. We treat enumerals as functions,
4752 since they contend in overloading in the same way. */
4753 static int
4754 is_nonfunction (struct block_symbol syms[], int n)
4755 {
4756 int i;
4757
4758 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 1)
4759 if (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].symbol)->code () != TYPE_CODE_FUNC
4760 && (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].symbol)->code () != TYPE_CODE_ENUM
4761 || SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].symbol) != LOC_CONST))
4762 return 1;
4763
4764 return 0;
4765 }
4766
4767 /* If true (non-zero), then TYPE0 and TYPE1 represent equivalent
4768 struct types. Otherwise, they may not. */
4769
4770 static int
4771 equiv_types (struct type *type0, struct type *type1)
4772 {
4773 if (type0 == type1)
4774 return 1;
4775 if (type0 == NULL || type1 == NULL
4776 || type0->code () != type1->code ())
4777 return 0;
4778 if ((type0->code () == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
4779 || type0->code () == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
4780 && ada_type_name (type0) != NULL && ada_type_name (type1) != NULL
4781 && strcmp (ada_type_name (type0), ada_type_name (type1)) == 0)
4782 return 1;
4783
4784 return 0;
4785 }
4786
4787 /* True iff SYM0 represents the same entity as SYM1, or one that is
4788 no more defined than that of SYM1. */
4789
4790 static int
4791 lesseq_defined_than (struct symbol *sym0, struct symbol *sym1)
4792 {
4793 if (sym0 == sym1)
4794 return 1;
4795 if (SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym0) != SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym1)
4796 || SYMBOL_CLASS (sym0) != SYMBOL_CLASS (sym1))
4797 return 0;
4798
4799 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym0))
4800 {
4801 case LOC_UNDEF:
4802 return 1;
4803 case LOC_TYPEDEF:
4804 {
4805 struct type *type0 = SYMBOL_TYPE (sym0);
4806 struct type *type1 = SYMBOL_TYPE (sym1);
4807 const char *name0 = sym0->linkage_name ();
4808 const char *name1 = sym1->linkage_name ();
4809 int len0 = strlen (name0);
4810
4811 return
4812 type0->code () == type1->code ()
4813 && (equiv_types (type0, type1)
4814 || (len0 < strlen (name1) && strncmp (name0, name1, len0) == 0
4815 && startswith (name1 + len0, "___XV")));
4816 }
4817 case LOC_CONST:
4818 return SYMBOL_VALUE (sym0) == SYMBOL_VALUE (sym1)
4819 && equiv_types (SYMBOL_TYPE (sym0), SYMBOL_TYPE (sym1));
4820
4821 case LOC_STATIC:
4822 {
4823 const char *name0 = sym0->linkage_name ();
4824 const char *name1 = sym1->linkage_name ();
4825 return (strcmp (name0, name1) == 0
4826 && SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (sym0) == SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (sym1));
4827 }
4828
4829 default:
4830 return 0;
4831 }
4832 }
4833
4834 /* Append (SYM,BLOCK,SYMTAB) to the end of the array of struct block_symbol
4835 records in OBSTACKP. Do nothing if SYM is a duplicate. */
4836
4837 static void
4838 add_defn_to_vec (struct obstack *obstackp,
4839 struct symbol *sym,
4840 const struct block *block)
4841 {
4842 int i;
4843 struct block_symbol *prevDefns = defns_collected (obstackp, 0);
4844
4845 /* Do not try to complete stub types, as the debugger is probably
4846 already scanning all symbols matching a certain name at the
4847 time when this function is called. Trying to replace the stub
4848 type by its associated full type will cause us to restart a scan
4849 which may lead to an infinite recursion. Instead, the client
4850 collecting the matching symbols will end up collecting several
4851 matches, with at least one of them complete. It can then filter
4852 out the stub ones if needed. */
4853
4854 for (i = num_defns_collected (obstackp) - 1; i >= 0; i -= 1)
4855 {
4856 if (lesseq_defined_than (sym, prevDefns[i].symbol))
4857 return;
4858 else if (lesseq_defined_than (prevDefns[i].symbol, sym))
4859 {
4860 prevDefns[i].symbol = sym;
4861 prevDefns[i].block = block;
4862 return;
4863 }
4864 }
4865
4866 {
4867 struct block_symbol info;
4868
4869 info.symbol = sym;
4870 info.block = block;
4871 obstack_grow (obstackp, &info, sizeof (struct block_symbol));
4872 }
4873 }
4874
4875 /* Number of block_symbol structures currently collected in current vector in
4876 OBSTACKP. */
4877
4878 static int
4879 num_defns_collected (struct obstack *obstackp)
4880 {
4881 return obstack_object_size (obstackp) / sizeof (struct block_symbol);
4882 }
4883
4884 /* Vector of block_symbol structures currently collected in current vector in
4885 OBSTACKP. If FINISH, close off the vector and return its final address. */
4886
4887 static struct block_symbol *
4888 defns_collected (struct obstack *obstackp, int finish)
4889 {
4890 if (finish)
4891 return (struct block_symbol *) obstack_finish (obstackp);
4892 else
4893 return (struct block_symbol *) obstack_base (obstackp);
4894 }
4895
4896 /* Return a bound minimal symbol matching NAME according to Ada
4897 decoding rules. Returns an invalid symbol if there is no such
4898 minimal symbol. Names prefixed with "standard__" are handled
4899 specially: "standard__" is first stripped off, and only static and
4900 global symbols are searched. */
4901
4902 struct bound_minimal_symbol
4903 ada_lookup_simple_minsym (const char *name)
4904 {
4905 struct bound_minimal_symbol result;
4906
4907 memset (&result, 0, sizeof (result));
4908
4909 symbol_name_match_type match_type = name_match_type_from_name (name);
4910 lookup_name_info lookup_name (name, match_type);
4911
4912 symbol_name_matcher_ftype *match_name
4913 = ada_get_symbol_name_matcher (lookup_name);
4914
4915 for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
4916 {
4917 for (minimal_symbol *msymbol : objfile->msymbols ())
4918 {
4919 if (match_name (msymbol->linkage_name (), lookup_name, NULL)
4920 && MSYMBOL_TYPE (msymbol) != mst_solib_trampoline)
4921 {
4922 result.minsym = msymbol;
4923 result.objfile = objfile;
4924 break;
4925 }
4926 }
4927 }
4928
4929 return result;
4930 }
4931
4932 /* For all subprograms that statically enclose the subprogram of the
4933 selected frame, add symbols matching identifier NAME in DOMAIN
4934 and their blocks to the list of data in OBSTACKP, as for
4935 ada_add_block_symbols (q.v.). If WILD_MATCH_P, treat as NAME
4936 with a wildcard prefix. */
4937
4938 static void
4939 add_symbols_from_enclosing_procs (struct obstack *obstackp,
4940 const lookup_name_info &lookup_name,
4941 domain_enum domain)
4942 {
4943 }
4944
4945 /* True if TYPE is definitely an artificial type supplied to a symbol
4946 for which no debugging information was given in the symbol file. */
4947
4948 static int
4949 is_nondebugging_type (struct type *type)
4950 {
4951 const char *name = ada_type_name (type);
4952
4953 return (name != NULL && strcmp (name, "<variable, no debug info>") == 0);
4954 }
4955
4956 /* Return nonzero if TYPE1 and TYPE2 are two enumeration types
4957 that are deemed "identical" for practical purposes.
4958
4959 This function assumes that TYPE1 and TYPE2 are both TYPE_CODE_ENUM
4960 types and that their number of enumerals is identical (in other
4961 words, TYPE_NFIELDS (type1) == TYPE_NFIELDS (type2)). */
4962
4963 static int
4964 ada_identical_enum_types_p (struct type *type1, struct type *type2)
4965 {
4966 int i;
4967
4968 /* The heuristic we use here is fairly conservative. We consider
4969 that 2 enumerate types are identical if they have the same
4970 number of enumerals and that all enumerals have the same
4971 underlying value and name. */
4972
4973 /* All enums in the type should have an identical underlying value. */
4974 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type1); i++)
4975 if (TYPE_FIELD_ENUMVAL (type1, i) != TYPE_FIELD_ENUMVAL (type2, i))
4976 return 0;
4977
4978 /* All enumerals should also have the same name (modulo any numerical
4979 suffix). */
4980 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type1); i++)
4981 {
4982 const char *name_1 = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type1, i);
4983 const char *name_2 = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type2, i);
4984 int len_1 = strlen (name_1);
4985 int len_2 = strlen (name_2);
4986
4987 ada_remove_trailing_digits (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type1, i), &len_1);
4988 ada_remove_trailing_digits (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type2, i), &len_2);
4989 if (len_1 != len_2
4990 || strncmp (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type1, i),
4991 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type2, i),
4992 len_1) != 0)
4993 return 0;
4994 }
4995
4996 return 1;
4997 }
4998
4999 /* Return nonzero if all the symbols in SYMS are all enumeral symbols
5000 that are deemed "identical" for practical purposes. Sometimes,
5001 enumerals are not strictly identical, but their types are so similar
5002 that they can be considered identical.
5003
5004 For instance, consider the following code:
5005
5006 type Color is (Black, Red, Green, Blue, White);
5007 type RGB_Color is new Color range Red .. Blue;
5008
5009 Type RGB_Color is a subrange of an implicit type which is a copy
5010 of type Color. If we call that implicit type RGB_ColorB ("B" is
5011 for "Base Type"), then type RGB_ColorB is a copy of type Color.
5012 As a result, when an expression references any of the enumeral
5013 by name (Eg. "print green"), the expression is technically
5014 ambiguous and the user should be asked to disambiguate. But
5015 doing so would only hinder the user, since it wouldn't matter
5016 what choice he makes, the outcome would always be the same.
5017 So, for practical purposes, we consider them as the same. */
5018
5019 static int
5020 symbols_are_identical_enums (const std::vector<struct block_symbol> &syms)
5021 {
5022 int i;
5023
5024 /* Before performing a thorough comparison check of each type,
5025 we perform a series of inexpensive checks. We expect that these
5026 checks will quickly fail in the vast majority of cases, and thus
5027 help prevent the unnecessary use of a more expensive comparison.
5028 Said comparison also expects us to make some of these checks
5029 (see ada_identical_enum_types_p). */
5030
5031 /* Quick check: All symbols should have an enum type. */
5032 for (i = 0; i < syms.size (); i++)
5033 if (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].symbol)->code () != TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
5034 return 0;
5035
5036 /* Quick check: They should all have the same value. */
5037 for (i = 1; i < syms.size (); i++)
5038 if (SYMBOL_VALUE (syms[i].symbol) != SYMBOL_VALUE (syms[0].symbol))
5039 return 0;
5040
5041 /* Quick check: They should all have the same number of enumerals. */
5042 for (i = 1; i < syms.size (); i++)
5043 if (TYPE_NFIELDS (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].symbol))
5044 != TYPE_NFIELDS (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[0].symbol)))
5045 return 0;
5046
5047 /* All the sanity checks passed, so we might have a set of
5048 identical enumeration types. Perform a more complete
5049 comparison of the type of each symbol. */
5050 for (i = 1; i < syms.size (); i++)
5051 if (!ada_identical_enum_types_p (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].symbol),
5052 SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[0].symbol)))
5053 return 0;
5054
5055 return 1;
5056 }
5057
5058 /* Remove any non-debugging symbols in SYMS that definitely
5059 duplicate other symbols in the list (The only case I know of where
5060 this happens is when object files containing stabs-in-ecoff are
5061 linked with files containing ordinary ecoff debugging symbols (or no
5062 debugging symbols)). Modifies SYMS to squeeze out deleted entries.
5063 Returns the number of items in the modified list. */
5064
5065 static int
5066 remove_extra_symbols (std::vector<struct block_symbol> *syms)
5067 {
5068 int i, j;
5069
5070 /* We should never be called with less than 2 symbols, as there
5071 cannot be any extra symbol in that case. But it's easy to
5072 handle, since we have nothing to do in that case. */
5073 if (syms->size () < 2)
5074 return syms->size ();
5075
5076 i = 0;
5077 while (i < syms->size ())
5078 {
5079 int remove_p = 0;
5080
5081 /* If two symbols have the same name and one of them is a stub type,
5082 the get rid of the stub. */
5083
5084 if (TYPE_STUB (SYMBOL_TYPE ((*syms)[i].symbol))
5085 && (*syms)[i].symbol->linkage_name () != NULL)
5086 {
5087 for (j = 0; j < syms->size (); j++)
5088 {
5089 if (j != i
5090 && !TYPE_STUB (SYMBOL_TYPE ((*syms)[j].symbol))
5091 && (*syms)[j].symbol->linkage_name () != NULL
5092 && strcmp ((*syms)[i].symbol->linkage_name (),
5093 (*syms)[j].symbol->linkage_name ()) == 0)
5094 remove_p = 1;
5095 }
5096 }
5097
5098 /* Two symbols with the same name, same class and same address
5099 should be identical. */
5100
5101 else if ((*syms)[i].symbol->linkage_name () != NULL
5102 && SYMBOL_CLASS ((*syms)[i].symbol) == LOC_STATIC
5103 && is_nondebugging_type (SYMBOL_TYPE ((*syms)[i].symbol)))
5104 {
5105 for (j = 0; j < syms->size (); j += 1)
5106 {
5107 if (i != j
5108 && (*syms)[j].symbol->linkage_name () != NULL
5109 && strcmp ((*syms)[i].symbol->linkage_name (),
5110 (*syms)[j].symbol->linkage_name ()) == 0
5111 && SYMBOL_CLASS ((*syms)[i].symbol)
5112 == SYMBOL_CLASS ((*syms)[j].symbol)
5113 && SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS ((*syms)[i].symbol)
5114 == SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS ((*syms)[j].symbol))
5115 remove_p = 1;
5116 }
5117 }
5118
5119 if (remove_p)
5120 syms->erase (syms->begin () + i);
5121
5122 i += 1;
5123 }
5124
5125 /* If all the remaining symbols are identical enumerals, then
5126 just keep the first one and discard the rest.
5127
5128 Unlike what we did previously, we do not discard any entry
5129 unless they are ALL identical. This is because the symbol
5130 comparison is not a strict comparison, but rather a practical
5131 comparison. If all symbols are considered identical, then
5132 we can just go ahead and use the first one and discard the rest.
5133 But if we cannot reduce the list to a single element, we have
5134 to ask the user to disambiguate anyways. And if we have to
5135 present a multiple-choice menu, it's less confusing if the list
5136 isn't missing some choices that were identical and yet distinct. */
5137 if (symbols_are_identical_enums (*syms))
5138 syms->resize (1);
5139
5140 return syms->size ();
5141 }
5142
5143 /* Given a type that corresponds to a renaming entity, use the type name
5144 to extract the scope (package name or function name, fully qualified,
5145 and following the GNAT encoding convention) where this renaming has been
5146 defined. */
5147
5148 static std::string
5149 xget_renaming_scope (struct type *renaming_type)
5150 {
5151 /* The renaming types adhere to the following convention:
5152 <scope>__<rename>___<XR extension>.
5153 So, to extract the scope, we search for the "___XR" extension,
5154 and then backtrack until we find the first "__". */
5155
5156 const char *name = renaming_type->name ();
5157 const char *suffix = strstr (name, "___XR");
5158 const char *last;
5159
5160 /* Now, backtrack a bit until we find the first "__". Start looking
5161 at suffix - 3, as the <rename> part is at least one character long. */
5162
5163 for (last = suffix - 3; last > name; last--)
5164 if (last[0] == '_' && last[1] == '_')
5165 break;
5166
5167 /* Make a copy of scope and return it. */
5168 return std::string (name, last);
5169 }
5170
5171 /* Return nonzero if NAME corresponds to a package name. */
5172
5173 static int
5174 is_package_name (const char *name)
5175 {
5176 /* Here, We take advantage of the fact that no symbols are generated
5177 for packages, while symbols are generated for each function.
5178 So the condition for NAME represent a package becomes equivalent
5179 to NAME not existing in our list of symbols. There is only one
5180 small complication with library-level functions (see below). */
5181
5182 /* If it is a function that has not been defined at library level,
5183 then we should be able to look it up in the symbols. */
5184 if (standard_lookup (name, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN) != NULL)
5185 return 0;
5186
5187 /* Library-level function names start with "_ada_". See if function
5188 "_ada_" followed by NAME can be found. */
5189
5190 /* Do a quick check that NAME does not contain "__", since library-level
5191 functions names cannot contain "__" in them. */
5192 if (strstr (name, "__") != NULL)
5193 return 0;
5194
5195 std::string fun_name = string_printf ("_ada_%s", name);
5196
5197 return (standard_lookup (fun_name.c_str (), NULL, VAR_DOMAIN) == NULL);
5198 }
5199
5200 /* Return nonzero if SYM corresponds to a renaming entity that is
5201 not visible from FUNCTION_NAME. */
5202
5203 static int
5204 old_renaming_is_invisible (const struct symbol *sym, const char *function_name)
5205 {
5206 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_TYPEDEF)
5207 return 0;
5208
5209 std::string scope = xget_renaming_scope (SYMBOL_TYPE (sym));
5210
5211 /* If the rename has been defined in a package, then it is visible. */
5212 if (is_package_name (scope.c_str ()))
5213 return 0;
5214
5215 /* Check that the rename is in the current function scope by checking
5216 that its name starts with SCOPE. */
5217
5218 /* If the function name starts with "_ada_", it means that it is
5219 a library-level function. Strip this prefix before doing the
5220 comparison, as the encoding for the renaming does not contain
5221 this prefix. */
5222 if (startswith (function_name, "_ada_"))
5223 function_name += 5;
5224
5225 return !startswith (function_name, scope.c_str ());
5226 }
5227
5228 /* Remove entries from SYMS that corresponds to a renaming entity that
5229 is not visible from the function associated with CURRENT_BLOCK or
5230 that is superfluous due to the presence of more specific renaming
5231 information. Places surviving symbols in the initial entries of
5232 SYMS and returns the number of surviving symbols.
5233
5234 Rationale:
5235 First, in cases where an object renaming is implemented as a
5236 reference variable, GNAT may produce both the actual reference
5237 variable and the renaming encoding. In this case, we discard the
5238 latter.
5239
5240 Second, GNAT emits a type following a specified encoding for each renaming
5241 entity. Unfortunately, STABS currently does not support the definition
5242 of types that are local to a given lexical block, so all renamings types
5243 are emitted at library level. As a consequence, if an application
5244 contains two renaming entities using the same name, and a user tries to
5245 print the value of one of these entities, the result of the ada symbol
5246 lookup will also contain the wrong renaming type.
5247
5248 This function partially covers for this limitation by attempting to
5249 remove from the SYMS list renaming symbols that should be visible
5250 from CURRENT_BLOCK. However, there does not seem be a 100% reliable
5251 method with the current information available. The implementation
5252 below has a couple of limitations (FIXME: brobecker-2003-05-12):
5253
5254 - When the user tries to print a rename in a function while there
5255 is another rename entity defined in a package: Normally, the
5256 rename in the function has precedence over the rename in the
5257 package, so the latter should be removed from the list. This is
5258 currently not the case.
5259
5260 - This function will incorrectly remove valid renames if
5261 the CURRENT_BLOCK corresponds to a function which symbol name
5262 has been changed by an "Export" pragma. As a consequence,
5263 the user will be unable to print such rename entities. */
5264
5265 static int
5266 remove_irrelevant_renamings (std::vector<struct block_symbol> *syms,
5267 const struct block *current_block)
5268 {
5269 struct symbol *current_function;
5270 const char *current_function_name;
5271 int i;
5272 int is_new_style_renaming;
5273
5274 /* If there is both a renaming foo___XR... encoded as a variable and
5275 a simple variable foo in the same block, discard the latter.
5276 First, zero out such symbols, then compress. */
5277 is_new_style_renaming = 0;
5278 for (i = 0; i < syms->size (); i += 1)
5279 {
5280 struct symbol *sym = (*syms)[i].symbol;
5281 const struct block *block = (*syms)[i].block;
5282 const char *name;
5283 const char *suffix;
5284
5285 if (sym == NULL || SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_TYPEDEF)
5286 continue;
5287 name = sym->linkage_name ();
5288 suffix = strstr (name, "___XR");
5289
5290 if (suffix != NULL)
5291 {
5292 int name_len = suffix - name;
5293 int j;
5294
5295 is_new_style_renaming = 1;
5296 for (j = 0; j < syms->size (); j += 1)
5297 if (i != j && (*syms)[j].symbol != NULL
5298 && strncmp (name, (*syms)[j].symbol->linkage_name (),
5299 name_len) == 0
5300 && block == (*syms)[j].block)
5301 (*syms)[j].symbol = NULL;
5302 }
5303 }
5304 if (is_new_style_renaming)
5305 {
5306 int j, k;
5307
5308 for (j = k = 0; j < syms->size (); j += 1)
5309 if ((*syms)[j].symbol != NULL)
5310 {
5311 (*syms)[k] = (*syms)[j];
5312 k += 1;
5313 }
5314 return k;
5315 }
5316
5317 /* Extract the function name associated to CURRENT_BLOCK.
5318 Abort if unable to do so. */
5319
5320 if (current_block == NULL)
5321 return syms->size ();
5322
5323 current_function = block_linkage_function (current_block);
5324 if (current_function == NULL)
5325 return syms->size ();
5326
5327 current_function_name = current_function->linkage_name ();
5328 if (current_function_name == NULL)
5329 return syms->size ();
5330
5331 /* Check each of the symbols, and remove it from the list if it is
5332 a type corresponding to a renaming that is out of the scope of
5333 the current block. */
5334
5335 i = 0;
5336 while (i < syms->size ())
5337 {
5338 if (ada_parse_renaming ((*syms)[i].symbol, NULL, NULL, NULL)
5339 == ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING
5340 && old_renaming_is_invisible ((*syms)[i].symbol,
5341 current_function_name))
5342 syms->erase (syms->begin () + i);
5343 else
5344 i += 1;
5345 }
5346
5347 return syms->size ();
5348 }
5349
5350 /* Add to OBSTACKP all symbols from BLOCK (and its super-blocks)
5351 whose name and domain match NAME and DOMAIN respectively.
5352 If no match was found, then extend the search to "enclosing"
5353 routines (in other words, if we're inside a nested function,
5354 search the symbols defined inside the enclosing functions).
5355 If WILD_MATCH_P is nonzero, perform the naming matching in
5356 "wild" mode (see function "wild_match" for more info).
5357
5358 Note: This function assumes that OBSTACKP has 0 (zero) element in it. */
5359
5360 static void
5361 ada_add_local_symbols (struct obstack *obstackp,
5362 const lookup_name_info &lookup_name,
5363 const struct block *block, domain_enum domain)
5364 {
5365 int block_depth = 0;
5366
5367 while (block != NULL)
5368 {
5369 block_depth += 1;
5370 ada_add_block_symbols (obstackp, block, lookup_name, domain, NULL);
5371
5372 /* If we found a non-function match, assume that's the one. */
5373 if (is_nonfunction (defns_collected (obstackp, 0),
5374 num_defns_collected (obstackp)))
5375 return;
5376
5377 block = BLOCK_SUPERBLOCK (block);
5378 }
5379
5380 /* If no luck so far, try to find NAME as a local symbol in some lexically
5381 enclosing subprogram. */
5382 if (num_defns_collected (obstackp) == 0 && block_depth > 2)
5383 add_symbols_from_enclosing_procs (obstackp, lookup_name, domain);
5384 }
5385
5386 /* An object of this type is used as the user_data argument when
5387 calling the map_matching_symbols method. */
5388
5389 struct match_data
5390 {
5391 struct objfile *objfile;
5392 struct obstack *obstackp;
5393 struct symbol *arg_sym;
5394 int found_sym;
5395 };
5396
5397 /* A callback for add_nonlocal_symbols that adds symbol, found in BSYM,
5398 to a list of symbols. DATA is a pointer to a struct match_data *
5399 containing the obstack that collects the symbol list, the file that SYM
5400 must come from, a flag indicating whether a non-argument symbol has
5401 been found in the current block, and the last argument symbol
5402 passed in SYM within the current block (if any). When SYM is null,
5403 marking the end of a block, the argument symbol is added if no
5404 other has been found. */
5405
5406 static bool
5407 aux_add_nonlocal_symbols (struct block_symbol *bsym,
5408 struct match_data *data)
5409 {
5410 const struct block *block = bsym->block;
5411 struct symbol *sym = bsym->symbol;
5412
5413 if (sym == NULL)
5414 {
5415 if (!data->found_sym && data->arg_sym != NULL)
5416 add_defn_to_vec (data->obstackp,
5417 fixup_symbol_section (data->arg_sym, data->objfile),
5418 block);
5419 data->found_sym = 0;
5420 data->arg_sym = NULL;
5421 }
5422 else
5423 {
5424 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_UNRESOLVED)
5425 return true;
5426 else if (SYMBOL_IS_ARGUMENT (sym))
5427 data->arg_sym = sym;
5428 else
5429 {
5430 data->found_sym = 1;
5431 add_defn_to_vec (data->obstackp,
5432 fixup_symbol_section (sym, data->objfile),
5433 block);
5434 }
5435 }
5436 return true;
5437 }
5438
5439 /* Helper for add_nonlocal_symbols. Find symbols in DOMAIN which are
5440 targeted by renamings matching LOOKUP_NAME in BLOCK. Add these
5441 symbols to OBSTACKP. Return whether we found such symbols. */
5442
5443 static int
5444 ada_add_block_renamings (struct obstack *obstackp,
5445 const struct block *block,
5446 const lookup_name_info &lookup_name,
5447 domain_enum domain)
5448 {
5449 struct using_direct *renaming;
5450 int defns_mark = num_defns_collected (obstackp);
5451
5452 symbol_name_matcher_ftype *name_match
5453 = ada_get_symbol_name_matcher (lookup_name);
5454
5455 for (renaming = block_using (block);
5456 renaming != NULL;
5457 renaming = renaming->next)
5458 {
5459 const char *r_name;
5460
5461 /* Avoid infinite recursions: skip this renaming if we are actually
5462 already traversing it.
5463
5464 Currently, symbol lookup in Ada don't use the namespace machinery from
5465 C++/Fortran support: skip namespace imports that use them. */
5466 if (renaming->searched
5467 || (renaming->import_src != NULL
5468 && renaming->import_src[0] != '\0')
5469 || (renaming->import_dest != NULL
5470 && renaming->import_dest[0] != '\0'))
5471 continue;
5472 renaming->searched = 1;
5473
5474 /* TODO: here, we perform another name-based symbol lookup, which can
5475 pull its own multiple overloads. In theory, we should be able to do
5476 better in this case since, in DWARF, DW_AT_import is a DIE reference,
5477 not a simple name. But in order to do this, we would need to enhance
5478 the DWARF reader to associate a symbol to this renaming, instead of a
5479 name. So, for now, we do something simpler: re-use the C++/Fortran
5480 namespace machinery. */
5481 r_name = (renaming->alias != NULL
5482 ? renaming->alias
5483 : renaming->declaration);
5484 if (name_match (r_name, lookup_name, NULL))
5485 {
5486 lookup_name_info decl_lookup_name (renaming->declaration,
5487 lookup_name.match_type ());
5488 ada_add_all_symbols (obstackp, block, decl_lookup_name, domain,
5489 1, NULL);
5490 }
5491 renaming->searched = 0;
5492 }
5493 return num_defns_collected (obstackp) != defns_mark;
5494 }
5495
5496 /* Implements compare_names, but only applying the comparision using
5497 the given CASING. */
5498
5499 static int
5500 compare_names_with_case (const char *string1, const char *string2,
5501 enum case_sensitivity casing)
5502 {
5503 while (*string1 != '\0' && *string2 != '\0')
5504 {
5505 char c1, c2;
5506
5507 if (isspace (*string1) || isspace (*string2))
5508 return strcmp_iw_ordered (string1, string2);
5509
5510 if (casing == case_sensitive_off)
5511 {
5512 c1 = tolower (*string1);
5513 c2 = tolower (*string2);
5514 }
5515 else
5516 {
5517 c1 = *string1;
5518 c2 = *string2;
5519 }
5520 if (c1 != c2)
5521 break;
5522
5523 string1 += 1;
5524 string2 += 1;
5525 }
5526
5527 switch (*string1)
5528 {
5529 case '(':
5530 return strcmp_iw_ordered (string1, string2);
5531 case '_':
5532 if (*string2 == '\0')
5533 {
5534 if (is_name_suffix (string1))
5535 return 0;
5536 else
5537 return 1;
5538 }
5539 /* FALLTHROUGH */
5540 default:
5541 if (*string2 == '(')
5542 return strcmp_iw_ordered (string1, string2);
5543 else
5544 {
5545 if (casing == case_sensitive_off)
5546 return tolower (*string1) - tolower (*string2);
5547 else
5548 return *string1 - *string2;
5549 }
5550 }
5551 }
5552
5553 /* Compare STRING1 to STRING2, with results as for strcmp.
5554 Compatible with strcmp_iw_ordered in that...
5555
5556 strcmp_iw_ordered (STRING1, STRING2) <= 0
5557
5558 ... implies...
5559
5560 compare_names (STRING1, STRING2) <= 0
5561
5562 (they may differ as to what symbols compare equal). */
5563
5564 static int
5565 compare_names (const char *string1, const char *string2)
5566 {
5567 int result;
5568
5569 /* Similar to what strcmp_iw_ordered does, we need to perform
5570 a case-insensitive comparison first, and only resort to
5571 a second, case-sensitive, comparison if the first one was
5572 not sufficient to differentiate the two strings. */
5573
5574 result = compare_names_with_case (string1, string2, case_sensitive_off);
5575 if (result == 0)
5576 result = compare_names_with_case (string1, string2, case_sensitive_on);
5577
5578 return result;
5579 }
5580
5581 /* Convenience function to get at the Ada encoded lookup name for
5582 LOOKUP_NAME, as a C string. */
5583
5584 static const char *
5585 ada_lookup_name (const lookup_name_info &lookup_name)
5586 {
5587 return lookup_name.ada ().lookup_name ().c_str ();
5588 }
5589
5590 /* Add to OBSTACKP all non-local symbols whose name and domain match
5591 LOOKUP_NAME and DOMAIN respectively. The search is performed on
5592 GLOBAL_BLOCK symbols if GLOBAL is non-zero, or on STATIC_BLOCK
5593 symbols otherwise. */
5594
5595 static void
5596 add_nonlocal_symbols (struct obstack *obstackp,
5597 const lookup_name_info &lookup_name,
5598 domain_enum domain, int global)
5599 {
5600 struct match_data data;
5601
5602 memset (&data, 0, sizeof data);
5603 data.obstackp = obstackp;
5604
5605 bool is_wild_match = lookup_name.ada ().wild_match_p ();
5606
5607 auto callback = [&] (struct block_symbol *bsym)
5608 {
5609 return aux_add_nonlocal_symbols (bsym, &data);
5610 };
5611
5612 for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
5613 {
5614 data.objfile = objfile;
5615
5616 objfile->sf->qf->map_matching_symbols (objfile, lookup_name,
5617 domain, global, callback,
5618 (is_wild_match
5619 ? NULL : compare_names));
5620
5621 for (compunit_symtab *cu : objfile->compunits ())
5622 {
5623 const struct block *global_block
5624 = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (COMPUNIT_BLOCKVECTOR (cu), GLOBAL_BLOCK);
5625
5626 if (ada_add_block_renamings (obstackp, global_block, lookup_name,
5627 domain))
5628 data.found_sym = 1;
5629 }
5630 }
5631
5632 if (num_defns_collected (obstackp) == 0 && global && !is_wild_match)
5633 {
5634 const char *name = ada_lookup_name (lookup_name);
5635 std::string bracket_name = std::string ("<_ada_") + name + '>';
5636 lookup_name_info name1 (bracket_name, symbol_name_match_type::FULL);
5637
5638 for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
5639 {
5640 data.objfile = objfile;
5641 objfile->sf->qf->map_matching_symbols (objfile, name1,
5642 domain, global, callback,
5643 compare_names);
5644 }
5645 }
5646 }
5647
5648 /* Find symbols in DOMAIN matching LOOKUP_NAME, in BLOCK and, if
5649 FULL_SEARCH is non-zero, enclosing scope and in global scopes,
5650 returning the number of matches. Add these to OBSTACKP.
5651
5652 When FULL_SEARCH is non-zero, any non-function/non-enumeral
5653 symbol match within the nest of blocks whose innermost member is BLOCK,
5654 is the one match returned (no other matches in that or
5655 enclosing blocks is returned). If there are any matches in or
5656 surrounding BLOCK, then these alone are returned.
5657
5658 Names prefixed with "standard__" are handled specially:
5659 "standard__" is first stripped off (by the lookup_name
5660 constructor), and only static and global symbols are searched.
5661
5662 If MADE_GLOBAL_LOOKUP_P is non-null, set it before return to whether we had
5663 to lookup global symbols. */
5664
5665 static void
5666 ada_add_all_symbols (struct obstack *obstackp,
5667 const struct block *block,
5668 const lookup_name_info &lookup_name,
5669 domain_enum domain,
5670 int full_search,
5671 int *made_global_lookup_p)
5672 {
5673 struct symbol *sym;
5674
5675 if (made_global_lookup_p)
5676 *made_global_lookup_p = 0;
5677
5678 /* Special case: If the user specifies a symbol name inside package
5679 Standard, do a non-wild matching of the symbol name without
5680 the "standard__" prefix. This was primarily introduced in order
5681 to allow the user to specifically access the standard exceptions
5682 using, for instance, Standard.Constraint_Error when Constraint_Error
5683 is ambiguous (due to the user defining its own Constraint_Error
5684 entity inside its program). */
5685 if (lookup_name.ada ().standard_p ())
5686 block = NULL;
5687
5688 /* Check the non-global symbols. If we have ANY match, then we're done. */
5689
5690 if (block != NULL)
5691 {
5692 if (full_search)
5693 ada_add_local_symbols (obstackp, lookup_name, block, domain);
5694 else
5695 {
5696 /* In the !full_search case we're are being called by
5697 ada_iterate_over_symbols, and we don't want to search
5698 superblocks. */
5699 ada_add_block_symbols (obstackp, block, lookup_name, domain, NULL);
5700 }
5701 if (num_defns_collected (obstackp) > 0 || !full_search)
5702 return;
5703 }
5704
5705 /* No non-global symbols found. Check our cache to see if we have
5706 already performed this search before. If we have, then return
5707 the same result. */
5708
5709 if (lookup_cached_symbol (ada_lookup_name (lookup_name),
5710 domain, &sym, &block))
5711 {
5712 if (sym != NULL)
5713 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp, sym, block);
5714 return;
5715 }
5716
5717 if (made_global_lookup_p)
5718 *made_global_lookup_p = 1;
5719
5720 /* Search symbols from all global blocks. */
5721
5722 add_nonlocal_symbols (obstackp, lookup_name, domain, 1);
5723
5724 /* Now add symbols from all per-file blocks if we've gotten no hits
5725 (not strictly correct, but perhaps better than an error). */
5726
5727 if (num_defns_collected (obstackp) == 0)
5728 add_nonlocal_symbols (obstackp, lookup_name, domain, 0);
5729 }
5730
5731 /* Find symbols in DOMAIN matching LOOKUP_NAME, in BLOCK and, if FULL_SEARCH
5732 is non-zero, enclosing scope and in global scopes, returning the number of
5733 matches.
5734 Fills *RESULTS with (SYM,BLOCK) tuples, indicating the symbols
5735 found and the blocks and symbol tables (if any) in which they were
5736 found.
5737
5738 When full_search is non-zero, any non-function/non-enumeral
5739 symbol match within the nest of blocks whose innermost member is BLOCK,
5740 is the one match returned (no other matches in that or
5741 enclosing blocks is returned). If there are any matches in or
5742 surrounding BLOCK, then these alone are returned.
5743
5744 Names prefixed with "standard__" are handled specially: "standard__"
5745 is first stripped off, and only static and global symbols are searched. */
5746
5747 static int
5748 ada_lookup_symbol_list_worker (const lookup_name_info &lookup_name,
5749 const struct block *block,
5750 domain_enum domain,
5751 std::vector<struct block_symbol> *results,
5752 int full_search)
5753 {
5754 int syms_from_global_search;
5755 int ndefns;
5756 auto_obstack obstack;
5757
5758 ada_add_all_symbols (&obstack, block, lookup_name,
5759 domain, full_search, &syms_from_global_search);
5760
5761 ndefns = num_defns_collected (&obstack);
5762
5763 struct block_symbol *base = defns_collected (&obstack, 1);
5764 for (int i = 0; i < ndefns; ++i)
5765 results->push_back (base[i]);
5766
5767 ndefns = remove_extra_symbols (results);
5768
5769 if (ndefns == 0 && full_search && syms_from_global_search)
5770 cache_symbol (ada_lookup_name (lookup_name), domain, NULL, NULL);
5771
5772 if (ndefns == 1 && full_search && syms_from_global_search)
5773 cache_symbol (ada_lookup_name (lookup_name), domain,
5774 (*results)[0].symbol, (*results)[0].block);
5775
5776 ndefns = remove_irrelevant_renamings (results, block);
5777
5778 return ndefns;
5779 }
5780
5781 /* Find symbols in DOMAIN matching NAME, in BLOCK and enclosing scope and
5782 in global scopes, returning the number of matches, and filling *RESULTS
5783 with (SYM,BLOCK) tuples.
5784
5785 See ada_lookup_symbol_list_worker for further details. */
5786
5787 int
5788 ada_lookup_symbol_list (const char *name, const struct block *block,
5789 domain_enum domain,
5790 std::vector<struct block_symbol> *results)
5791 {
5792 symbol_name_match_type name_match_type = name_match_type_from_name (name);
5793 lookup_name_info lookup_name (name, name_match_type);
5794
5795 return ada_lookup_symbol_list_worker (lookup_name, block, domain, results, 1);
5796 }
5797
5798 /* Implementation of the la_iterate_over_symbols method. */
5799
5800 static bool
5801 ada_iterate_over_symbols
5802 (const struct block *block, const lookup_name_info &name,
5803 domain_enum domain,
5804 gdb::function_view<symbol_found_callback_ftype> callback)
5805 {
5806 int ndefs, i;
5807 std::vector<struct block_symbol> results;
5808
5809 ndefs = ada_lookup_symbol_list_worker (name, block, domain, &results, 0);
5810
5811 for (i = 0; i < ndefs; ++i)
5812 {
5813 if (!callback (&results[i]))
5814 return false;
5815 }
5816
5817 return true;
5818 }
5819
5820 /* The result is as for ada_lookup_symbol_list with FULL_SEARCH set
5821 to 1, but choosing the first symbol found if there are multiple
5822 choices.
5823
5824 The result is stored in *INFO, which must be non-NULL.
5825 If no match is found, INFO->SYM is set to NULL. */
5826
5827 void
5828 ada_lookup_encoded_symbol (const char *name, const struct block *block,
5829 domain_enum domain,
5830 struct block_symbol *info)
5831 {
5832 /* Since we already have an encoded name, wrap it in '<>' to force a
5833 verbatim match. Otherwise, if the name happens to not look like
5834 an encoded name (because it doesn't include a "__"),
5835 ada_lookup_name_info would re-encode/fold it again, and that
5836 would e.g., incorrectly lowercase object renaming names like
5837 "R28b" -> "r28b". */
5838 std::string verbatim = std::string ("<") + name + '>';
5839
5840 gdb_assert (info != NULL);
5841 *info = ada_lookup_symbol (verbatim.c_str (), block, domain);
5842 }
5843
5844 /* Return a symbol in DOMAIN matching NAME, in BLOCK0 and enclosing
5845 scope and in global scopes, or NULL if none. NAME is folded and
5846 encoded first. Otherwise, the result is as for ada_lookup_symbol_list,
5847 choosing the first symbol if there are multiple choices. */
5848
5849 struct block_symbol
5850 ada_lookup_symbol (const char *name, const struct block *block0,
5851 domain_enum domain)
5852 {
5853 std::vector<struct block_symbol> candidates;
5854 int n_candidates;
5855
5856 n_candidates = ada_lookup_symbol_list (name, block0, domain, &candidates);
5857
5858 if (n_candidates == 0)
5859 return {};
5860
5861 block_symbol info = candidates[0];
5862 info.symbol = fixup_symbol_section (info.symbol, NULL);
5863 return info;
5864 }
5865
5866 static struct block_symbol
5867 ada_lookup_symbol_nonlocal (const struct language_defn *langdef,
5868 const char *name,
5869 const struct block *block,
5870 const domain_enum domain)
5871 {
5872 struct block_symbol sym;
5873
5874 sym = ada_lookup_symbol (name, block_static_block (block), domain);
5875 if (sym.symbol != NULL)
5876 return sym;
5877
5878 /* If we haven't found a match at this point, try the primitive
5879 types. In other languages, this search is performed before
5880 searching for global symbols in order to short-circuit that
5881 global-symbol search if it happens that the name corresponds
5882 to a primitive type. But we cannot do the same in Ada, because
5883 it is perfectly legitimate for a program to declare a type which
5884 has the same name as a standard type. If looking up a type in
5885 that situation, we have traditionally ignored the primitive type
5886 in favor of user-defined types. This is why, unlike most other
5887 languages, we search the primitive types this late and only after
5888 having searched the global symbols without success. */
5889
5890 if (domain == VAR_DOMAIN)
5891 {
5892 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
5893
5894 if (block == NULL)
5895 gdbarch = target_gdbarch ();
5896 else
5897 gdbarch = block_gdbarch (block);
5898 sym.symbol = language_lookup_primitive_type_as_symbol (langdef, gdbarch, name);
5899 if (sym.symbol != NULL)
5900 return sym;
5901 }
5902
5903 return {};
5904 }
5905
5906
5907 /* True iff STR is a possible encoded suffix of a normal Ada name
5908 that is to be ignored for matching purposes. Suffixes of parallel
5909 names (e.g., XVE) are not included here. Currently, the possible suffixes
5910 are given by any of the regular expressions:
5911
5912 [.$][0-9]+ [nested subprogram suffix, on platforms such as GNU/Linux]
5913 ___[0-9]+ [nested subprogram suffix, on platforms such as HP/UX]
5914 TKB [subprogram suffix for task bodies]
5915 _E[0-9]+[bs]$ [protected object entry suffixes]
5916 (X[nb]*)?((\$|__)[0-9](_?[0-9]+)|___(JM|LJM|X([FDBUP].*|R[^T]?)))?$
5917
5918 Also, any leading "__[0-9]+" sequence is skipped before the suffix
5919 match is performed. This sequence is used to differentiate homonyms,
5920 is an optional part of a valid name suffix. */
5921
5922 static int
5923 is_name_suffix (const char *str)
5924 {
5925 int k;
5926 const char *matching;
5927 const int len = strlen (str);
5928
5929 /* Skip optional leading __[0-9]+. */
5930
5931 if (len > 3 && str[0] == '_' && str[1] == '_' && isdigit (str[2]))
5932 {
5933 str += 3;
5934 while (isdigit (str[0]))
5935 str += 1;
5936 }
5937
5938 /* [.$][0-9]+ */
5939
5940 if (str[0] == '.' || str[0] == '$')
5941 {
5942 matching = str + 1;
5943 while (isdigit (matching[0]))
5944 matching += 1;
5945 if (matching[0] == '\0')
5946 return 1;
5947 }
5948
5949 /* ___[0-9]+ */
5950
5951 if (len > 3 && str[0] == '_' && str[1] == '_' && str[2] == '_')
5952 {
5953 matching = str + 3;
5954 while (isdigit (matching[0]))
5955 matching += 1;
5956 if (matching[0] == '\0')
5957 return 1;
5958 }
5959
5960 /* "TKB" suffixes are used for subprograms implementing task bodies. */
5961
5962 if (strcmp (str, "TKB") == 0)
5963 return 1;
5964
5965 #if 0
5966 /* FIXME: brobecker/2005-09-23: Protected Object subprograms end
5967 with a N at the end. Unfortunately, the compiler uses the same
5968 convention for other internal types it creates. So treating
5969 all entity names that end with an "N" as a name suffix causes
5970 some regressions. For instance, consider the case of an enumerated
5971 type. To support the 'Image attribute, it creates an array whose
5972 name ends with N.
5973 Having a single character like this as a suffix carrying some
5974 information is a bit risky. Perhaps we should change the encoding
5975 to be something like "_N" instead. In the meantime, do not do
5976 the following check. */
5977 /* Protected Object Subprograms */
5978 if (len == 1 && str [0] == 'N')
5979 return 1;
5980 #endif
5981
5982 /* _E[0-9]+[bs]$ */
5983 if (len > 3 && str[0] == '_' && str [1] == 'E' && isdigit (str[2]))
5984 {
5985 matching = str + 3;
5986 while (isdigit (matching[0]))
5987 matching += 1;
5988 if ((matching[0] == 'b' || matching[0] == 's')
5989 && matching [1] == '\0')
5990 return 1;
5991 }
5992
5993 /* ??? We should not modify STR directly, as we are doing below. This
5994 is fine in this case, but may become problematic later if we find
5995 that this alternative did not work, and want to try matching
5996 another one from the begining of STR. Since we modified it, we
5997 won't be able to find the begining of the string anymore! */
5998 if (str[0] == 'X')
5999 {
6000 str += 1;
6001 while (str[0] != '_' && str[0] != '\0')
6002 {
6003 if (str[0] != 'n' && str[0] != 'b')
6004 return 0;
6005 str += 1;
6006 }
6007 }
6008
6009 if (str[0] == '\000')
6010 return 1;
6011
6012 if (str[0] == '_')
6013 {
6014 if (str[1] != '_' || str[2] == '\000')
6015 return 0;
6016 if (str[2] == '_')
6017 {
6018 if (strcmp (str + 3, "JM") == 0)
6019 return 1;
6020 /* FIXME: brobecker/2004-09-30: GNAT will soon stop using
6021 the LJM suffix in favor of the JM one. But we will
6022 still accept LJM as a valid suffix for a reasonable
6023 amount of time, just to allow ourselves to debug programs
6024 compiled using an older version of GNAT. */
6025 if (strcmp (str + 3, "LJM") == 0)
6026 return 1;
6027 if (str[3] != 'X')
6028 return 0;
6029 if (str[4] == 'F' || str[4] == 'D' || str[4] == 'B'
6030 || str[4] == 'U' || str[4] == 'P')
6031 return 1;
6032 if (str[4] == 'R' && str[5] != 'T')
6033 return 1;
6034 return 0;
6035 }
6036 if (!isdigit (str[2]))
6037 return 0;
6038 for (k = 3; str[k] != '\0'; k += 1)
6039 if (!isdigit (str[k]) && str[k] != '_')
6040 return 0;
6041 return 1;
6042 }
6043 if (str[0] == '$' && isdigit (str[1]))
6044 {
6045 for (k = 2; str[k] != '\0'; k += 1)
6046 if (!isdigit (str[k]) && str[k] != '_')
6047 return 0;
6048 return 1;
6049 }
6050 return 0;
6051 }
6052
6053 /* Return non-zero if the string starting at NAME and ending before
6054 NAME_END contains no capital letters. */
6055
6056 static int
6057 is_valid_name_for_wild_match (const char *name0)
6058 {
6059 std::string decoded_name = ada_decode (name0);
6060 int i;
6061
6062 /* If the decoded name starts with an angle bracket, it means that
6063 NAME0 does not follow the GNAT encoding format. It should then
6064 not be allowed as a possible wild match. */
6065 if (decoded_name[0] == '<')
6066 return 0;
6067
6068 for (i=0; decoded_name[i] != '\0'; i++)
6069 if (isalpha (decoded_name[i]) && !islower (decoded_name[i]))
6070 return 0;
6071
6072 return 1;
6073 }
6074
6075 /* Advance *NAMEP to next occurrence of TARGET0 in the string NAME0
6076 that could start a simple name. Assumes that *NAMEP points into
6077 the string beginning at NAME0. */
6078
6079 static int
6080 advance_wild_match (const char **namep, const char *name0, int target0)
6081 {
6082 const char *name = *namep;
6083
6084 while (1)
6085 {
6086 int t0, t1;
6087
6088 t0 = *name;
6089 if (t0 == '_')
6090 {
6091 t1 = name[1];
6092 if ((t1 >= 'a' && t1 <= 'z') || (t1 >= '0' && t1 <= '9'))
6093 {
6094 name += 1;
6095 if (name == name0 + 5 && startswith (name0, "_ada"))
6096 break;
6097 else
6098 name += 1;
6099 }
6100 else if (t1 == '_' && ((name[2] >= 'a' && name[2] <= 'z')
6101 || name[2] == target0))
6102 {
6103 name += 2;
6104 break;
6105 }
6106 else
6107 return 0;
6108 }
6109 else if ((t0 >= 'a' && t0 <= 'z') || (t0 >= '0' && t0 <= '9'))
6110 name += 1;
6111 else
6112 return 0;
6113 }
6114
6115 *namep = name;
6116 return 1;
6117 }
6118
6119 /* Return true iff NAME encodes a name of the form prefix.PATN.
6120 Ignores any informational suffixes of NAME (i.e., for which
6121 is_name_suffix is true). Assumes that PATN is a lower-cased Ada
6122 simple name. */
6123
6124 static bool
6125 wild_match (const char *name, const char *patn)
6126 {
6127 const char *p;
6128 const char *name0 = name;
6129
6130 while (1)
6131 {
6132 const char *match = name;
6133
6134 if (*name == *patn)
6135 {
6136 for (name += 1, p = patn + 1; *p != '\0'; name += 1, p += 1)
6137 if (*p != *name)
6138 break;
6139 if (*p == '\0' && is_name_suffix (name))
6140 return match == name0 || is_valid_name_for_wild_match (name0);
6141
6142 if (name[-1] == '_')
6143 name -= 1;
6144 }
6145 if (!advance_wild_match (&name, name0, *patn))
6146 return false;
6147 }
6148 }
6149
6150 /* Returns true iff symbol name SYM_NAME matches SEARCH_NAME, ignoring
6151 any trailing suffixes that encode debugging information or leading
6152 _ada_ on SYM_NAME (see is_name_suffix commentary for the debugging
6153 information that is ignored). */
6154
6155 static bool
6156 full_match (const char *sym_name, const char *search_name)
6157 {
6158 size_t search_name_len = strlen (search_name);
6159
6160 if (strncmp (sym_name, search_name, search_name_len) == 0
6161 && is_name_suffix (sym_name + search_name_len))
6162 return true;
6163
6164 if (startswith (sym_name, "_ada_")
6165 && strncmp (sym_name + 5, search_name, search_name_len) == 0
6166 && is_name_suffix (sym_name + search_name_len + 5))
6167 return true;
6168
6169 return false;
6170 }
6171
6172 /* Add symbols from BLOCK matching LOOKUP_NAME in DOMAIN to vector
6173 *defn_symbols, updating the list of symbols in OBSTACKP (if
6174 necessary). OBJFILE is the section containing BLOCK. */
6175
6176 static void
6177 ada_add_block_symbols (struct obstack *obstackp,
6178 const struct block *block,
6179 const lookup_name_info &lookup_name,
6180 domain_enum domain, struct objfile *objfile)
6181 {
6182 struct block_iterator iter;
6183 /* A matching argument symbol, if any. */
6184 struct symbol *arg_sym;
6185 /* Set true when we find a matching non-argument symbol. */
6186 int found_sym;
6187 struct symbol *sym;
6188
6189 arg_sym = NULL;
6190 found_sym = 0;
6191 for (sym = block_iter_match_first (block, lookup_name, &iter);
6192 sym != NULL;
6193 sym = block_iter_match_next (lookup_name, &iter))
6194 {
6195 if (symbol_matches_domain (sym->language (), SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym), domain))
6196 {
6197 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_UNRESOLVED)
6198 {
6199 if (SYMBOL_IS_ARGUMENT (sym))
6200 arg_sym = sym;
6201 else
6202 {
6203 found_sym = 1;
6204 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
6205 fixup_symbol_section (sym, objfile),
6206 block);
6207 }
6208 }
6209 }
6210 }
6211
6212 /* Handle renamings. */
6213
6214 if (ada_add_block_renamings (obstackp, block, lookup_name, domain))
6215 found_sym = 1;
6216
6217 if (!found_sym && arg_sym != NULL)
6218 {
6219 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
6220 fixup_symbol_section (arg_sym, objfile),
6221 block);
6222 }
6223
6224 if (!lookup_name.ada ().wild_match_p ())
6225 {
6226 arg_sym = NULL;
6227 found_sym = 0;
6228 const std::string &ada_lookup_name = lookup_name.ada ().lookup_name ();
6229 const char *name = ada_lookup_name.c_str ();
6230 size_t name_len = ada_lookup_name.size ();
6231
6232 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (block, iter, sym)
6233 {
6234 if (symbol_matches_domain (sym->language (),
6235 SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym), domain))
6236 {
6237 int cmp;
6238
6239 cmp = (int) '_' - (int) sym->linkage_name ()[0];
6240 if (cmp == 0)
6241 {
6242 cmp = !startswith (sym->linkage_name (), "_ada_");
6243 if (cmp == 0)
6244 cmp = strncmp (name, sym->linkage_name () + 5,
6245 name_len);
6246 }
6247
6248 if (cmp == 0
6249 && is_name_suffix (sym->linkage_name () + name_len + 5))
6250 {
6251 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_UNRESOLVED)
6252 {
6253 if (SYMBOL_IS_ARGUMENT (sym))
6254 arg_sym = sym;
6255 else
6256 {
6257 found_sym = 1;
6258 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
6259 fixup_symbol_section (sym, objfile),
6260 block);
6261 }
6262 }
6263 }
6264 }
6265 }
6266
6267 /* NOTE: This really shouldn't be needed for _ada_ symbols.
6268 They aren't parameters, right? */
6269 if (!found_sym && arg_sym != NULL)
6270 {
6271 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
6272 fixup_symbol_section (arg_sym, objfile),
6273 block);
6274 }
6275 }
6276 }
6277 \f
6278
6279 /* Symbol Completion */
6280
6281 /* See symtab.h. */
6282
6283 bool
6284 ada_lookup_name_info::matches
6285 (const char *sym_name,
6286 symbol_name_match_type match_type,
6287 completion_match_result *comp_match_res) const
6288 {
6289 bool match = false;
6290 const char *text = m_encoded_name.c_str ();
6291 size_t text_len = m_encoded_name.size ();
6292
6293 /* First, test against the fully qualified name of the symbol. */
6294
6295 if (strncmp (sym_name, text, text_len) == 0)
6296 match = true;
6297
6298 std::string decoded_name = ada_decode (sym_name);
6299 if (match && !m_encoded_p)
6300 {
6301 /* One needed check before declaring a positive match is to verify
6302 that iff we are doing a verbatim match, the decoded version
6303 of the symbol name starts with '<'. Otherwise, this symbol name
6304 is not a suitable completion. */
6305
6306 bool has_angle_bracket = (decoded_name[0] == '<');
6307 match = (has_angle_bracket == m_verbatim_p);
6308 }
6309
6310 if (match && !m_verbatim_p)
6311 {
6312 /* When doing non-verbatim match, another check that needs to
6313 be done is to verify that the potentially matching symbol name
6314 does not include capital letters, because the ada-mode would
6315 not be able to understand these symbol names without the
6316 angle bracket notation. */
6317 const char *tmp;
6318
6319 for (tmp = sym_name; *tmp != '\0' && !isupper (*tmp); tmp++);
6320 if (*tmp != '\0')
6321 match = false;
6322 }
6323
6324 /* Second: Try wild matching... */
6325
6326 if (!match && m_wild_match_p)
6327 {
6328 /* Since we are doing wild matching, this means that TEXT
6329 may represent an unqualified symbol name. We therefore must
6330 also compare TEXT against the unqualified name of the symbol. */
6331 sym_name = ada_unqualified_name (decoded_name.c_str ());
6332
6333 if (strncmp (sym_name, text, text_len) == 0)
6334 match = true;
6335 }
6336
6337 /* Finally: If we found a match, prepare the result to return. */
6338
6339 if (!match)
6340 return false;
6341
6342 if (comp_match_res != NULL)
6343 {
6344 std::string &match_str = comp_match_res->match.storage ();
6345
6346 if (!m_encoded_p)
6347 match_str = ada_decode (sym_name);
6348 else
6349 {
6350 if (m_verbatim_p)
6351 match_str = add_angle_brackets (sym_name);
6352 else
6353 match_str = sym_name;
6354
6355 }
6356
6357 comp_match_res->set_match (match_str.c_str ());
6358 }
6359
6360 return true;
6361 }
6362
6363 /* Add the list of possible symbol names completing TEXT to TRACKER.
6364 WORD is the entire command on which completion is made. */
6365
6366 static void
6367 ada_collect_symbol_completion_matches (completion_tracker &tracker,
6368 complete_symbol_mode mode,
6369 symbol_name_match_type name_match_type,
6370 const char *text, const char *word,
6371 enum type_code code)
6372 {
6373 struct symbol *sym;
6374 const struct block *b, *surrounding_static_block = 0;
6375 struct block_iterator iter;
6376
6377 gdb_assert (code == TYPE_CODE_UNDEF);
6378
6379 lookup_name_info lookup_name (text, name_match_type, true);
6380
6381 /* First, look at the partial symtab symbols. */
6382 expand_symtabs_matching (NULL,
6383 lookup_name,
6384 NULL,
6385 NULL,
6386 ALL_DOMAIN);
6387
6388 /* At this point scan through the misc symbol vectors and add each
6389 symbol you find to the list. Eventually we want to ignore
6390 anything that isn't a text symbol (everything else will be
6391 handled by the psymtab code above). */
6392
6393 for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
6394 {
6395 for (minimal_symbol *msymbol : objfile->msymbols ())
6396 {
6397 QUIT;
6398
6399 if (completion_skip_symbol (mode, msymbol))
6400 continue;
6401
6402 language symbol_language = msymbol->language ();
6403
6404 /* Ada minimal symbols won't have their language set to Ada. If
6405 we let completion_list_add_name compare using the
6406 default/C-like matcher, then when completing e.g., symbols in a
6407 package named "pck", we'd match internal Ada symbols like
6408 "pckS", which are invalid in an Ada expression, unless you wrap
6409 them in '<' '>' to request a verbatim match.
6410
6411 Unfortunately, some Ada encoded names successfully demangle as
6412 C++ symbols (using an old mangling scheme), such as "name__2Xn"
6413 -> "Xn::name(void)" and thus some Ada minimal symbols end up
6414 with the wrong language set. Paper over that issue here. */
6415 if (symbol_language == language_auto
6416 || symbol_language == language_cplus)
6417 symbol_language = language_ada;
6418
6419 completion_list_add_name (tracker,
6420 symbol_language,
6421 msymbol->linkage_name (),
6422 lookup_name, text, word);
6423 }
6424 }
6425
6426 /* Search upwards from currently selected frame (so that we can
6427 complete on local vars. */
6428
6429 for (b = get_selected_block (0); b != NULL; b = BLOCK_SUPERBLOCK (b))
6430 {
6431 if (!BLOCK_SUPERBLOCK (b))
6432 surrounding_static_block = b; /* For elmin of dups */
6433
6434 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, sym)
6435 {
6436 if (completion_skip_symbol (mode, sym))
6437 continue;
6438
6439 completion_list_add_name (tracker,
6440 sym->language (),
6441 sym->linkage_name (),
6442 lookup_name, text, word);
6443 }
6444 }
6445
6446 /* Go through the symtabs and check the externs and statics for
6447 symbols which match. */
6448
6449 for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
6450 {
6451 for (compunit_symtab *s : objfile->compunits ())
6452 {
6453 QUIT;
6454 b = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (COMPUNIT_BLOCKVECTOR (s), GLOBAL_BLOCK);
6455 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, sym)
6456 {
6457 if (completion_skip_symbol (mode, sym))
6458 continue;
6459
6460 completion_list_add_name (tracker,
6461 sym->language (),
6462 sym->linkage_name (),
6463 lookup_name, text, word);
6464 }
6465 }
6466 }
6467
6468 for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
6469 {
6470 for (compunit_symtab *s : objfile->compunits ())
6471 {
6472 QUIT;
6473 b = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (COMPUNIT_BLOCKVECTOR (s), STATIC_BLOCK);
6474 /* Don't do this block twice. */
6475 if (b == surrounding_static_block)
6476 continue;
6477 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, sym)
6478 {
6479 if (completion_skip_symbol (mode, sym))
6480 continue;
6481
6482 completion_list_add_name (tracker,
6483 sym->language (),
6484 sym->linkage_name (),
6485 lookup_name, text, word);
6486 }
6487 }
6488 }
6489 }
6490
6491 /* Field Access */
6492
6493 /* Return non-zero if TYPE is a pointer to the GNAT dispatch table used
6494 for tagged types. */
6495
6496 static int
6497 ada_is_dispatch_table_ptr_type (struct type *type)
6498 {
6499 const char *name;
6500
6501 if (type->code () != TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6502 return 0;
6503
6504 name = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)->name ();
6505 if (name == NULL)
6506 return 0;
6507
6508 return (strcmp (name, "ada__tags__dispatch_table") == 0);
6509 }
6510
6511 /* Return non-zero if TYPE is an interface tag. */
6512
6513 static int
6514 ada_is_interface_tag (struct type *type)
6515 {
6516 const char *name = type->name ();
6517
6518 if (name == NULL)
6519 return 0;
6520
6521 return (strcmp (name, "ada__tags__interface_tag") == 0);
6522 }
6523
6524 /* True if field number FIELD_NUM in struct or union type TYPE is supposed
6525 to be invisible to users. */
6526
6527 int
6528 ada_is_ignored_field (struct type *type, int field_num)
6529 {
6530 if (field_num < 0 || field_num > TYPE_NFIELDS (type))
6531 return 1;
6532
6533 /* Check the name of that field. */
6534 {
6535 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
6536
6537 /* Anonymous field names should not be printed.
6538 brobecker/2007-02-20: I don't think this can actually happen
6539 but we don't want to print the value of anonymous fields anyway. */
6540 if (name == NULL)
6541 return 1;
6542
6543 /* Normally, fields whose name start with an underscore ("_")
6544 are fields that have been internally generated by the compiler,
6545 and thus should not be printed. The "_parent" field is special,
6546 however: This is a field internally generated by the compiler
6547 for tagged types, and it contains the components inherited from
6548 the parent type. This field should not be printed as is, but
6549 should not be ignored either. */
6550 if (name[0] == '_' && !startswith (name, "_parent"))
6551 return 1;
6552 }
6553
6554 /* If this is the dispatch table of a tagged type or an interface tag,
6555 then ignore. */
6556 if (ada_is_tagged_type (type, 1)
6557 && (ada_is_dispatch_table_ptr_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, field_num))
6558 || ada_is_interface_tag (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, field_num))))
6559 return 1;
6560
6561 /* Not a special field, so it should not be ignored. */
6562 return 0;
6563 }
6564
6565 /* True iff TYPE has a tag field. If REFOK, then TYPE may also be a
6566 pointer or reference type whose ultimate target has a tag field. */
6567
6568 int
6569 ada_is_tagged_type (struct type *type, int refok)
6570 {
6571 return (ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "_tag", refok, 1) != NULL);
6572 }
6573
6574 /* True iff TYPE represents the type of X'Tag */
6575
6576 int
6577 ada_is_tag_type (struct type *type)
6578 {
6579 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
6580
6581 if (type == NULL || type->code () != TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6582 return 0;
6583 else
6584 {
6585 const char *name = ada_type_name (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
6586
6587 return (name != NULL
6588 && strcmp (name, "ada__tags__dispatch_table") == 0);
6589 }
6590 }
6591
6592 /* The type of the tag on VAL. */
6593
6594 static struct type *
6595 ada_tag_type (struct value *val)
6596 {
6597 return ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (value_type (val), "_tag", 1, 0);
6598 }
6599
6600 /* Return 1 if TAG follows the old scheme for Ada tags (used for Ada 95,
6601 retired at Ada 05). */
6602
6603 static int
6604 is_ada95_tag (struct value *tag)
6605 {
6606 return ada_value_struct_elt (tag, "tsd", 1) != NULL;
6607 }
6608
6609 /* The value of the tag on VAL. */
6610
6611 static struct value *
6612 ada_value_tag (struct value *val)
6613 {
6614 return ada_value_struct_elt (val, "_tag", 0);
6615 }
6616
6617 /* The value of the tag on the object of type TYPE whose contents are
6618 saved at VALADDR, if it is non-null, or is at memory address
6619 ADDRESS. */
6620
6621 static struct value *
6622 value_tag_from_contents_and_address (struct type *type,
6623 const gdb_byte *valaddr,
6624 CORE_ADDR address)
6625 {
6626 int tag_byte_offset;
6627 struct type *tag_type;
6628
6629 if (find_struct_field ("_tag", type, 0, &tag_type, &tag_byte_offset,
6630 NULL, NULL, NULL))
6631 {
6632 const gdb_byte *valaddr1 = ((valaddr == NULL)
6633 ? NULL
6634 : valaddr + tag_byte_offset);
6635 CORE_ADDR address1 = (address == 0) ? 0 : address + tag_byte_offset;
6636
6637 return value_from_contents_and_address (tag_type, valaddr1, address1);
6638 }
6639 return NULL;
6640 }
6641
6642 static struct type *
6643 type_from_tag (struct value *tag)
6644 {
6645 const char *type_name = ada_tag_name (tag);
6646
6647 if (type_name != NULL)
6648 return ada_find_any_type (ada_encode (type_name));
6649 return NULL;
6650 }
6651
6652 /* Given a value OBJ of a tagged type, return a value of this
6653 type at the base address of the object. The base address, as
6654 defined in Ada.Tags, it is the address of the primary tag of
6655 the object, and therefore where the field values of its full
6656 view can be fetched. */
6657
6658 struct value *
6659 ada_tag_value_at_base_address (struct value *obj)
6660 {
6661 struct value *val;
6662 LONGEST offset_to_top = 0;
6663 struct type *ptr_type, *obj_type;
6664 struct value *tag;
6665 CORE_ADDR base_address;
6666
6667 obj_type = value_type (obj);
6668
6669 /* It is the responsability of the caller to deref pointers. */
6670
6671 if (obj_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR || obj_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_REF)
6672 return obj;
6673
6674 tag = ada_value_tag (obj);
6675 if (!tag)
6676 return obj;
6677
6678 /* Base addresses only appeared with Ada 05 and multiple inheritance. */
6679
6680 if (is_ada95_tag (tag))
6681 return obj;
6682
6683 ptr_type = language_lookup_primitive_type
6684 (language_def (language_ada), target_gdbarch(), "storage_offset");
6685 ptr_type = lookup_pointer_type (ptr_type);
6686 val = value_cast (ptr_type, tag);
6687 if (!val)
6688 return obj;
6689
6690 /* It is perfectly possible that an exception be raised while
6691 trying to determine the base address, just like for the tag;
6692 see ada_tag_name for more details. We do not print the error
6693 message for the same reason. */
6694
6695 try
6696 {
6697 offset_to_top = value_as_long (value_ind (value_ptradd (val, -2)));
6698 }
6699
6700 catch (const gdb_exception_error &e)
6701 {
6702 return obj;
6703 }
6704
6705 /* If offset is null, nothing to do. */
6706
6707 if (offset_to_top == 0)
6708 return obj;
6709
6710 /* -1 is a special case in Ada.Tags; however, what should be done
6711 is not quite clear from the documentation. So do nothing for
6712 now. */
6713
6714 if (offset_to_top == -1)
6715 return obj;
6716
6717 /* OFFSET_TO_TOP used to be a positive value to be subtracted
6718 from the base address. This was however incompatible with
6719 C++ dispatch table: C++ uses a *negative* value to *add*
6720 to the base address. Ada's convention has therefore been
6721 changed in GNAT 19.0w 20171023: since then, C++ and Ada
6722 use the same convention. Here, we support both cases by
6723 checking the sign of OFFSET_TO_TOP. */
6724
6725 if (offset_to_top > 0)
6726 offset_to_top = -offset_to_top;
6727
6728 base_address = value_address (obj) + offset_to_top;
6729 tag = value_tag_from_contents_and_address (obj_type, NULL, base_address);
6730
6731 /* Make sure that we have a proper tag at the new address.
6732 Otherwise, offset_to_top is bogus (which can happen when
6733 the object is not initialized yet). */
6734
6735 if (!tag)
6736 return obj;
6737
6738 obj_type = type_from_tag (tag);
6739
6740 if (!obj_type)
6741 return obj;
6742
6743 return value_from_contents_and_address (obj_type, NULL, base_address);
6744 }
6745
6746 /* Return the "ada__tags__type_specific_data" type. */
6747
6748 static struct type *
6749 ada_get_tsd_type (struct inferior *inf)
6750 {
6751 struct ada_inferior_data *data = get_ada_inferior_data (inf);
6752
6753 if (data->tsd_type == 0)
6754 data->tsd_type = ada_find_any_type ("ada__tags__type_specific_data");
6755 return data->tsd_type;
6756 }
6757
6758 /* Return the TSD (type-specific data) associated to the given TAG.
6759 TAG is assumed to be the tag of a tagged-type entity.
6760
6761 May return NULL if we are unable to get the TSD. */
6762
6763 static struct value *
6764 ada_get_tsd_from_tag (struct value *tag)
6765 {
6766 struct value *val;
6767 struct type *type;
6768
6769 /* First option: The TSD is simply stored as a field of our TAG.
6770 Only older versions of GNAT would use this format, but we have
6771 to test it first, because there are no visible markers for
6772 the current approach except the absence of that field. */
6773
6774 val = ada_value_struct_elt (tag, "tsd", 1);
6775 if (val)
6776 return val;
6777
6778 /* Try the second representation for the dispatch table (in which
6779 there is no explicit 'tsd' field in the referent of the tag pointer,
6780 and instead the tsd pointer is stored just before the dispatch
6781 table. */
6782
6783 type = ada_get_tsd_type (current_inferior());
6784 if (type == NULL)
6785 return NULL;
6786 type = lookup_pointer_type (lookup_pointer_type (type));
6787 val = value_cast (type, tag);
6788 if (val == NULL)
6789 return NULL;
6790 return value_ind (value_ptradd (val, -1));
6791 }
6792
6793 /* Given the TSD of a tag (type-specific data), return a string
6794 containing the name of the associated type.
6795
6796 The returned value is good until the next call. May return NULL
6797 if we are unable to determine the tag name. */
6798
6799 static char *
6800 ada_tag_name_from_tsd (struct value *tsd)
6801 {
6802 static char name[1024];
6803 char *p;
6804 struct value *val;
6805
6806 val = ada_value_struct_elt (tsd, "expanded_name", 1);
6807 if (val == NULL)
6808 return NULL;
6809 read_memory_string (value_as_address (val), name, sizeof (name) - 1);
6810 for (p = name; *p != '\0'; p += 1)
6811 if (isalpha (*p))
6812 *p = tolower (*p);
6813 return name;
6814 }
6815
6816 /* The type name of the dynamic type denoted by the 'tag value TAG, as
6817 a C string.
6818
6819 Return NULL if the TAG is not an Ada tag, or if we were unable to
6820 determine the name of that tag. The result is good until the next
6821 call. */
6822
6823 const char *
6824 ada_tag_name (struct value *tag)
6825 {
6826 char *name = NULL;
6827
6828 if (!ada_is_tag_type (value_type (tag)))
6829 return NULL;
6830
6831 /* It is perfectly possible that an exception be raised while trying
6832 to determine the TAG's name, even under normal circumstances:
6833 The associated variable may be uninitialized or corrupted, for
6834 instance. We do not let any exception propagate past this point.
6835 instead we return NULL.
6836
6837 We also do not print the error message either (which often is very
6838 low-level (Eg: "Cannot read memory at 0x[...]"), but instead let
6839 the caller print a more meaningful message if necessary. */
6840 try
6841 {
6842 struct value *tsd = ada_get_tsd_from_tag (tag);
6843
6844 if (tsd != NULL)
6845 name = ada_tag_name_from_tsd (tsd);
6846 }
6847 catch (const gdb_exception_error &e)
6848 {
6849 }
6850
6851 return name;
6852 }
6853
6854 /* The parent type of TYPE, or NULL if none. */
6855
6856 struct type *
6857 ada_parent_type (struct type *type)
6858 {
6859 int i;
6860
6861 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
6862
6863 if (type == NULL || type->code () != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
6864 return NULL;
6865
6866 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
6867 if (ada_is_parent_field (type, i))
6868 {
6869 struct type *parent_type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i);
6870
6871 /* If the _parent field is a pointer, then dereference it. */
6872 if (parent_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6873 parent_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (parent_type);
6874 /* If there is a parallel XVS type, get the actual base type. */
6875 parent_type = ada_get_base_type (parent_type);
6876
6877 return ada_check_typedef (parent_type);
6878 }
6879
6880 return NULL;
6881 }
6882
6883 /* True iff field number FIELD_NUM of structure type TYPE contains the
6884 parent-type (inherited) fields of a derived type. Assumes TYPE is
6885 a structure type with at least FIELD_NUM+1 fields. */
6886
6887 int
6888 ada_is_parent_field (struct type *type, int field_num)
6889 {
6890 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (ada_check_typedef (type), field_num);
6891
6892 return (name != NULL
6893 && (startswith (name, "PARENT")
6894 || startswith (name, "_parent")));
6895 }
6896
6897 /* True iff field number FIELD_NUM of structure type TYPE is a
6898 transparent wrapper field (which should be silently traversed when doing
6899 field selection and flattened when printing). Assumes TYPE is a
6900 structure type with at least FIELD_NUM+1 fields. Such fields are always
6901 structures. */
6902
6903 int
6904 ada_is_wrapper_field (struct type *type, int field_num)
6905 {
6906 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
6907
6908 if (name != NULL && strcmp (name, "RETVAL") == 0)
6909 {
6910 /* This happens in functions with "out" or "in out" parameters
6911 which are passed by copy. For such functions, GNAT describes
6912 the function's return type as being a struct where the return
6913 value is in a field called RETVAL, and where the other "out"
6914 or "in out" parameters are fields of that struct. This is not
6915 a wrapper. */
6916 return 0;
6917 }
6918
6919 return (name != NULL
6920 && (startswith (name, "PARENT")
6921 || strcmp (name, "REP") == 0
6922 || startswith (name, "_parent")
6923 || name[0] == 'S' || name[0] == 'R' || name[0] == 'O'));
6924 }
6925
6926 /* True iff field number FIELD_NUM of structure or union type TYPE
6927 is a variant wrapper. Assumes TYPE is a structure type with at least
6928 FIELD_NUM+1 fields. */
6929
6930 int
6931 ada_is_variant_part (struct type *type, int field_num)
6932 {
6933 /* Only Ada types are eligible. */
6934 if (!ADA_TYPE_P (type))
6935 return 0;
6936
6937 struct type *field_type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, field_num);
6938
6939 return (field_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_UNION
6940 || (is_dynamic_field (type, field_num)
6941 && (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (field_type)->code ()
6942 == TYPE_CODE_UNION)));
6943 }
6944
6945 /* Assuming that VAR_TYPE is a variant wrapper (type of the variant part)
6946 whose discriminants are contained in the record type OUTER_TYPE,
6947 returns the type of the controlling discriminant for the variant.
6948 May return NULL if the type could not be found. */
6949
6950 struct type *
6951 ada_variant_discrim_type (struct type *var_type, struct type *outer_type)
6952 {
6953 const char *name = ada_variant_discrim_name (var_type);
6954
6955 return ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (outer_type, name, 1, 1);
6956 }
6957
6958 /* Assuming that TYPE is the type of a variant wrapper, and FIELD_NUM is a
6959 valid field number within it, returns 1 iff field FIELD_NUM of TYPE
6960 represents a 'when others' clause; otherwise 0. */
6961
6962 static int
6963 ada_is_others_clause (struct type *type, int field_num)
6964 {
6965 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
6966
6967 return (name != NULL && name[0] == 'O');
6968 }
6969
6970 /* Assuming that TYPE0 is the type of the variant part of a record,
6971 returns the name of the discriminant controlling the variant.
6972 The value is valid until the next call to ada_variant_discrim_name. */
6973
6974 const char *
6975 ada_variant_discrim_name (struct type *type0)
6976 {
6977 static char *result = NULL;
6978 static size_t result_len = 0;
6979 struct type *type;
6980 const char *name;
6981 const char *discrim_end;
6982 const char *discrim_start;
6983
6984 if (type0->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6985 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0);
6986 else
6987 type = type0;
6988
6989 name = ada_type_name (type);
6990
6991 if (name == NULL || name[0] == '\000')
6992 return "";
6993
6994 for (discrim_end = name + strlen (name) - 6; discrim_end != name;
6995 discrim_end -= 1)
6996 {
6997 if (startswith (discrim_end, "___XVN"))
6998 break;
6999 }
7000 if (discrim_end == name)
7001 return "";
7002
7003 for (discrim_start = discrim_end; discrim_start != name + 3;
7004 discrim_start -= 1)
7005 {
7006 if (discrim_start == name + 1)
7007 return "";
7008 if ((discrim_start > name + 3
7009 && startswith (discrim_start - 3, "___"))
7010 || discrim_start[-1] == '.')
7011 break;
7012 }
7013
7014 GROW_VECT (result, result_len, discrim_end - discrim_start + 1);
7015 strncpy (result, discrim_start, discrim_end - discrim_start);
7016 result[discrim_end - discrim_start] = '\0';
7017 return result;
7018 }
7019
7020 /* Scan STR for a subtype-encoded number, beginning at position K.
7021 Put the position of the character just past the number scanned in
7022 *NEW_K, if NEW_K!=NULL. Put the scanned number in *R, if R!=NULL.
7023 Return 1 if there was a valid number at the given position, and 0
7024 otherwise. A "subtype-encoded" number consists of the absolute value
7025 in decimal, followed by the letter 'm' to indicate a negative number.
7026 Assumes 0m does not occur. */
7027
7028 int
7029 ada_scan_number (const char str[], int k, LONGEST * R, int *new_k)
7030 {
7031 ULONGEST RU;
7032
7033 if (!isdigit (str[k]))
7034 return 0;
7035
7036 /* Do it the hard way so as not to make any assumption about
7037 the relationship of unsigned long (%lu scan format code) and
7038 LONGEST. */
7039 RU = 0;
7040 while (isdigit (str[k]))
7041 {
7042 RU = RU * 10 + (str[k] - '0');
7043 k += 1;
7044 }
7045
7046 if (str[k] == 'm')
7047 {
7048 if (R != NULL)
7049 *R = (-(LONGEST) (RU - 1)) - 1;
7050 k += 1;
7051 }
7052 else if (R != NULL)
7053 *R = (LONGEST) RU;
7054
7055 /* NOTE on the above: Technically, C does not say what the results of
7056 - (LONGEST) RU or (LONGEST) -RU are for RU == largest positive
7057 number representable as a LONGEST (although either would probably work
7058 in most implementations). When RU>0, the locution in the then branch
7059 above is always equivalent to the negative of RU. */
7060
7061 if (new_k != NULL)
7062 *new_k = k;
7063 return 1;
7064 }
7065
7066 /* Assuming that TYPE is a variant part wrapper type (a VARIANTS field),
7067 and FIELD_NUM is a valid field number within it, returns 1 iff VAL is
7068 in the range encoded by field FIELD_NUM of TYPE; otherwise 0. */
7069
7070 static int
7071 ada_in_variant (LONGEST val, struct type *type, int field_num)
7072 {
7073 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
7074 int p;
7075
7076 p = 0;
7077 while (1)
7078 {
7079 switch (name[p])
7080 {
7081 case '\0':
7082 return 0;
7083 case 'S':
7084 {
7085 LONGEST W;
7086
7087 if (!ada_scan_number (name, p + 1, &W, &p))
7088 return 0;
7089 if (val == W)
7090 return 1;
7091 break;
7092 }
7093 case 'R':
7094 {
7095 LONGEST L, U;
7096
7097 if (!ada_scan_number (name, p + 1, &L, &p)
7098 || name[p] != 'T' || !ada_scan_number (name, p + 1, &U, &p))
7099 return 0;
7100 if (val >= L && val <= U)
7101 return 1;
7102 break;
7103 }
7104 case 'O':
7105 return 1;
7106 default:
7107 return 0;
7108 }
7109 }
7110 }
7111
7112 /* FIXME: Lots of redundancy below. Try to consolidate. */
7113
7114 /* Given a value ARG1 (offset by OFFSET bytes) of a struct or union type
7115 ARG_TYPE, extract and return the value of one of its (non-static)
7116 fields. FIELDNO says which field. Differs from value_primitive_field
7117 only in that it can handle packed values of arbitrary type. */
7118
7119 struct value *
7120 ada_value_primitive_field (struct value *arg1, int offset, int fieldno,
7121 struct type *arg_type)
7122 {
7123 struct type *type;
7124
7125 arg_type = ada_check_typedef (arg_type);
7126 type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (arg_type, fieldno);
7127
7128 /* Handle packed fields. It might be that the field is not packed
7129 relative to its containing structure, but the structure itself is
7130 packed; in this case we must take the bit-field path. */
7131 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (arg_type, fieldno) != 0 || value_bitpos (arg1) != 0)
7132 {
7133 int bit_pos = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (arg_type, fieldno);
7134 int bit_size = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (arg_type, fieldno);
7135
7136 return ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arg1, value_contents (arg1),
7137 offset + bit_pos / 8,
7138 bit_pos % 8, bit_size, type);
7139 }
7140 else
7141 return value_primitive_field (arg1, offset, fieldno, arg_type);
7142 }
7143
7144 /* Find field with name NAME in object of type TYPE. If found,
7145 set the following for each argument that is non-null:
7146 - *FIELD_TYPE_P to the field's type;
7147 - *BYTE_OFFSET_P to OFFSET + the byte offset of the field within
7148 an object of that type;
7149 - *BIT_OFFSET_P to the bit offset modulo byte size of the field;
7150 - *BIT_SIZE_P to its size in bits if the field is packed, and
7151 0 otherwise;
7152 If INDEX_P is non-null, increment *INDEX_P by the number of source-visible
7153 fields up to but not including the desired field, or by the total
7154 number of fields if not found. A NULL value of NAME never
7155 matches; the function just counts visible fields in this case.
7156
7157 Notice that we need to handle when a tagged record hierarchy
7158 has some components with the same name, like in this scenario:
7159
7160 type Top_T is tagged record
7161 N : Integer := 1;
7162 U : Integer := 974;
7163 A : Integer := 48;
7164 end record;
7165
7166 type Middle_T is new Top.Top_T with record
7167 N : Character := 'a';
7168 C : Integer := 3;
7169 end record;
7170
7171 type Bottom_T is new Middle.Middle_T with record
7172 N : Float := 4.0;
7173 C : Character := '5';
7174 X : Integer := 6;
7175 A : Character := 'J';
7176 end record;
7177
7178 Let's say we now have a variable declared and initialized as follow:
7179
7180 TC : Top_A := new Bottom_T;
7181
7182 And then we use this variable to call this function
7183
7184 procedure Assign (Obj: in out Top_T; TV : Integer);
7185
7186 as follow:
7187
7188 Assign (Top_T (B), 12);
7189
7190 Now, we're in the debugger, and we're inside that procedure
7191 then and we want to print the value of obj.c:
7192
7193 Usually, the tagged record or one of the parent type owns the
7194 component to print and there's no issue but in this particular
7195 case, what does it mean to ask for Obj.C? Since the actual
7196 type for object is type Bottom_T, it could mean two things: type
7197 component C from the Middle_T view, but also component C from
7198 Bottom_T. So in that "undefined" case, when the component is
7199 not found in the non-resolved type (which includes all the
7200 components of the parent type), then resolve it and see if we
7201 get better luck once expanded.
7202
7203 In the case of homonyms in the derived tagged type, we don't
7204 guaranty anything, and pick the one that's easiest for us
7205 to program.
7206
7207 Returns 1 if found, 0 otherwise. */
7208
7209 static int
7210 find_struct_field (const char *name, struct type *type, int offset,
7211 struct type **field_type_p,
7212 int *byte_offset_p, int *bit_offset_p, int *bit_size_p,
7213 int *index_p)
7214 {
7215 int i;
7216 int parent_offset = -1;
7217
7218 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
7219
7220 if (field_type_p != NULL)
7221 *field_type_p = NULL;
7222 if (byte_offset_p != NULL)
7223 *byte_offset_p = 0;
7224 if (bit_offset_p != NULL)
7225 *bit_offset_p = 0;
7226 if (bit_size_p != NULL)
7227 *bit_size_p = 0;
7228
7229 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
7230 {
7231 int bit_pos = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i);
7232 int fld_offset = offset + bit_pos / 8;
7233 const char *t_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i);
7234
7235 if (t_field_name == NULL)
7236 continue;
7237
7238 else if (ada_is_parent_field (type, i))
7239 {
7240 /* This is a field pointing us to the parent type of a tagged
7241 type. As hinted in this function's documentation, we give
7242 preference to fields in the current record first, so what
7243 we do here is just record the index of this field before
7244 we skip it. If it turns out we couldn't find our field
7245 in the current record, then we'll get back to it and search
7246 inside it whether the field might exist in the parent. */
7247
7248 parent_offset = i;
7249 continue;
7250 }
7251
7252 else if (name != NULL && field_name_match (t_field_name, name))
7253 {
7254 int bit_size = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, i);
7255
7256 if (field_type_p != NULL)
7257 *field_type_p = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i);
7258 if (byte_offset_p != NULL)
7259 *byte_offset_p = fld_offset;
7260 if (bit_offset_p != NULL)
7261 *bit_offset_p = bit_pos % 8;
7262 if (bit_size_p != NULL)
7263 *bit_size_p = bit_size;
7264 return 1;
7265 }
7266 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
7267 {
7268 if (find_struct_field (name, TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i), fld_offset,
7269 field_type_p, byte_offset_p, bit_offset_p,
7270 bit_size_p, index_p))
7271 return 1;
7272 }
7273 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
7274 {
7275 /* PNH: Wait. Do we ever execute this section, or is ARG always of
7276 fixed type?? */
7277 int j;
7278 struct type *field_type
7279 = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
7280
7281 for (j = 0; j < TYPE_NFIELDS (field_type); j += 1)
7282 {
7283 if (find_struct_field (name, TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type, j),
7284 fld_offset
7285 + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (field_type, j) / 8,
7286 field_type_p, byte_offset_p,
7287 bit_offset_p, bit_size_p, index_p))
7288 return 1;
7289 }
7290 }
7291 else if (index_p != NULL)
7292 *index_p += 1;
7293 }
7294
7295 /* Field not found so far. If this is a tagged type which
7296 has a parent, try finding that field in the parent now. */
7297
7298 if (parent_offset != -1)
7299 {
7300 int bit_pos = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, parent_offset);
7301 int fld_offset = offset + bit_pos / 8;
7302
7303 if (find_struct_field (name, TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, parent_offset),
7304 fld_offset, field_type_p, byte_offset_p,
7305 bit_offset_p, bit_size_p, index_p))
7306 return 1;
7307 }
7308
7309 return 0;
7310 }
7311
7312 /* Number of user-visible fields in record type TYPE. */
7313
7314 static int
7315 num_visible_fields (struct type *type)
7316 {
7317 int n;
7318
7319 n = 0;
7320 find_struct_field (NULL, type, 0, NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, &n);
7321 return n;
7322 }
7323
7324 /* Look for a field NAME in ARG. Adjust the address of ARG by OFFSET bytes,
7325 and search in it assuming it has (class) type TYPE.
7326 If found, return value, else return NULL.
7327
7328 Searches recursively through wrapper fields (e.g., '_parent').
7329
7330 In the case of homonyms in the tagged types, please refer to the
7331 long explanation in find_struct_field's function documentation. */
7332
7333 static struct value *
7334 ada_search_struct_field (const char *name, struct value *arg, int offset,
7335 struct type *type)
7336 {
7337 int i;
7338 int parent_offset = -1;
7339
7340 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
7341 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
7342 {
7343 const char *t_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i);
7344
7345 if (t_field_name == NULL)
7346 continue;
7347
7348 else if (ada_is_parent_field (type, i))
7349 {
7350 /* This is a field pointing us to the parent type of a tagged
7351 type. As hinted in this function's documentation, we give
7352 preference to fields in the current record first, so what
7353 we do here is just record the index of this field before
7354 we skip it. If it turns out we couldn't find our field
7355 in the current record, then we'll get back to it and search
7356 inside it whether the field might exist in the parent. */
7357
7358 parent_offset = i;
7359 continue;
7360 }
7361
7362 else if (field_name_match (t_field_name, name))
7363 return ada_value_primitive_field (arg, offset, i, type);
7364
7365 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
7366 {
7367 struct value *v = /* Do not let indent join lines here. */
7368 ada_search_struct_field (name, arg,
7369 offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8,
7370 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
7371
7372 if (v != NULL)
7373 return v;
7374 }
7375
7376 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
7377 {
7378 /* PNH: Do we ever get here? See find_struct_field. */
7379 int j;
7380 struct type *field_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type,
7381 i));
7382 int var_offset = offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8;
7383
7384 for (j = 0; j < TYPE_NFIELDS (field_type); j += 1)
7385 {
7386 struct value *v = ada_search_struct_field /* Force line
7387 break. */
7388 (name, arg,
7389 var_offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (field_type, j) / 8,
7390 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type, j));
7391
7392 if (v != NULL)
7393 return v;
7394 }
7395 }
7396 }
7397
7398 /* Field not found so far. If this is a tagged type which
7399 has a parent, try finding that field in the parent now. */
7400
7401 if (parent_offset != -1)
7402 {
7403 struct value *v = ada_search_struct_field (
7404 name, arg, offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, parent_offset) / 8,
7405 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, parent_offset));
7406
7407 if (v != NULL)
7408 return v;
7409 }
7410
7411 return NULL;
7412 }
7413
7414 static struct value *ada_index_struct_field_1 (int *, struct value *,
7415 int, struct type *);
7416
7417
7418 /* Return field #INDEX in ARG, where the index is that returned by
7419 * find_struct_field through its INDEX_P argument. Adjust the address
7420 * of ARG by OFFSET bytes, and search in it assuming it has (class) type TYPE.
7421 * If found, return value, else return NULL. */
7422
7423 static struct value *
7424 ada_index_struct_field (int index, struct value *arg, int offset,
7425 struct type *type)
7426 {
7427 return ada_index_struct_field_1 (&index, arg, offset, type);
7428 }
7429
7430
7431 /* Auxiliary function for ada_index_struct_field. Like
7432 * ada_index_struct_field, but takes index from *INDEX_P and modifies
7433 * *INDEX_P. */
7434
7435 static struct value *
7436 ada_index_struct_field_1 (int *index_p, struct value *arg, int offset,
7437 struct type *type)
7438 {
7439 int i;
7440 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
7441
7442 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
7443 {
7444 if (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i) == NULL)
7445 continue;
7446 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
7447 {
7448 struct value *v = /* Do not let indent join lines here. */
7449 ada_index_struct_field_1 (index_p, arg,
7450 offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8,
7451 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
7452
7453 if (v != NULL)
7454 return v;
7455 }
7456
7457 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
7458 {
7459 /* PNH: Do we ever get here? See ada_search_struct_field,
7460 find_struct_field. */
7461 error (_("Cannot assign this kind of variant record"));
7462 }
7463 else if (*index_p == 0)
7464 return ada_value_primitive_field (arg, offset, i, type);
7465 else
7466 *index_p -= 1;
7467 }
7468 return NULL;
7469 }
7470
7471 /* Return a string representation of type TYPE. */
7472
7473 static std::string
7474 type_as_string (struct type *type)
7475 {
7476 string_file tmp_stream;
7477
7478 type_print (type, "", &tmp_stream, -1);
7479
7480 return std::move (tmp_stream.string ());
7481 }
7482
7483 /* Given a type TYPE, look up the type of the component of type named NAME.
7484 If DISPP is non-null, add its byte displacement from the beginning of a
7485 structure (pointed to by a value) of type TYPE to *DISPP (does not
7486 work for packed fields).
7487
7488 Matches any field whose name has NAME as a prefix, possibly
7489 followed by "___".
7490
7491 TYPE can be either a struct or union. If REFOK, TYPE may also
7492 be a (pointer or reference)+ to a struct or union, and the
7493 ultimate target type will be searched.
7494
7495 Looks recursively into variant clauses and parent types.
7496
7497 In the case of homonyms in the tagged types, please refer to the
7498 long explanation in find_struct_field's function documentation.
7499
7500 If NOERR is nonzero, return NULL if NAME is not suitably defined or
7501 TYPE is not a type of the right kind. */
7502
7503 static struct type *
7504 ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (struct type *type, const char *name, int refok,
7505 int noerr)
7506 {
7507 int i;
7508 int parent_offset = -1;
7509
7510 if (name == NULL)
7511 goto BadName;
7512
7513 if (refok && type != NULL)
7514 while (1)
7515 {
7516 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
7517 if (type->code () != TYPE_CODE_PTR && type->code () != TYPE_CODE_REF)
7518 break;
7519 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
7520 }
7521
7522 if (type == NULL
7523 || (type->code () != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
7524 && type->code () != TYPE_CODE_UNION))
7525 {
7526 if (noerr)
7527 return NULL;
7528
7529 error (_("Type %s is not a structure or union type"),
7530 type != NULL ? type_as_string (type).c_str () : _("(null)"));
7531 }
7532
7533 type = to_static_fixed_type (type);
7534
7535 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
7536 {
7537 const char *t_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i);
7538 struct type *t;
7539
7540 if (t_field_name == NULL)
7541 continue;
7542
7543 else if (ada_is_parent_field (type, i))
7544 {
7545 /* This is a field pointing us to the parent type of a tagged
7546 type. As hinted in this function's documentation, we give
7547 preference to fields in the current record first, so what
7548 we do here is just record the index of this field before
7549 we skip it. If it turns out we couldn't find our field
7550 in the current record, then we'll get back to it and search
7551 inside it whether the field might exist in the parent. */
7552
7553 parent_offset = i;
7554 continue;
7555 }
7556
7557 else if (field_name_match (t_field_name, name))
7558 return TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i);
7559
7560 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
7561 {
7562 t = ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i), name,
7563 0, 1);
7564 if (t != NULL)
7565 return t;
7566 }
7567
7568 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
7569 {
7570 int j;
7571 struct type *field_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type,
7572 i));
7573
7574 for (j = TYPE_NFIELDS (field_type) - 1; j >= 0; j -= 1)
7575 {
7576 /* FIXME pnh 2008/01/26: We check for a field that is
7577 NOT wrapped in a struct, since the compiler sometimes
7578 generates these for unchecked variant types. Revisit
7579 if the compiler changes this practice. */
7580 const char *v_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (field_type, j);
7581
7582 if (v_field_name != NULL
7583 && field_name_match (v_field_name, name))
7584 t = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type, j);
7585 else
7586 t = ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type,
7587 j),
7588 name, 0, 1);
7589
7590 if (t != NULL)
7591 return t;
7592 }
7593 }
7594
7595 }
7596
7597 /* Field not found so far. If this is a tagged type which
7598 has a parent, try finding that field in the parent now. */
7599
7600 if (parent_offset != -1)
7601 {
7602 struct type *t;
7603
7604 t = ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, parent_offset),
7605 name, 0, 1);
7606 if (t != NULL)
7607 return t;
7608 }
7609
7610 BadName:
7611 if (!noerr)
7612 {
7613 const char *name_str = name != NULL ? name : _("<null>");
7614
7615 error (_("Type %s has no component named %s"),
7616 type_as_string (type).c_str (), name_str);
7617 }
7618
7619 return NULL;
7620 }
7621
7622 /* Assuming that VAR_TYPE is the type of a variant part of a record (a union),
7623 within a value of type OUTER_TYPE, return true iff VAR_TYPE
7624 represents an unchecked union (that is, the variant part of a
7625 record that is named in an Unchecked_Union pragma). */
7626
7627 static int
7628 is_unchecked_variant (struct type *var_type, struct type *outer_type)
7629 {
7630 const char *discrim_name = ada_variant_discrim_name (var_type);
7631
7632 return (ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (outer_type, discrim_name, 0, 1) == NULL);
7633 }
7634
7635
7636 /* Assuming that VAR_TYPE is the type of a variant part of a record (a union),
7637 within OUTER, determine which variant clause (field number in VAR_TYPE,
7638 numbering from 0) is applicable. Returns -1 if none are. */
7639
7640 int
7641 ada_which_variant_applies (struct type *var_type, struct value *outer)
7642 {
7643 int others_clause;
7644 int i;
7645 const char *discrim_name = ada_variant_discrim_name (var_type);
7646 struct value *discrim;
7647 LONGEST discrim_val;
7648
7649 /* Using plain value_from_contents_and_address here causes problems
7650 because we will end up trying to resolve a type that is currently
7651 being constructed. */
7652 discrim = ada_value_struct_elt (outer, discrim_name, 1);
7653 if (discrim == NULL)
7654 return -1;
7655 discrim_val = value_as_long (discrim);
7656
7657 others_clause = -1;
7658 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (var_type); i += 1)
7659 {
7660 if (ada_is_others_clause (var_type, i))
7661 others_clause = i;
7662 else if (ada_in_variant (discrim_val, var_type, i))
7663 return i;
7664 }
7665
7666 return others_clause;
7667 }
7668 \f
7669
7670
7671 /* Dynamic-Sized Records */
7672
7673 /* Strategy: The type ostensibly attached to a value with dynamic size
7674 (i.e., a size that is not statically recorded in the debugging
7675 data) does not accurately reflect the size or layout of the value.
7676 Our strategy is to convert these values to values with accurate,
7677 conventional types that are constructed on the fly. */
7678
7679 /* There is a subtle and tricky problem here. In general, we cannot
7680 determine the size of dynamic records without its data. However,
7681 the 'struct value' data structure, which GDB uses to represent
7682 quantities in the inferior process (the target), requires the size
7683 of the type at the time of its allocation in order to reserve space
7684 for GDB's internal copy of the data. That's why the
7685 'to_fixed_xxx_type' routines take (target) addresses as parameters,
7686 rather than struct value*s.
7687
7688 However, GDB's internal history variables ($1, $2, etc.) are
7689 struct value*s containing internal copies of the data that are not, in
7690 general, the same as the data at their corresponding addresses in
7691 the target. Fortunately, the types we give to these values are all
7692 conventional, fixed-size types (as per the strategy described
7693 above), so that we don't usually have to perform the
7694 'to_fixed_xxx_type' conversions to look at their values.
7695 Unfortunately, there is one exception: if one of the internal
7696 history variables is an array whose elements are unconstrained
7697 records, then we will need to create distinct fixed types for each
7698 element selected. */
7699
7700 /* The upshot of all of this is that many routines take a (type, host
7701 address, target address) triple as arguments to represent a value.
7702 The host address, if non-null, is supposed to contain an internal
7703 copy of the relevant data; otherwise, the program is to consult the
7704 target at the target address. */
7705
7706 /* Assuming that VAL0 represents a pointer value, the result of
7707 dereferencing it. Differs from value_ind in its treatment of
7708 dynamic-sized types. */
7709
7710 struct value *
7711 ada_value_ind (struct value *val0)
7712 {
7713 struct value *val = value_ind (val0);
7714
7715 if (ada_is_tagged_type (value_type (val), 0))
7716 val = ada_tag_value_at_base_address (val);
7717
7718 return ada_to_fixed_value (val);
7719 }
7720
7721 /* The value resulting from dereferencing any "reference to"
7722 qualifiers on VAL0. */
7723
7724 static struct value *
7725 ada_coerce_ref (struct value *val0)
7726 {
7727 if (value_type (val0)->code () == TYPE_CODE_REF)
7728 {
7729 struct value *val = val0;
7730
7731 val = coerce_ref (val);
7732
7733 if (ada_is_tagged_type (value_type (val), 0))
7734 val = ada_tag_value_at_base_address (val);
7735
7736 return ada_to_fixed_value (val);
7737 }
7738 else
7739 return val0;
7740 }
7741
7742 /* Return the bit alignment required for field #F of template type TYPE. */
7743
7744 static unsigned int
7745 field_alignment (struct type *type, int f)
7746 {
7747 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f);
7748 int len;
7749 int align_offset;
7750
7751 /* The field name should never be null, unless the debugging information
7752 is somehow malformed. In this case, we assume the field does not
7753 require any alignment. */
7754 if (name == NULL)
7755 return 1;
7756
7757 len = strlen (name);
7758
7759 if (!isdigit (name[len - 1]))
7760 return 1;
7761
7762 if (isdigit (name[len - 2]))
7763 align_offset = len - 2;
7764 else
7765 align_offset = len - 1;
7766
7767 if (align_offset < 7 || !startswith (name + align_offset - 6, "___XV"))
7768 return TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
7769
7770 return atoi (name + align_offset) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
7771 }
7772
7773 /* Find a typedef or tag symbol named NAME. Ignores ambiguity. */
7774
7775 static struct symbol *
7776 ada_find_any_type_symbol (const char *name)
7777 {
7778 struct symbol *sym;
7779
7780 sym = standard_lookup (name, get_selected_block (NULL), VAR_DOMAIN);
7781 if (sym != NULL && SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_TYPEDEF)
7782 return sym;
7783
7784 sym = standard_lookup (name, NULL, STRUCT_DOMAIN);
7785 return sym;
7786 }
7787
7788 /* Find a type named NAME. Ignores ambiguity. This routine will look
7789 solely for types defined by debug info, it will not search the GDB
7790 primitive types. */
7791
7792 static struct type *
7793 ada_find_any_type (const char *name)
7794 {
7795 struct symbol *sym = ada_find_any_type_symbol (name);
7796
7797 if (sym != NULL)
7798 return SYMBOL_TYPE (sym);
7799
7800 return NULL;
7801 }
7802
7803 /* Given NAME_SYM and an associated BLOCK, find a "renaming" symbol
7804 associated with NAME_SYM's name. NAME_SYM may itself be a renaming
7805 symbol, in which case it is returned. Otherwise, this looks for
7806 symbols whose name is that of NAME_SYM suffixed with "___XR".
7807 Return symbol if found, and NULL otherwise. */
7808
7809 static bool
7810 ada_is_renaming_symbol (struct symbol *name_sym)
7811 {
7812 const char *name = name_sym->linkage_name ();
7813 return strstr (name, "___XR") != NULL;
7814 }
7815
7816 /* Because of GNAT encoding conventions, several GDB symbols may match a
7817 given type name. If the type denoted by TYPE0 is to be preferred to
7818 that of TYPE1 for purposes of type printing, return non-zero;
7819 otherwise return 0. */
7820
7821 int
7822 ada_prefer_type (struct type *type0, struct type *type1)
7823 {
7824 if (type1 == NULL)
7825 return 1;
7826 else if (type0 == NULL)
7827 return 0;
7828 else if (type1->code () == TYPE_CODE_VOID)
7829 return 1;
7830 else if (type0->code () == TYPE_CODE_VOID)
7831 return 0;
7832 else if (type1->name () == NULL && type0->name () != NULL)
7833 return 1;
7834 else if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type0))
7835 return 1;
7836 else if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type0)
7837 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type1))
7838 return 1;
7839 else
7840 {
7841 const char *type0_name = type0->name ();
7842 const char *type1_name = type1->name ();
7843
7844 if (type0_name != NULL && strstr (type0_name, "___XR") != NULL
7845 && (type1_name == NULL || strstr (type1_name, "___XR") == NULL))
7846 return 1;
7847 }
7848 return 0;
7849 }
7850
7851 /* The name of TYPE, which is its TYPE_NAME. Null if TYPE is
7852 null. */
7853
7854 const char *
7855 ada_type_name (struct type *type)
7856 {
7857 if (type == NULL)
7858 return NULL;
7859 return type->name ();
7860 }
7861
7862 /* Search the list of "descriptive" types associated to TYPE for a type
7863 whose name is NAME. */
7864
7865 static struct type *
7866 find_parallel_type_by_descriptive_type (struct type *type, const char *name)
7867 {
7868 struct type *result, *tmp;
7869
7870 if (ada_ignore_descriptive_types_p)
7871 return NULL;
7872
7873 /* If there no descriptive-type info, then there is no parallel type
7874 to be found. */
7875 if (!HAVE_GNAT_AUX_INFO (type))
7876 return NULL;
7877
7878 result = TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE_TYPE (type);
7879 while (result != NULL)
7880 {
7881 const char *result_name = ada_type_name (result);
7882
7883 if (result_name == NULL)
7884 {
7885 warning (_("unexpected null name on descriptive type"));
7886 return NULL;
7887 }
7888
7889 /* If the names match, stop. */
7890 if (strcmp (result_name, name) == 0)
7891 break;
7892
7893 /* Otherwise, look at the next item on the list, if any. */
7894 if (HAVE_GNAT_AUX_INFO (result))
7895 tmp = TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE_TYPE (result);
7896 else
7897 tmp = NULL;
7898
7899 /* If not found either, try after having resolved the typedef. */
7900 if (tmp != NULL)
7901 result = tmp;
7902 else
7903 {
7904 result = check_typedef (result);
7905 if (HAVE_GNAT_AUX_INFO (result))
7906 result = TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE_TYPE (result);
7907 else
7908 result = NULL;
7909 }
7910 }
7911
7912 /* If we didn't find a match, see whether this is a packed array. With
7913 older compilers, the descriptive type information is either absent or
7914 irrelevant when it comes to packed arrays so the above lookup fails.
7915 Fall back to using a parallel lookup by name in this case. */
7916 if (result == NULL && ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type))
7917 return ada_find_any_type (name);
7918
7919 return result;
7920 }
7921
7922 /* Find a parallel type to TYPE with the specified NAME, using the
7923 descriptive type taken from the debugging information, if available,
7924 and otherwise using the (slower) name-based method. */
7925
7926 static struct type *
7927 ada_find_parallel_type_with_name (struct type *type, const char *name)
7928 {
7929 struct type *result = NULL;
7930
7931 if (HAVE_GNAT_AUX_INFO (type))
7932 result = find_parallel_type_by_descriptive_type (type, name);
7933 else
7934 result = ada_find_any_type (name);
7935
7936 return result;
7937 }
7938
7939 /* Same as above, but specify the name of the parallel type by appending
7940 SUFFIX to the name of TYPE. */
7941
7942 struct type *
7943 ada_find_parallel_type (struct type *type, const char *suffix)
7944 {
7945 char *name;
7946 const char *type_name = ada_type_name (type);
7947 int len;
7948
7949 if (type_name == NULL)
7950 return NULL;
7951
7952 len = strlen (type_name);
7953
7954 name = (char *) alloca (len + strlen (suffix) + 1);
7955
7956 strcpy (name, type_name);
7957 strcpy (name + len, suffix);
7958
7959 return ada_find_parallel_type_with_name (type, name);
7960 }
7961
7962 /* If TYPE is a variable-size record type, return the corresponding template
7963 type describing its fields. Otherwise, return NULL. */
7964
7965 static struct type *
7966 dynamic_template_type (struct type *type)
7967 {
7968 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
7969
7970 if (type == NULL || type->code () != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
7971 || ada_type_name (type) == NULL)
7972 return NULL;
7973 else
7974 {
7975 int len = strlen (ada_type_name (type));
7976
7977 if (len > 6 && strcmp (ada_type_name (type) + len - 6, "___XVE") == 0)
7978 return type;
7979 else
7980 return ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XVE");
7981 }
7982 }
7983
7984 /* Assuming that TEMPL_TYPE is a union or struct type, returns
7985 non-zero iff field FIELD_NUM of TEMPL_TYPE has dynamic size. */
7986
7987 static int
7988 is_dynamic_field (struct type *templ_type, int field_num)
7989 {
7990 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (templ_type, field_num);
7991
7992 return name != NULL
7993 && TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (templ_type, field_num)->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR
7994 && strstr (name, "___XVL") != NULL;
7995 }
7996
7997 /* The index of the variant field of TYPE, or -1 if TYPE does not
7998 represent a variant record type. */
7999
8000 static int
8001 variant_field_index (struct type *type)
8002 {
8003 int f;
8004
8005 if (type == NULL || type->code () != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
8006 return -1;
8007
8008 for (f = 0; f < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); f += 1)
8009 {
8010 if (ada_is_variant_part (type, f))
8011 return f;
8012 }
8013 return -1;
8014 }
8015
8016 /* A record type with no fields. */
8017
8018 static struct type *
8019 empty_record (struct type *templ)
8020 {
8021 struct type *type = alloc_type_copy (templ);
8022
8023 type->set_code (TYPE_CODE_STRUCT);
8024 TYPE_FIELDS (type) = NULL;
8025 INIT_NONE_SPECIFIC (type);
8026 type->set_name ("<empty>");
8027 TYPE_LENGTH (type) = 0;
8028 return type;
8029 }
8030
8031 /* An ordinary record type (with fixed-length fields) that describes
8032 the value of type TYPE at VALADDR or ADDRESS (see comments at
8033 the beginning of this section) VAL according to GNAT conventions.
8034 DVAL0 should describe the (portion of a) record that contains any
8035 necessary discriminants. It should be NULL if value_type (VAL) is
8036 an outer-level type (i.e., as opposed to a branch of a variant.) A
8037 variant field (unless unchecked) is replaced by a particular branch
8038 of the variant.
8039
8040 If not KEEP_DYNAMIC_FIELDS, then all fields whose position or
8041 length are not statically known are discarded. As a consequence,
8042 VALADDR, ADDRESS and DVAL0 are ignored.
8043
8044 NOTE: Limitations: For now, we assume that dynamic fields and
8045 variants occupy whole numbers of bytes. However, they need not be
8046 byte-aligned. */
8047
8048 struct type *
8049 ada_template_to_fixed_record_type_1 (struct type *type,
8050 const gdb_byte *valaddr,
8051 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval0,
8052 int keep_dynamic_fields)
8053 {
8054 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
8055 struct value *dval;
8056 struct type *rtype;
8057 int nfields, bit_len;
8058 int variant_field;
8059 long off;
8060 int fld_bit_len;
8061 int f;
8062
8063 /* Compute the number of fields in this record type that are going
8064 to be processed: unless keep_dynamic_fields, this includes only
8065 fields whose position and length are static will be processed. */
8066 if (keep_dynamic_fields)
8067 nfields = TYPE_NFIELDS (type);
8068 else
8069 {
8070 nfields = 0;
8071 while (nfields < TYPE_NFIELDS (type)
8072 && !ada_is_variant_part (type, nfields)
8073 && !is_dynamic_field (type, nfields))
8074 nfields++;
8075 }
8076
8077 rtype = alloc_type_copy (type);
8078 rtype->set_code (TYPE_CODE_STRUCT);
8079 INIT_NONE_SPECIFIC (rtype);
8080 rtype->set_num_fields (nfields);
8081 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype) = (struct field *)
8082 TYPE_ALLOC (rtype, nfields * sizeof (struct field));
8083 memset (TYPE_FIELDS (rtype), 0, sizeof (struct field) * nfields);
8084 rtype->set_name (ada_type_name (type));
8085 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (rtype) = 1;
8086
8087 off = 0;
8088 bit_len = 0;
8089 variant_field = -1;
8090
8091 for (f = 0; f < nfields; f += 1)
8092 {
8093 off = align_up (off, field_alignment (type, f))
8094 + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, f);
8095 SET_FIELD_BITPOS (TYPE_FIELD (rtype, f), off);
8096 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (rtype, f) = 0;
8097
8098 if (ada_is_variant_part (type, f))
8099 {
8100 variant_field = f;
8101 fld_bit_len = 0;
8102 }
8103 else if (is_dynamic_field (type, f))
8104 {
8105 const gdb_byte *field_valaddr = valaddr;
8106 CORE_ADDR field_address = address;
8107 struct type *field_type =
8108 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f));
8109
8110 if (dval0 == NULL)
8111 {
8112 /* rtype's length is computed based on the run-time
8113 value of discriminants. If the discriminants are not
8114 initialized, the type size may be completely bogus and
8115 GDB may fail to allocate a value for it. So check the
8116 size first before creating the value. */
8117 ada_ensure_varsize_limit (rtype);
8118 /* Using plain value_from_contents_and_address here
8119 causes problems because we will end up trying to
8120 resolve a type that is currently being
8121 constructed. */
8122 dval = value_from_contents_and_address_unresolved (rtype,
8123 valaddr,
8124 address);
8125 rtype = value_type (dval);
8126 }
8127 else
8128 dval = dval0;
8129
8130 /* If the type referenced by this field is an aligner type, we need
8131 to unwrap that aligner type, because its size might not be set.
8132 Keeping the aligner type would cause us to compute the wrong
8133 size for this field, impacting the offset of the all the fields
8134 that follow this one. */
8135 if (ada_is_aligner_type (field_type))
8136 {
8137 long field_offset = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (field_type, f);
8138
8139 field_valaddr = cond_offset_host (field_valaddr, field_offset);
8140 field_address = cond_offset_target (field_address, field_offset);
8141 field_type = ada_aligned_type (field_type);
8142 }
8143
8144 field_valaddr = cond_offset_host (field_valaddr,
8145 off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT);
8146 field_address = cond_offset_target (field_address,
8147 off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT);
8148
8149 /* Get the fixed type of the field. Note that, in this case,
8150 we do not want to get the real type out of the tag: if
8151 the current field is the parent part of a tagged record,
8152 we will get the tag of the object. Clearly wrong: the real
8153 type of the parent is not the real type of the child. We
8154 would end up in an infinite loop. */
8155 field_type = ada_get_base_type (field_type);
8156 field_type = ada_to_fixed_type (field_type, field_valaddr,
8157 field_address, dval, 0);
8158 /* If the field size is already larger than the maximum
8159 object size, then the record itself will necessarily
8160 be larger than the maximum object size. We need to make
8161 this check now, because the size might be so ridiculously
8162 large (due to an uninitialized variable in the inferior)
8163 that it would cause an overflow when adding it to the
8164 record size. */
8165 ada_ensure_varsize_limit (field_type);
8166
8167 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, f) = field_type;
8168 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f);
8169 /* The multiplication can potentially overflow. But because
8170 the field length has been size-checked just above, and
8171 assuming that the maximum size is a reasonable value,
8172 an overflow should not happen in practice. So rather than
8173 adding overflow recovery code to this already complex code,
8174 we just assume that it's not going to happen. */
8175 fld_bit_len =
8176 TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, f)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
8177 }
8178 else
8179 {
8180 /* Note: If this field's type is a typedef, it is important
8181 to preserve the typedef layer.
8182
8183 Otherwise, we might be transforming a typedef to a fat
8184 pointer (encoding a pointer to an unconstrained array),
8185 into a basic fat pointer (encoding an unconstrained
8186 array). As both types are implemented using the same
8187 structure, the typedef is the only clue which allows us
8188 to distinguish between the two options. Stripping it
8189 would prevent us from printing this field appropriately. */
8190 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f);
8191 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f);
8192 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, f) > 0)
8193 fld_bit_len =
8194 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, f);
8195 else
8196 {
8197 struct type *field_type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f);
8198
8199 /* We need to be careful of typedefs when computing
8200 the length of our field. If this is a typedef,
8201 get the length of the target type, not the length
8202 of the typedef. */
8203 if (field_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
8204 field_type = ada_typedef_target_type (field_type);
8205
8206 fld_bit_len =
8207 TYPE_LENGTH (ada_check_typedef (field_type)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
8208 }
8209 }
8210 if (off + fld_bit_len > bit_len)
8211 bit_len = off + fld_bit_len;
8212 off += fld_bit_len;
8213 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) =
8214 align_up (bit_len, TARGET_CHAR_BIT) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
8215 }
8216
8217 /* We handle the variant part, if any, at the end because of certain
8218 odd cases in which it is re-ordered so as NOT to be the last field of
8219 the record. This can happen in the presence of representation
8220 clauses. */
8221 if (variant_field >= 0)
8222 {
8223 struct type *branch_type;
8224
8225 off = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (rtype, variant_field);
8226
8227 if (dval0 == NULL)
8228 {
8229 /* Using plain value_from_contents_and_address here causes
8230 problems because we will end up trying to resolve a type
8231 that is currently being constructed. */
8232 dval = value_from_contents_and_address_unresolved (rtype, valaddr,
8233 address);
8234 rtype = value_type (dval);
8235 }
8236 else
8237 dval = dval0;
8238
8239 branch_type =
8240 to_fixed_variant_branch_type
8241 (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, variant_field),
8242 cond_offset_host (valaddr, off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT),
8243 cond_offset_target (address, off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT), dval);
8244 if (branch_type == NULL)
8245 {
8246 for (f = variant_field + 1; f < TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype); f += 1)
8247 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f - 1] = TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f];
8248 rtype->set_num_fields (rtype->num_fields () - 1);
8249 }
8250 else
8251 {
8252 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, variant_field) = branch_type;
8253 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, variant_field) = "S";
8254 fld_bit_len =
8255 TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, variant_field)) *
8256 TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
8257 if (off + fld_bit_len > bit_len)
8258 bit_len = off + fld_bit_len;
8259 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) =
8260 align_up (bit_len, TARGET_CHAR_BIT) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
8261 }
8262 }
8263
8264 /* According to exp_dbug.ads, the size of TYPE for variable-size records
8265 should contain the alignment of that record, which should be a strictly
8266 positive value. If null or negative, then something is wrong, most
8267 probably in the debug info. In that case, we don't round up the size
8268 of the resulting type. If this record is not part of another structure,
8269 the current RTYPE length might be good enough for our purposes. */
8270 if (TYPE_LENGTH (type) <= 0)
8271 {
8272 if (rtype->name ())
8273 warning (_("Invalid type size for `%s' detected: %s."),
8274 rtype->name (), pulongest (TYPE_LENGTH (type)));
8275 else
8276 warning (_("Invalid type size for <unnamed> detected: %s."),
8277 pulongest (TYPE_LENGTH (type)));
8278 }
8279 else
8280 {
8281 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) = align_up (TYPE_LENGTH (rtype),
8282 TYPE_LENGTH (type));
8283 }
8284
8285 value_free_to_mark (mark);
8286 if (TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) > varsize_limit)
8287 error (_("record type with dynamic size is larger than varsize-limit"));
8288 return rtype;
8289 }
8290
8291 /* As for ada_template_to_fixed_record_type_1 with KEEP_DYNAMIC_FIELDS
8292 of 1. */
8293
8294 static struct type *
8295 template_to_fixed_record_type (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
8296 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval0)
8297 {
8298 return ada_template_to_fixed_record_type_1 (type, valaddr,
8299 address, dval0, 1);
8300 }
8301
8302 /* An ordinary record type in which ___XVL-convention fields and
8303 ___XVU- and ___XVN-convention field types in TYPE0 are replaced with
8304 static approximations, containing all possible fields. Uses
8305 no runtime values. Useless for use in values, but that's OK,
8306 since the results are used only for type determinations. Works on both
8307 structs and unions. Representation note: to save space, we memorize
8308 the result of this function in the TYPE_TARGET_TYPE of the
8309 template type. */
8310
8311 static struct type *
8312 template_to_static_fixed_type (struct type *type0)
8313 {
8314 struct type *type;
8315 int nfields;
8316 int f;
8317
8318 /* No need no do anything if the input type is already fixed. */
8319 if (TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0))
8320 return type0;
8321
8322 /* Likewise if we already have computed the static approximation. */
8323 if (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0) != NULL)
8324 return TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0);
8325
8326 /* Don't clone TYPE0 until we are sure we are going to need a copy. */
8327 type = type0;
8328 nfields = TYPE_NFIELDS (type0);
8329
8330 /* Whether or not we cloned TYPE0, cache the result so that we don't do
8331 recompute all over next time. */
8332 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0) = type;
8333
8334 for (f = 0; f < nfields; f += 1)
8335 {
8336 struct type *field_type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type0, f);
8337 struct type *new_type;
8338
8339 if (is_dynamic_field (type0, f))
8340 {
8341 field_type = ada_check_typedef (field_type);
8342 new_type = to_static_fixed_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (field_type));
8343 }
8344 else
8345 new_type = static_unwrap_type (field_type);
8346
8347 if (new_type != field_type)
8348 {
8349 /* Clone TYPE0 only the first time we get a new field type. */
8350 if (type == type0)
8351 {
8352 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0) = type = alloc_type_copy (type0);
8353 type->set_code (type0->code ());
8354 INIT_NONE_SPECIFIC (type);
8355 type->set_num_fields (nfields);
8356 TYPE_FIELDS (type) = (struct field *)
8357 TYPE_ALLOC (type, nfields * sizeof (struct field));
8358 memcpy (TYPE_FIELDS (type), TYPE_FIELDS (type0),
8359 sizeof (struct field) * nfields);
8360 type->set_name (ada_type_name (type0));
8361 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type) = 1;
8362 TYPE_LENGTH (type) = 0;
8363 }
8364 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f) = new_type;
8365 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f) = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type0, f);
8366 }
8367 }
8368
8369 return type;
8370 }
8371
8372 /* Given an object of type TYPE whose contents are at VALADDR and
8373 whose address in memory is ADDRESS, returns a revision of TYPE,
8374 which should be a non-dynamic-sized record, in which the variant
8375 part, if any, is replaced with the appropriate branch. Looks
8376 for discriminant values in DVAL0, which can be NULL if the record
8377 contains the necessary discriminant values. */
8378
8379 static struct type *
8380 to_record_with_fixed_variant_part (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
8381 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval0)
8382 {
8383 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
8384 struct value *dval;
8385 struct type *rtype;
8386 struct type *branch_type;
8387 int nfields = TYPE_NFIELDS (type);
8388 int variant_field = variant_field_index (type);
8389
8390 if (variant_field == -1)
8391 return type;
8392
8393 if (dval0 == NULL)
8394 {
8395 dval = value_from_contents_and_address (type, valaddr, address);
8396 type = value_type (dval);
8397 }
8398 else
8399 dval = dval0;
8400
8401 rtype = alloc_type_copy (type);
8402 rtype->set_code (TYPE_CODE_STRUCT);
8403 INIT_NONE_SPECIFIC (rtype);
8404 rtype->set_num_fields (nfields);
8405 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype) =
8406 (struct field *) TYPE_ALLOC (rtype, nfields * sizeof (struct field));
8407 memcpy (TYPE_FIELDS (rtype), TYPE_FIELDS (type),
8408 sizeof (struct field) * nfields);
8409 rtype->set_name (ada_type_name (type));
8410 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (rtype) = 1;
8411 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) = TYPE_LENGTH (type);
8412
8413 branch_type = to_fixed_variant_branch_type
8414 (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, variant_field),
8415 cond_offset_host (valaddr,
8416 TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, variant_field)
8417 / TARGET_CHAR_BIT),
8418 cond_offset_target (address,
8419 TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, variant_field)
8420 / TARGET_CHAR_BIT), dval);
8421 if (branch_type == NULL)
8422 {
8423 int f;
8424
8425 for (f = variant_field + 1; f < nfields; f += 1)
8426 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f - 1] = TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f];
8427 rtype->set_num_fields (rtype->num_fields () - 1);
8428 }
8429 else
8430 {
8431 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, variant_field) = branch_type;
8432 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, variant_field) = "S";
8433 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (rtype, variant_field) = 0;
8434 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) += TYPE_LENGTH (branch_type);
8435 }
8436 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) -= TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, variant_field));
8437
8438 value_free_to_mark (mark);
8439 return rtype;
8440 }
8441
8442 /* An ordinary record type (with fixed-length fields) that describes
8443 the value at (TYPE0, VALADDR, ADDRESS) [see explanation at
8444 beginning of this section]. Any necessary discriminants' values
8445 should be in DVAL, a record value; it may be NULL if the object
8446 at ADDR itself contains any necessary discriminant values.
8447 Additionally, VALADDR and ADDRESS may also be NULL if no discriminant
8448 values from the record are needed. Except in the case that DVAL,
8449 VALADDR, and ADDRESS are all 0 or NULL, a variant field (unless
8450 unchecked) is replaced by a particular branch of the variant.
8451
8452 NOTE: the case in which DVAL and VALADDR are NULL and ADDRESS is 0
8453 is questionable and may be removed. It can arise during the
8454 processing of an unconstrained-array-of-record type where all the
8455 variant branches have exactly the same size. This is because in
8456 such cases, the compiler does not bother to use the XVS convention
8457 when encoding the record. I am currently dubious of this
8458 shortcut and suspect the compiler should be altered. FIXME. */
8459
8460 static struct type *
8461 to_fixed_record_type (struct type *type0, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
8462 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval)
8463 {
8464 struct type *templ_type;
8465
8466 if (TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0))
8467 return type0;
8468
8469 templ_type = dynamic_template_type (type0);
8470
8471 if (templ_type != NULL)
8472 return template_to_fixed_record_type (templ_type, valaddr, address, dval);
8473 else if (variant_field_index (type0) >= 0)
8474 {
8475 if (dval == NULL && valaddr == NULL && address == 0)
8476 return type0;
8477 return to_record_with_fixed_variant_part (type0, valaddr, address,
8478 dval);
8479 }
8480 else
8481 {
8482 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0) = 1;
8483 return type0;
8484 }
8485
8486 }
8487
8488 /* An ordinary record type (with fixed-length fields) that describes
8489 the value at (VAR_TYPE0, VALADDR, ADDRESS), where VAR_TYPE0 is a
8490 union type. Any necessary discriminants' values should be in DVAL,
8491 a record value. That is, this routine selects the appropriate
8492 branch of the union at ADDR according to the discriminant value
8493 indicated in the union's type name. Returns VAR_TYPE0 itself if
8494 it represents a variant subject to a pragma Unchecked_Union. */
8495
8496 static struct type *
8497 to_fixed_variant_branch_type (struct type *var_type0, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
8498 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval)
8499 {
8500 int which;
8501 struct type *templ_type;
8502 struct type *var_type;
8503
8504 if (var_type0->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
8505 var_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (var_type0);
8506 else
8507 var_type = var_type0;
8508
8509 templ_type = ada_find_parallel_type (var_type, "___XVU");
8510
8511 if (templ_type != NULL)
8512 var_type = templ_type;
8513
8514 if (is_unchecked_variant (var_type, value_type (dval)))
8515 return var_type0;
8516 which = ada_which_variant_applies (var_type, dval);
8517
8518 if (which < 0)
8519 return empty_record (var_type);
8520 else if (is_dynamic_field (var_type, which))
8521 return to_fixed_record_type
8522 (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which)),
8523 valaddr, address, dval);
8524 else if (variant_field_index (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which)) >= 0)
8525 return
8526 to_fixed_record_type
8527 (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which), valaddr, address, dval);
8528 else
8529 return TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which);
8530 }
8531
8532 /* Assuming RANGE_TYPE is a TYPE_CODE_RANGE, return nonzero if
8533 ENCODING_TYPE, a type following the GNAT conventions for discrete
8534 type encodings, only carries redundant information. */
8535
8536 static int
8537 ada_is_redundant_range_encoding (struct type *range_type,
8538 struct type *encoding_type)
8539 {
8540 const char *bounds_str;
8541 int n;
8542 LONGEST lo, hi;
8543
8544 gdb_assert (range_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_RANGE);
8545
8546 if (get_base_type (range_type)->code ()
8547 != get_base_type (encoding_type)->code ())
8548 {
8549 /* The compiler probably used a simple base type to describe
8550 the range type instead of the range's actual base type,
8551 expecting us to get the real base type from the encoding
8552 anyway. In this situation, the encoding cannot be ignored
8553 as redundant. */
8554 return 0;
8555 }
8556
8557 if (is_dynamic_type (range_type))
8558 return 0;
8559
8560 if (encoding_type->name () == NULL)
8561 return 0;
8562
8563 bounds_str = strstr (encoding_type->name (), "___XDLU_");
8564 if (bounds_str == NULL)
8565 return 0;
8566
8567 n = 8; /* Skip "___XDLU_". */
8568 if (!ada_scan_number (bounds_str, n, &lo, &n))
8569 return 0;
8570 if (TYPE_LOW_BOUND (range_type) != lo)
8571 return 0;
8572
8573 n += 2; /* Skip the "__" separator between the two bounds. */
8574 if (!ada_scan_number (bounds_str, n, &hi, &n))
8575 return 0;
8576 if (TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (range_type) != hi)
8577 return 0;
8578
8579 return 1;
8580 }
8581
8582 /* Given the array type ARRAY_TYPE, return nonzero if DESC_TYPE,
8583 a type following the GNAT encoding for describing array type
8584 indices, only carries redundant information. */
8585
8586 static int
8587 ada_is_redundant_index_type_desc (struct type *array_type,
8588 struct type *desc_type)
8589 {
8590 struct type *this_layer = check_typedef (array_type);
8591 int i;
8592
8593 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (desc_type); i++)
8594 {
8595 if (!ada_is_redundant_range_encoding (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (this_layer),
8596 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (desc_type, i)))
8597 return 0;
8598 this_layer = check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (this_layer));
8599 }
8600
8601 return 1;
8602 }
8603
8604 /* Assuming that TYPE0 is an array type describing the type of a value
8605 at ADDR, and that DVAL describes a record containing any
8606 discriminants used in TYPE0, returns a type for the value that
8607 contains no dynamic components (that is, no components whose sizes
8608 are determined by run-time quantities). Unless IGNORE_TOO_BIG is
8609 true, gives an error message if the resulting type's size is over
8610 varsize_limit. */
8611
8612 static struct type *
8613 to_fixed_array_type (struct type *type0, struct value *dval,
8614 int ignore_too_big)
8615 {
8616 struct type *index_type_desc;
8617 struct type *result;
8618 int constrained_packed_array_p;
8619 static const char *xa_suffix = "___XA";
8620
8621 type0 = ada_check_typedef (type0);
8622 if (TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0))
8623 return type0;
8624
8625 constrained_packed_array_p = ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type0);
8626 if (constrained_packed_array_p)
8627 type0 = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (type0);
8628
8629 index_type_desc = ada_find_parallel_type (type0, xa_suffix);
8630
8631 /* As mentioned in exp_dbug.ads, for non bit-packed arrays an
8632 encoding suffixed with 'P' may still be generated. If so,
8633 it should be used to find the XA type. */
8634
8635 if (index_type_desc == NULL)
8636 {
8637 const char *type_name = ada_type_name (type0);
8638
8639 if (type_name != NULL)
8640 {
8641 const int len = strlen (type_name);
8642 char *name = (char *) alloca (len + strlen (xa_suffix));
8643
8644 if (type_name[len - 1] == 'P')
8645 {
8646 strcpy (name, type_name);
8647 strcpy (name + len - 1, xa_suffix);
8648 index_type_desc = ada_find_parallel_type_with_name (type0, name);
8649 }
8650 }
8651 }
8652
8653 ada_fixup_array_indexes_type (index_type_desc);
8654 if (index_type_desc != NULL
8655 && ada_is_redundant_index_type_desc (type0, index_type_desc))
8656 {
8657 /* Ignore this ___XA parallel type, as it does not bring any
8658 useful information. This allows us to avoid creating fixed
8659 versions of the array's index types, which would be identical
8660 to the original ones. This, in turn, can also help avoid
8661 the creation of fixed versions of the array itself. */
8662 index_type_desc = NULL;
8663 }
8664
8665 if (index_type_desc == NULL)
8666 {
8667 struct type *elt_type0 = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0));
8668
8669 /* NOTE: elt_type---the fixed version of elt_type0---should never
8670 depend on the contents of the array in properly constructed
8671 debugging data. */
8672 /* Create a fixed version of the array element type.
8673 We're not providing the address of an element here,
8674 and thus the actual object value cannot be inspected to do
8675 the conversion. This should not be a problem, since arrays of
8676 unconstrained objects are not allowed. In particular, all
8677 the elements of an array of a tagged type should all be of
8678 the same type specified in the debugging info. No need to
8679 consult the object tag. */
8680 struct type *elt_type = ada_to_fixed_type (elt_type0, 0, 0, dval, 1);
8681
8682 /* Make sure we always create a new array type when dealing with
8683 packed array types, since we're going to fix-up the array
8684 type length and element bitsize a little further down. */
8685 if (elt_type0 == elt_type && !constrained_packed_array_p)
8686 result = type0;
8687 else
8688 result = create_array_type (alloc_type_copy (type0),
8689 elt_type, TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type0));
8690 }
8691 else
8692 {
8693 int i;
8694 struct type *elt_type0;
8695
8696 elt_type0 = type0;
8697 for (i = TYPE_NFIELDS (index_type_desc); i > 0; i -= 1)
8698 elt_type0 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type0);
8699
8700 /* NOTE: result---the fixed version of elt_type0---should never
8701 depend on the contents of the array in properly constructed
8702 debugging data. */
8703 /* Create a fixed version of the array element type.
8704 We're not providing the address of an element here,
8705 and thus the actual object value cannot be inspected to do
8706 the conversion. This should not be a problem, since arrays of
8707 unconstrained objects are not allowed. In particular, all
8708 the elements of an array of a tagged type should all be of
8709 the same type specified in the debugging info. No need to
8710 consult the object tag. */
8711 result =
8712 ada_to_fixed_type (ada_check_typedef (elt_type0), 0, 0, dval, 1);
8713
8714 elt_type0 = type0;
8715 for (i = TYPE_NFIELDS (index_type_desc) - 1; i >= 0; i -= 1)
8716 {
8717 struct type *range_type =
8718 to_fixed_range_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_type_desc, i), dval);
8719
8720 result = create_array_type (alloc_type_copy (elt_type0),
8721 result, range_type);
8722 elt_type0 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type0);
8723 }
8724 if (!ignore_too_big && TYPE_LENGTH (result) > varsize_limit)
8725 error (_("array type with dynamic size is larger than varsize-limit"));
8726 }
8727
8728 /* We want to preserve the type name. This can be useful when
8729 trying to get the type name of a value that has already been
8730 printed (for instance, if the user did "print VAR; whatis $". */
8731 result->set_name (type0->name ());
8732
8733 if (constrained_packed_array_p)
8734 {
8735 /* So far, the resulting type has been created as if the original
8736 type was a regular (non-packed) array type. As a result, the
8737 bitsize of the array elements needs to be set again, and the array
8738 length needs to be recomputed based on that bitsize. */
8739 int len = TYPE_LENGTH (result) / TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (result));
8740 int elt_bitsize = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type0, 0);
8741
8742 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (result, 0) = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type0, 0);
8743 TYPE_LENGTH (result) = len * elt_bitsize / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
8744 if (TYPE_LENGTH (result) * HOST_CHAR_BIT < len * elt_bitsize)
8745 TYPE_LENGTH (result)++;
8746 }
8747
8748 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (result) = 1;
8749 return result;
8750 }
8751
8752
8753 /* A standard type (containing no dynamically sized components)
8754 corresponding to TYPE for the value (TYPE, VALADDR, ADDRESS)
8755 DVAL describes a record containing any discriminants used in TYPE0,
8756 and may be NULL if there are none, or if the object of type TYPE at
8757 ADDRESS or in VALADDR contains these discriminants.
8758
8759 If CHECK_TAG is not null, in the case of tagged types, this function
8760 attempts to locate the object's tag and use it to compute the actual
8761 type. However, when ADDRESS is null, we cannot use it to determine the
8762 location of the tag, and therefore compute the tagged type's actual type.
8763 So we return the tagged type without consulting the tag. */
8764
8765 static struct type *
8766 ada_to_fixed_type_1 (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
8767 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval, int check_tag)
8768 {
8769 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
8770
8771 /* Only un-fixed types need to be handled here. */
8772 if (!HAVE_GNAT_AUX_INFO (type))
8773 return type;
8774
8775 switch (type->code ())
8776 {
8777 default:
8778 return type;
8779 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
8780 {
8781 struct type *static_type = to_static_fixed_type (type);
8782 struct type *fixed_record_type =
8783 to_fixed_record_type (type, valaddr, address, NULL);
8784
8785 /* If STATIC_TYPE is a tagged type and we know the object's address,
8786 then we can determine its tag, and compute the object's actual
8787 type from there. Note that we have to use the fixed record
8788 type (the parent part of the record may have dynamic fields
8789 and the way the location of _tag is expressed may depend on
8790 them). */
8791
8792 if (check_tag && address != 0 && ada_is_tagged_type (static_type, 0))
8793 {
8794 struct value *tag =
8795 value_tag_from_contents_and_address
8796 (fixed_record_type,
8797 valaddr,
8798 address);
8799 struct type *real_type = type_from_tag (tag);
8800 struct value *obj =
8801 value_from_contents_and_address (fixed_record_type,
8802 valaddr,
8803 address);
8804 fixed_record_type = value_type (obj);
8805 if (real_type != NULL)
8806 return to_fixed_record_type
8807 (real_type, NULL,
8808 value_address (ada_tag_value_at_base_address (obj)), NULL);
8809 }
8810
8811 /* Check to see if there is a parallel ___XVZ variable.
8812 If there is, then it provides the actual size of our type. */
8813 else if (ada_type_name (fixed_record_type) != NULL)
8814 {
8815 const char *name = ada_type_name (fixed_record_type);
8816 char *xvz_name
8817 = (char *) alloca (strlen (name) + 7 /* "___XVZ\0" */);
8818 bool xvz_found = false;
8819 LONGEST size;
8820
8821 xsnprintf (xvz_name, strlen (name) + 7, "%s___XVZ", name);
8822 try
8823 {
8824 xvz_found = get_int_var_value (xvz_name, size);
8825 }
8826 catch (const gdb_exception_error &except)
8827 {
8828 /* We found the variable, but somehow failed to read
8829 its value. Rethrow the same error, but with a little
8830 bit more information, to help the user understand
8831 what went wrong (Eg: the variable might have been
8832 optimized out). */
8833 throw_error (except.error,
8834 _("unable to read value of %s (%s)"),
8835 xvz_name, except.what ());
8836 }
8837
8838 if (xvz_found && TYPE_LENGTH (fixed_record_type) != size)
8839 {
8840 fixed_record_type = copy_type (fixed_record_type);
8841 TYPE_LENGTH (fixed_record_type) = size;
8842
8843 /* The FIXED_RECORD_TYPE may have be a stub. We have
8844 observed this when the debugging info is STABS, and
8845 apparently it is something that is hard to fix.
8846
8847 In practice, we don't need the actual type definition
8848 at all, because the presence of the XVZ variable allows us
8849 to assume that there must be a XVS type as well, which we
8850 should be able to use later, when we need the actual type
8851 definition.
8852
8853 In the meantime, pretend that the "fixed" type we are
8854 returning is NOT a stub, because this can cause trouble
8855 when using this type to create new types targeting it.
8856 Indeed, the associated creation routines often check
8857 whether the target type is a stub and will try to replace
8858 it, thus using a type with the wrong size. This, in turn,
8859 might cause the new type to have the wrong size too.
8860 Consider the case of an array, for instance, where the size
8861 of the array is computed from the number of elements in
8862 our array multiplied by the size of its element. */
8863 TYPE_STUB (fixed_record_type) = 0;
8864 }
8865 }
8866 return fixed_record_type;
8867 }
8868 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
8869 return to_fixed_array_type (type, dval, 1);
8870 case TYPE_CODE_UNION:
8871 if (dval == NULL)
8872 return type;
8873 else
8874 return to_fixed_variant_branch_type (type, valaddr, address, dval);
8875 }
8876 }
8877
8878 /* The same as ada_to_fixed_type_1, except that it preserves the type
8879 if it is a TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF of a type that is already fixed.
8880
8881 The typedef layer needs be preserved in order to differentiate between
8882 arrays and array pointers when both types are implemented using the same
8883 fat pointer. In the array pointer case, the pointer is encoded as
8884 a typedef of the pointer type. For instance, considering:
8885
8886 type String_Access is access String;
8887 S1 : String_Access := null;
8888
8889 To the debugger, S1 is defined as a typedef of type String. But
8890 to the user, it is a pointer. So if the user tries to print S1,
8891 we should not dereference the array, but print the array address
8892 instead.
8893
8894 If we didn't preserve the typedef layer, we would lose the fact that
8895 the type is to be presented as a pointer (needs de-reference before
8896 being printed). And we would also use the source-level type name. */
8897
8898 struct type *
8899 ada_to_fixed_type (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
8900 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval, int check_tag)
8901
8902 {
8903 struct type *fixed_type =
8904 ada_to_fixed_type_1 (type, valaddr, address, dval, check_tag);
8905
8906 /* If TYPE is a typedef and its target type is the same as the FIXED_TYPE,
8907 then preserve the typedef layer.
8908
8909 Implementation note: We can only check the main-type portion of
8910 the TYPE and FIXED_TYPE, because eliminating the typedef layer
8911 from TYPE now returns a type that has the same instance flags
8912 as TYPE. For instance, if TYPE is a "typedef const", and its
8913 target type is a "struct", then the typedef elimination will return
8914 a "const" version of the target type. See check_typedef for more
8915 details about how the typedef layer elimination is done.
8916
8917 brobecker/2010-11-19: It seems to me that the only case where it is
8918 useful to preserve the typedef layer is when dealing with fat pointers.
8919 Perhaps, we could add a check for that and preserve the typedef layer
8920 only in that situation. But this seems unnecessary so far, probably
8921 because we call check_typedef/ada_check_typedef pretty much everywhere.
8922 */
8923 if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
8924 && (TYPE_MAIN_TYPE (ada_typedef_target_type (type))
8925 == TYPE_MAIN_TYPE (fixed_type)))
8926 return type;
8927
8928 return fixed_type;
8929 }
8930
8931 /* A standard (static-sized) type corresponding as well as possible to
8932 TYPE0, but based on no runtime data. */
8933
8934 static struct type *
8935 to_static_fixed_type (struct type *type0)
8936 {
8937 struct type *type;
8938
8939 if (type0 == NULL)
8940 return NULL;
8941
8942 if (TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0))
8943 return type0;
8944
8945 type0 = ada_check_typedef (type0);
8946
8947 switch (type0->code ())
8948 {
8949 default:
8950 return type0;
8951 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
8952 type = dynamic_template_type (type0);
8953 if (type != NULL)
8954 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type);
8955 else
8956 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type0);
8957 case TYPE_CODE_UNION:
8958 type = ada_find_parallel_type (type0, "___XVU");
8959 if (type != NULL)
8960 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type);
8961 else
8962 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type0);
8963 }
8964 }
8965
8966 /* A static approximation of TYPE with all type wrappers removed. */
8967
8968 static struct type *
8969 static_unwrap_type (struct type *type)
8970 {
8971 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
8972 {
8973 struct type *type1 = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (ada_check_typedef (type), 0);
8974 if (ada_type_name (type1) == NULL)
8975 type1->set_name (ada_type_name (type));
8976
8977 return static_unwrap_type (type1);
8978 }
8979 else
8980 {
8981 struct type *raw_real_type = ada_get_base_type (type);
8982
8983 if (raw_real_type == type)
8984 return type;
8985 else
8986 return to_static_fixed_type (raw_real_type);
8987 }
8988 }
8989
8990 /* In some cases, incomplete and private types require
8991 cross-references that are not resolved as records (for example,
8992 type Foo;
8993 type FooP is access Foo;
8994 V: FooP;
8995 type Foo is array ...;
8996 ). In these cases, since there is no mechanism for producing
8997 cross-references to such types, we instead substitute for FooP a
8998 stub enumeration type that is nowhere resolved, and whose tag is
8999 the name of the actual type. Call these types "non-record stubs". */
9000
9001 /* A type equivalent to TYPE that is not a non-record stub, if one
9002 exists, otherwise TYPE. */
9003
9004 struct type *
9005 ada_check_typedef (struct type *type)
9006 {
9007 if (type == NULL)
9008 return NULL;
9009
9010 /* If our type is an access to an unconstrained array, which is encoded
9011 as a TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF of a fat pointer, then we're done.
9012 We don't want to strip the TYPE_CODE_TYPDEF layer, because this is
9013 what allows us to distinguish between fat pointers that represent
9014 array types, and fat pointers that represent array access types
9015 (in both cases, the compiler implements them as fat pointers). */
9016 if (ada_is_access_to_unconstrained_array (type))
9017 return type;
9018
9019 type = check_typedef (type);
9020 if (type == NULL || type->code () != TYPE_CODE_ENUM
9021 || !TYPE_STUB (type)
9022 || type->name () == NULL)
9023 return type;
9024 else
9025 {
9026 const char *name = type->name ();
9027 struct type *type1 = ada_find_any_type (name);
9028
9029 if (type1 == NULL)
9030 return type;
9031
9032 /* TYPE1 might itself be a TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF (this can happen with
9033 stubs pointing to arrays, as we don't create symbols for array
9034 types, only for the typedef-to-array types). If that's the case,
9035 strip the typedef layer. */
9036 if (type1->code () == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
9037 type1 = ada_check_typedef (type1);
9038
9039 return type1;
9040 }
9041 }
9042
9043 /* A value representing the data at VALADDR/ADDRESS as described by
9044 type TYPE0, but with a standard (static-sized) type that correctly
9045 describes it. If VAL0 is not NULL and TYPE0 already is a standard
9046 type, then return VAL0 [this feature is simply to avoid redundant
9047 creation of struct values]. */
9048
9049 static struct value *
9050 ada_to_fixed_value_create (struct type *type0, CORE_ADDR address,
9051 struct value *val0)
9052 {
9053 struct type *type = ada_to_fixed_type (type0, 0, address, NULL, 1);
9054
9055 if (type == type0 && val0 != NULL)
9056 return val0;
9057
9058 if (VALUE_LVAL (val0) != lval_memory)
9059 {
9060 /* Our value does not live in memory; it could be a convenience
9061 variable, for instance. Create a not_lval value using val0's
9062 contents. */
9063 return value_from_contents (type, value_contents (val0));
9064 }
9065
9066 return value_from_contents_and_address (type, 0, address);
9067 }
9068
9069 /* A value representing VAL, but with a standard (static-sized) type
9070 that correctly describes it. Does not necessarily create a new
9071 value. */
9072
9073 struct value *
9074 ada_to_fixed_value (struct value *val)
9075 {
9076 val = unwrap_value (val);
9077 val = ada_to_fixed_value_create (value_type (val), value_address (val), val);
9078 return val;
9079 }
9080 \f
9081
9082 /* Attributes */
9083
9084 /* Table mapping attribute numbers to names.
9085 NOTE: Keep up to date with enum ada_attribute definition in ada-lang.h. */
9086
9087 static const char *attribute_names[] = {
9088 "<?>",
9089
9090 "first",
9091 "last",
9092 "length",
9093 "image",
9094 "max",
9095 "min",
9096 "modulus",
9097 "pos",
9098 "size",
9099 "tag",
9100 "val",
9101 0
9102 };
9103
9104 static const char *
9105 ada_attribute_name (enum exp_opcode n)
9106 {
9107 if (n >= OP_ATR_FIRST && n <= (int) OP_ATR_VAL)
9108 return attribute_names[n - OP_ATR_FIRST + 1];
9109 else
9110 return attribute_names[0];
9111 }
9112
9113 /* Evaluate the 'POS attribute applied to ARG. */
9114
9115 static LONGEST
9116 pos_atr (struct value *arg)
9117 {
9118 struct value *val = coerce_ref (arg);
9119 struct type *type = value_type (val);
9120 LONGEST result;
9121
9122 if (!discrete_type_p (type))
9123 error (_("'POS only defined on discrete types"));
9124
9125 if (!discrete_position (type, value_as_long (val), &result))
9126 error (_("enumeration value is invalid: can't find 'POS"));
9127
9128 return result;
9129 }
9130
9131 static struct value *
9132 value_pos_atr (struct type *type, struct value *arg)
9133 {
9134 return value_from_longest (type, pos_atr (arg));
9135 }
9136
9137 /* Evaluate the TYPE'VAL attribute applied to ARG. */
9138
9139 static struct value *
9140 value_val_atr (struct type *type, struct value *arg)
9141 {
9142 if (!discrete_type_p (type))
9143 error (_("'VAL only defined on discrete types"));
9144 if (!integer_type_p (value_type (arg)))
9145 error (_("'VAL requires integral argument"));
9146
9147 if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
9148 {
9149 long pos = value_as_long (arg);
9150
9151 if (pos < 0 || pos >= TYPE_NFIELDS (type))
9152 error (_("argument to 'VAL out of range"));
9153 return value_from_longest (type, TYPE_FIELD_ENUMVAL (type, pos));
9154 }
9155 else
9156 return value_from_longest (type, value_as_long (arg));
9157 }
9158 \f
9159
9160 /* Evaluation */
9161
9162 /* True if TYPE appears to be an Ada character type.
9163 [At the moment, this is true only for Character and Wide_Character;
9164 It is a heuristic test that could stand improvement]. */
9165
9166 bool
9167 ada_is_character_type (struct type *type)
9168 {
9169 const char *name;
9170
9171 /* If the type code says it's a character, then assume it really is,
9172 and don't check any further. */
9173 if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_CHAR)
9174 return true;
9175
9176 /* Otherwise, assume it's a character type iff it is a discrete type
9177 with a known character type name. */
9178 name = ada_type_name (type);
9179 return (name != NULL
9180 && (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_INT
9181 || type->code () == TYPE_CODE_RANGE)
9182 && (strcmp (name, "character") == 0
9183 || strcmp (name, "wide_character") == 0
9184 || strcmp (name, "wide_wide_character") == 0
9185 || strcmp (name, "unsigned char") == 0));
9186 }
9187
9188 /* True if TYPE appears to be an Ada string type. */
9189
9190 bool
9191 ada_is_string_type (struct type *type)
9192 {
9193 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
9194 if (type != NULL
9195 && type->code () != TYPE_CODE_PTR
9196 && (ada_is_simple_array_type (type)
9197 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type))
9198 && ada_array_arity (type) == 1)
9199 {
9200 struct type *elttype = ada_array_element_type (type, 1);
9201
9202 return ada_is_character_type (elttype);
9203 }
9204 else
9205 return false;
9206 }
9207
9208 /* The compiler sometimes provides a parallel XVS type for a given
9209 PAD type. Normally, it is safe to follow the PAD type directly,
9210 but older versions of the compiler have a bug that causes the offset
9211 of its "F" field to be wrong. Following that field in that case
9212 would lead to incorrect results, but this can be worked around
9213 by ignoring the PAD type and using the associated XVS type instead.
9214
9215 Set to True if the debugger should trust the contents of PAD types.
9216 Otherwise, ignore the PAD type if there is a parallel XVS type. */
9217 static bool trust_pad_over_xvs = true;
9218
9219 /* True if TYPE is a struct type introduced by the compiler to force the
9220 alignment of a value. Such types have a single field with a
9221 distinctive name. */
9222
9223 int
9224 ada_is_aligner_type (struct type *type)
9225 {
9226 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
9227
9228 if (!trust_pad_over_xvs && ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XVS") != NULL)
9229 return 0;
9230
9231 return (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
9232 && TYPE_NFIELDS (type) == 1
9233 && strcmp (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, 0), "F") == 0);
9234 }
9235
9236 /* If there is an ___XVS-convention type parallel to SUBTYPE, return
9237 the parallel type. */
9238
9239 struct type *
9240 ada_get_base_type (struct type *raw_type)
9241 {
9242 struct type *real_type_namer;
9243 struct type *raw_real_type;
9244
9245 if (raw_type == NULL || raw_type->code () != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
9246 return raw_type;
9247
9248 if (ada_is_aligner_type (raw_type))
9249 /* The encoding specifies that we should always use the aligner type.
9250 So, even if this aligner type has an associated XVS type, we should
9251 simply ignore it.
9252
9253 According to the compiler gurus, an XVS type parallel to an aligner
9254 type may exist because of a stabs limitation. In stabs, aligner
9255 types are empty because the field has a variable-sized type, and
9256 thus cannot actually be used as an aligner type. As a result,
9257 we need the associated parallel XVS type to decode the type.
9258 Since the policy in the compiler is to not change the internal
9259 representation based on the debugging info format, we sometimes
9260 end up having a redundant XVS type parallel to the aligner type. */
9261 return raw_type;
9262
9263 real_type_namer = ada_find_parallel_type (raw_type, "___XVS");
9264 if (real_type_namer == NULL
9265 || real_type_namer->code () != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
9266 || TYPE_NFIELDS (real_type_namer) != 1)
9267 return raw_type;
9268
9269 if (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (real_type_namer, 0)->code () != TYPE_CODE_REF)
9270 {
9271 /* This is an older encoding form where the base type needs to be
9272 looked up by name. We prefer the newer encoding because it is
9273 more efficient. */
9274 raw_real_type = ada_find_any_type (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (real_type_namer, 0));
9275 if (raw_real_type == NULL)
9276 return raw_type;
9277 else
9278 return raw_real_type;
9279 }
9280
9281 /* The field in our XVS type is a reference to the base type. */
9282 return TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (real_type_namer, 0));
9283 }
9284
9285 /* The type of value designated by TYPE, with all aligners removed. */
9286
9287 struct type *
9288 ada_aligned_type (struct type *type)
9289 {
9290 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
9291 return ada_aligned_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 0));
9292 else
9293 return ada_get_base_type (type);
9294 }
9295
9296
9297 /* The address of the aligned value in an object at address VALADDR
9298 having type TYPE. Assumes ada_is_aligner_type (TYPE). */
9299
9300 const gdb_byte *
9301 ada_aligned_value_addr (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr)
9302 {
9303 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
9304 return ada_aligned_value_addr (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 0),
9305 valaddr +
9306 TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type,
9307 0) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT);
9308 else
9309 return valaddr;
9310 }
9311
9312
9313
9314 /* The printed representation of an enumeration literal with encoded
9315 name NAME. The value is good to the next call of ada_enum_name. */
9316 const char *
9317 ada_enum_name (const char *name)
9318 {
9319 static char *result;
9320 static size_t result_len = 0;
9321 const char *tmp;
9322
9323 /* First, unqualify the enumeration name:
9324 1. Search for the last '.' character. If we find one, then skip
9325 all the preceding characters, the unqualified name starts
9326 right after that dot.
9327 2. Otherwise, we may be debugging on a target where the compiler
9328 translates dots into "__". Search forward for double underscores,
9329 but stop searching when we hit an overloading suffix, which is
9330 of the form "__" followed by digits. */
9331
9332 tmp = strrchr (name, '.');
9333 if (tmp != NULL)
9334 name = tmp + 1;
9335 else
9336 {
9337 while ((tmp = strstr (name, "__")) != NULL)
9338 {
9339 if (isdigit (tmp[2]))
9340 break;
9341 else
9342 name = tmp + 2;
9343 }
9344 }
9345
9346 if (name[0] == 'Q')
9347 {
9348 int v;
9349
9350 if (name[1] == 'U' || name[1] == 'W')
9351 {
9352 if (sscanf (name + 2, "%x", &v) != 1)
9353 return name;
9354 }
9355 else if (((name[1] >= '0' && name[1] <= '9')
9356 || (name[1] >= 'a' && name[1] <= 'z'))
9357 && name[2] == '\0')
9358 {
9359 GROW_VECT (result, result_len, 4);
9360 xsnprintf (result, result_len, "'%c'", name[1]);
9361 return result;
9362 }
9363 else
9364 return name;
9365
9366 GROW_VECT (result, result_len, 16);
9367 if (isascii (v) && isprint (v))
9368 xsnprintf (result, result_len, "'%c'", v);
9369 else if (name[1] == 'U')
9370 xsnprintf (result, result_len, "[\"%02x\"]", v);
9371 else
9372 xsnprintf (result, result_len, "[\"%04x\"]", v);
9373
9374 return result;
9375 }
9376 else
9377 {
9378 tmp = strstr (name, "__");
9379 if (tmp == NULL)
9380 tmp = strstr (name, "$");
9381 if (tmp != NULL)
9382 {
9383 GROW_VECT (result, result_len, tmp - name + 1);
9384 strncpy (result, name, tmp - name);
9385 result[tmp - name] = '\0';
9386 return result;
9387 }
9388
9389 return name;
9390 }
9391 }
9392
9393 /* Evaluate the subexpression of EXP starting at *POS as for
9394 evaluate_type, updating *POS to point just past the evaluated
9395 expression. */
9396
9397 static struct value *
9398 evaluate_subexp_type (struct expression *exp, int *pos)
9399 {
9400 return evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS);
9401 }
9402
9403 /* If VAL is wrapped in an aligner or subtype wrapper, return the
9404 value it wraps. */
9405
9406 static struct value *
9407 unwrap_value (struct value *val)
9408 {
9409 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (val));
9410
9411 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
9412 {
9413 struct value *v = ada_value_struct_elt (val, "F", 0);
9414 struct type *val_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (v));
9415
9416 if (ada_type_name (val_type) == NULL)
9417 val_type->set_name (ada_type_name (type));
9418
9419 return unwrap_value (v);
9420 }
9421 else
9422 {
9423 struct type *raw_real_type =
9424 ada_check_typedef (ada_get_base_type (type));
9425
9426 /* If there is no parallel XVS or XVE type, then the value is
9427 already unwrapped. Return it without further modification. */
9428 if ((type == raw_real_type)
9429 && ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XVE") == NULL)
9430 return val;
9431
9432 return
9433 coerce_unspec_val_to_type
9434 (val, ada_to_fixed_type (raw_real_type, 0,
9435 value_address (val),
9436 NULL, 1));
9437 }
9438 }
9439
9440 static struct value *
9441 cast_from_fixed (struct type *type, struct value *arg)
9442 {
9443 struct value *scale = ada_scaling_factor (value_type (arg));
9444 arg = value_cast (value_type (scale), arg);
9445
9446 arg = value_binop (arg, scale, BINOP_MUL);
9447 return value_cast (type, arg);
9448 }
9449
9450 static struct value *
9451 cast_to_fixed (struct type *type, struct value *arg)
9452 {
9453 if (type == value_type (arg))
9454 return arg;
9455
9456 struct value *scale = ada_scaling_factor (type);
9457 if (ada_is_gnat_encoded_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg)))
9458 arg = cast_from_fixed (value_type (scale), arg);
9459 else
9460 arg = value_cast (value_type (scale), arg);
9461
9462 arg = value_binop (arg, scale, BINOP_DIV);
9463 return value_cast (type, arg);
9464 }
9465
9466 /* Given two array types T1 and T2, return nonzero iff both arrays
9467 contain the same number of elements. */
9468
9469 static int
9470 ada_same_array_size_p (struct type *t1, struct type *t2)
9471 {
9472 LONGEST lo1, hi1, lo2, hi2;
9473
9474 /* Get the array bounds in order to verify that the size of
9475 the two arrays match. */
9476 if (!get_array_bounds (t1, &lo1, &hi1)
9477 || !get_array_bounds (t2, &lo2, &hi2))
9478 error (_("unable to determine array bounds"));
9479
9480 /* To make things easier for size comparison, normalize a bit
9481 the case of empty arrays by making sure that the difference
9482 between upper bound and lower bound is always -1. */
9483 if (lo1 > hi1)
9484 hi1 = lo1 - 1;
9485 if (lo2 > hi2)
9486 hi2 = lo2 - 1;
9487
9488 return (hi1 - lo1 == hi2 - lo2);
9489 }
9490
9491 /* Assuming that VAL is an array of integrals, and TYPE represents
9492 an array with the same number of elements, but with wider integral
9493 elements, return an array "casted" to TYPE. In practice, this
9494 means that the returned array is built by casting each element
9495 of the original array into TYPE's (wider) element type. */
9496
9497 static struct value *
9498 ada_promote_array_of_integrals (struct type *type, struct value *val)
9499 {
9500 struct type *elt_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
9501 LONGEST lo, hi;
9502 struct value *res;
9503 LONGEST i;
9504
9505 /* Verify that both val and type are arrays of scalars, and
9506 that the size of val's elements is smaller than the size
9507 of type's element. */
9508 gdb_assert (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY);
9509 gdb_assert (is_integral_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)));
9510 gdb_assert (value_type (val)->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY);
9511 gdb_assert (is_integral_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (val))));
9512 gdb_assert (TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type))
9513 > TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (val))));
9514
9515 if (!get_array_bounds (type, &lo, &hi))
9516 error (_("unable to determine array bounds"));
9517
9518 res = allocate_value (type);
9519
9520 /* Promote each array element. */
9521 for (i = 0; i < hi - lo + 1; i++)
9522 {
9523 struct value *elt = value_cast (elt_type, value_subscript (val, lo + i));
9524
9525 memcpy (value_contents_writeable (res) + (i * TYPE_LENGTH (elt_type)),
9526 value_contents_all (elt), TYPE_LENGTH (elt_type));
9527 }
9528
9529 return res;
9530 }
9531
9532 /* Coerce VAL as necessary for assignment to an lval of type TYPE, and
9533 return the converted value. */
9534
9535 static struct value *
9536 coerce_for_assign (struct type *type, struct value *val)
9537 {
9538 struct type *type2 = value_type (val);
9539
9540 if (type == type2)
9541 return val;
9542
9543 type2 = ada_check_typedef (type2);
9544 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
9545
9546 if (type2->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR
9547 && type->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
9548 {
9549 val = ada_value_ind (val);
9550 type2 = value_type (val);
9551 }
9552
9553 if (type2->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
9554 && type->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
9555 {
9556 if (!ada_same_array_size_p (type, type2))
9557 error (_("cannot assign arrays of different length"));
9558
9559 if (is_integral_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type))
9560 && is_integral_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type2))
9561 && TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type2))
9562 < TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)))
9563 {
9564 /* Allow implicit promotion of the array elements to
9565 a wider type. */
9566 return ada_promote_array_of_integrals (type, val);
9567 }
9568
9569 if (TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type2))
9570 != TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)))
9571 error (_("Incompatible types in assignment"));
9572 deprecated_set_value_type (val, type);
9573 }
9574 return val;
9575 }
9576
9577 static struct value *
9578 ada_value_binop (struct value *arg1, struct value *arg2, enum exp_opcode op)
9579 {
9580 struct value *val;
9581 struct type *type1, *type2;
9582 LONGEST v, v1, v2;
9583
9584 arg1 = coerce_ref (arg1);
9585 arg2 = coerce_ref (arg2);
9586 type1 = get_base_type (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg1)));
9587 type2 = get_base_type (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg2)));
9588
9589 if (type1->code () != TYPE_CODE_INT
9590 || type2->code () != TYPE_CODE_INT)
9591 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
9592
9593 switch (op)
9594 {
9595 case BINOP_MOD:
9596 case BINOP_DIV:
9597 case BINOP_REM:
9598 break;
9599 default:
9600 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
9601 }
9602
9603 v2 = value_as_long (arg2);
9604 if (v2 == 0)
9605 error (_("second operand of %s must not be zero."), op_string (op));
9606
9607 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type1) || op == BINOP_MOD)
9608 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
9609
9610 v1 = value_as_long (arg1);
9611 switch (op)
9612 {
9613 case BINOP_DIV:
9614 v = v1 / v2;
9615 if (!TRUNCATION_TOWARDS_ZERO && v1 * (v1 % v2) < 0)
9616 v += v > 0 ? -1 : 1;
9617 break;
9618 case BINOP_REM:
9619 v = v1 % v2;
9620 if (v * v1 < 0)
9621 v -= v2;
9622 break;
9623 default:
9624 /* Should not reach this point. */
9625 v = 0;
9626 }
9627
9628 val = allocate_value (type1);
9629 store_unsigned_integer (value_contents_raw (val),
9630 TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (val)),
9631 type_byte_order (type1), v);
9632 return val;
9633 }
9634
9635 static int
9636 ada_value_equal (struct value *arg1, struct value *arg2)
9637 {
9638 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (arg1))
9639 || ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (arg2)))
9640 {
9641 struct type *arg1_type, *arg2_type;
9642
9643 /* Automatically dereference any array reference before
9644 we attempt to perform the comparison. */
9645 arg1 = ada_coerce_ref (arg1);
9646 arg2 = ada_coerce_ref (arg2);
9647
9648 arg1 = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg1);
9649 arg2 = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg2);
9650
9651 arg1_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg1));
9652 arg2_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg2));
9653
9654 if (arg1_type->code () != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
9655 || arg2_type->code () != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
9656 error (_("Attempt to compare array with non-array"));
9657 /* FIXME: The following works only for types whose
9658 representations use all bits (no padding or undefined bits)
9659 and do not have user-defined equality. */
9660 return (TYPE_LENGTH (arg1_type) == TYPE_LENGTH (arg2_type)
9661 && memcmp (value_contents (arg1), value_contents (arg2),
9662 TYPE_LENGTH (arg1_type)) == 0);
9663 }
9664 return value_equal (arg1, arg2);
9665 }
9666
9667 /* Total number of component associations in the aggregate starting at
9668 index PC in EXP. Assumes that index PC is the start of an
9669 OP_AGGREGATE. */
9670
9671 static int
9672 num_component_specs (struct expression *exp, int pc)
9673 {
9674 int n, m, i;
9675
9676 m = exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst;
9677 pc += 3;
9678 n = 0;
9679 for (i = 0; i < m; i += 1)
9680 {
9681 switch (exp->elts[pc].opcode)
9682 {
9683 default:
9684 n += 1;
9685 break;
9686 case OP_CHOICES:
9687 n += exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst;
9688 break;
9689 }
9690 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, &pc, EVAL_SKIP);
9691 }
9692 return n;
9693 }
9694
9695 /* Assign the result of evaluating EXP starting at *POS to the INDEXth
9696 component of LHS (a simple array or a record), updating *POS past
9697 the expression, assuming that LHS is contained in CONTAINER. Does
9698 not modify the inferior's memory, nor does it modify LHS (unless
9699 LHS == CONTAINER). */
9700
9701 static void
9702 assign_component (struct value *container, struct value *lhs, LONGEST index,
9703 struct expression *exp, int *pos)
9704 {
9705 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
9706 struct value *elt;
9707 struct type *lhs_type = check_typedef (value_type (lhs));
9708
9709 if (lhs_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
9710 {
9711 struct type *index_type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
9712 struct value *index_val = value_from_longest (index_type, index);
9713
9714 elt = unwrap_value (ada_value_subscript (lhs, 1, &index_val));
9715 }
9716 else
9717 {
9718 elt = ada_index_struct_field (index, lhs, 0, value_type (lhs));
9719 elt = ada_to_fixed_value (elt);
9720 }
9721
9722 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_AGGREGATE)
9723 assign_aggregate (container, elt, exp, pos, EVAL_NORMAL);
9724 else
9725 value_assign_to_component (container, elt,
9726 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos,
9727 EVAL_NORMAL));
9728
9729 value_free_to_mark (mark);
9730 }
9731
9732 /* Assuming that LHS represents an lvalue having a record or array
9733 type, and EXP->ELTS[*POS] is an OP_AGGREGATE, evaluate an assignment
9734 of that aggregate's value to LHS, advancing *POS past the
9735 aggregate. NOSIDE is as for evaluate_subexp. CONTAINER is an
9736 lvalue containing LHS (possibly LHS itself). Does not modify
9737 the inferior's memory, nor does it modify the contents of
9738 LHS (unless == CONTAINER). Returns the modified CONTAINER. */
9739
9740 static struct value *
9741 assign_aggregate (struct value *container,
9742 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
9743 int *pos, enum noside noside)
9744 {
9745 struct type *lhs_type;
9746 int n = exp->elts[*pos+1].longconst;
9747 LONGEST low_index, high_index;
9748 int num_specs;
9749 LONGEST *indices;
9750 int max_indices, num_indices;
9751 int i;
9752
9753 *pos += 3;
9754 if (noside != EVAL_NORMAL)
9755 {
9756 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 1)
9757 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, noside);
9758 return container;
9759 }
9760
9761 container = ada_coerce_ref (container);
9762 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (container)))
9763 container = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (container);
9764 lhs = ada_coerce_ref (lhs);
9765 if (!deprecated_value_modifiable (lhs))
9766 error (_("Left operand of assignment is not a modifiable lvalue."));
9767
9768 lhs_type = check_typedef (value_type (lhs));
9769 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (lhs_type))
9770 {
9771 lhs = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (lhs);
9772 lhs_type = check_typedef (value_type (lhs));
9773 low_index = TYPE_ARRAY_LOWER_BOUND_VALUE (lhs_type);
9774 high_index = TYPE_ARRAY_UPPER_BOUND_VALUE (lhs_type);
9775 }
9776 else if (lhs_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
9777 {
9778 low_index = 0;
9779 high_index = num_visible_fields (lhs_type) - 1;
9780 }
9781 else
9782 error (_("Left-hand side must be array or record."));
9783
9784 num_specs = num_component_specs (exp, *pos - 3);
9785 max_indices = 4 * num_specs + 4;
9786 indices = XALLOCAVEC (LONGEST, max_indices);
9787 indices[0] = indices[1] = low_index - 1;
9788 indices[2] = indices[3] = high_index + 1;
9789 num_indices = 4;
9790
9791 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 1)
9792 {
9793 switch (exp->elts[*pos].opcode)
9794 {
9795 case OP_CHOICES:
9796 aggregate_assign_from_choices (container, lhs, exp, pos, indices,
9797 &num_indices, max_indices,
9798 low_index, high_index);
9799 break;
9800 case OP_POSITIONAL:
9801 aggregate_assign_positional (container, lhs, exp, pos, indices,
9802 &num_indices, max_indices,
9803 low_index, high_index);
9804 break;
9805 case OP_OTHERS:
9806 if (i != n-1)
9807 error (_("Misplaced 'others' clause"));
9808 aggregate_assign_others (container, lhs, exp, pos, indices,
9809 num_indices, low_index, high_index);
9810 break;
9811 default:
9812 error (_("Internal error: bad aggregate clause"));
9813 }
9814 }
9815
9816 return container;
9817 }
9818
9819 /* Assign into the component of LHS indexed by the OP_POSITIONAL
9820 construct at *POS, updating *POS past the construct, given that
9821 the positions are relative to lower bound LOW, where HIGH is the
9822 upper bound. Record the position in INDICES[0 .. MAX_INDICES-1]
9823 updating *NUM_INDICES as needed. CONTAINER is as for
9824 assign_aggregate. */
9825 static void
9826 aggregate_assign_positional (struct value *container,
9827 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
9828 int *pos, LONGEST *indices, int *num_indices,
9829 int max_indices, LONGEST low, LONGEST high)
9830 {
9831 LONGEST ind = longest_to_int (exp->elts[*pos + 1].longconst) + low;
9832
9833 if (ind - 1 == high)
9834 warning (_("Extra components in aggregate ignored."));
9835 if (ind <= high)
9836 {
9837 add_component_interval (ind, ind, indices, num_indices, max_indices);
9838 *pos += 3;
9839 assign_component (container, lhs, ind, exp, pos);
9840 }
9841 else
9842 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9843 }
9844
9845 /* Assign into the components of LHS indexed by the OP_CHOICES
9846 construct at *POS, updating *POS past the construct, given that
9847 the allowable indices are LOW..HIGH. Record the indices assigned
9848 to in INDICES[0 .. MAX_INDICES-1], updating *NUM_INDICES as
9849 needed. CONTAINER is as for assign_aggregate. */
9850 static void
9851 aggregate_assign_from_choices (struct value *container,
9852 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
9853 int *pos, LONGEST *indices, int *num_indices,
9854 int max_indices, LONGEST low, LONGEST high)
9855 {
9856 int j;
9857 int n_choices = longest_to_int (exp->elts[*pos+1].longconst);
9858 int choice_pos, expr_pc;
9859 int is_array = ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (lhs));
9860
9861 choice_pos = *pos += 3;
9862
9863 for (j = 0; j < n_choices; j += 1)
9864 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9865 expr_pc = *pos;
9866 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9867
9868 for (j = 0; j < n_choices; j += 1)
9869 {
9870 LONGEST lower, upper;
9871 enum exp_opcode op = exp->elts[choice_pos].opcode;
9872
9873 if (op == OP_DISCRETE_RANGE)
9874 {
9875 choice_pos += 1;
9876 lower = value_as_long (ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos,
9877 EVAL_NORMAL));
9878 upper = value_as_long (ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos,
9879 EVAL_NORMAL));
9880 }
9881 else if (is_array)
9882 {
9883 lower = value_as_long (ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, &choice_pos,
9884 EVAL_NORMAL));
9885 upper = lower;
9886 }
9887 else
9888 {
9889 int ind;
9890 const char *name;
9891
9892 switch (op)
9893 {
9894 case OP_NAME:
9895 name = &exp->elts[choice_pos + 2].string;
9896 break;
9897 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
9898 name = exp->elts[choice_pos + 2].symbol->natural_name ();
9899 break;
9900 default:
9901 error (_("Invalid record component association."));
9902 }
9903 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, &choice_pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9904 ind = 0;
9905 if (! find_struct_field (name, value_type (lhs), 0,
9906 NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, &ind))
9907 error (_("Unknown component name: %s."), name);
9908 lower = upper = ind;
9909 }
9910
9911 if (lower <= upper && (lower < low || upper > high))
9912 error (_("Index in component association out of bounds."));
9913
9914 add_component_interval (lower, upper, indices, num_indices,
9915 max_indices);
9916 while (lower <= upper)
9917 {
9918 int pos1;
9919
9920 pos1 = expr_pc;
9921 assign_component (container, lhs, lower, exp, &pos1);
9922 lower += 1;
9923 }
9924 }
9925 }
9926
9927 /* Assign the value of the expression in the OP_OTHERS construct in
9928 EXP at *POS into the components of LHS indexed from LOW .. HIGH that
9929 have not been previously assigned. The index intervals already assigned
9930 are in INDICES[0 .. NUM_INDICES-1]. Updates *POS to after the
9931 OP_OTHERS clause. CONTAINER is as for assign_aggregate. */
9932 static void
9933 aggregate_assign_others (struct value *container,
9934 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
9935 int *pos, LONGEST *indices, int num_indices,
9936 LONGEST low, LONGEST high)
9937 {
9938 int i;
9939 int expr_pc = *pos + 1;
9940
9941 for (i = 0; i < num_indices - 2; i += 2)
9942 {
9943 LONGEST ind;
9944
9945 for (ind = indices[i + 1] + 1; ind < indices[i + 2]; ind += 1)
9946 {
9947 int localpos;
9948
9949 localpos = expr_pc;
9950 assign_component (container, lhs, ind, exp, &localpos);
9951 }
9952 }
9953 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9954 }
9955
9956 /* Add the interval [LOW .. HIGH] to the sorted set of intervals
9957 [ INDICES[0] .. INDICES[1] ],..., [ INDICES[*SIZE-2] .. INDICES[*SIZE-1] ],
9958 modifying *SIZE as needed. It is an error if *SIZE exceeds
9959 MAX_SIZE. The resulting intervals do not overlap. */
9960 static void
9961 add_component_interval (LONGEST low, LONGEST high,
9962 LONGEST* indices, int *size, int max_size)
9963 {
9964 int i, j;
9965
9966 for (i = 0; i < *size; i += 2) {
9967 if (high >= indices[i] && low <= indices[i + 1])
9968 {
9969 int kh;
9970
9971 for (kh = i + 2; kh < *size; kh += 2)
9972 if (high < indices[kh])
9973 break;
9974 if (low < indices[i])
9975 indices[i] = low;
9976 indices[i + 1] = indices[kh - 1];
9977 if (high > indices[i + 1])
9978 indices[i + 1] = high;
9979 memcpy (indices + i + 2, indices + kh, *size - kh);
9980 *size -= kh - i - 2;
9981 return;
9982 }
9983 else if (high < indices[i])
9984 break;
9985 }
9986
9987 if (*size == max_size)
9988 error (_("Internal error: miscounted aggregate components."));
9989 *size += 2;
9990 for (j = *size-1; j >= i+2; j -= 1)
9991 indices[j] = indices[j - 2];
9992 indices[i] = low;
9993 indices[i + 1] = high;
9994 }
9995
9996 /* Perform and Ada cast of ARG2 to type TYPE if the type of ARG2
9997 is different. */
9998
9999 static struct value *
10000 ada_value_cast (struct type *type, struct value *arg2)
10001 {
10002 if (type == ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg2)))
10003 return arg2;
10004
10005 if (ada_is_gnat_encoded_fixed_point_type (type))
10006 return cast_to_fixed (type, arg2);
10007
10008 if (ada_is_gnat_encoded_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
10009 return cast_from_fixed (type, arg2);
10010
10011 return value_cast (type, arg2);
10012 }
10013
10014 /* Evaluating Ada expressions, and printing their result.
10015 ------------------------------------------------------
10016
10017 1. Introduction:
10018 ----------------
10019
10020 We usually evaluate an Ada expression in order to print its value.
10021 We also evaluate an expression in order to print its type, which
10022 happens during the EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS phase of the evaluation,
10023 but we'll focus mostly on the EVAL_NORMAL phase. In practice, the
10024 EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS phase allows us to simplify certain aspects of
10025 the evaluation compared to the EVAL_NORMAL, but is otherwise very
10026 similar.
10027
10028 Evaluating expressions is a little more complicated for Ada entities
10029 than it is for entities in languages such as C. The main reason for
10030 this is that Ada provides types whose definition might be dynamic.
10031 One example of such types is variant records. Or another example
10032 would be an array whose bounds can only be known at run time.
10033
10034 The following description is a general guide as to what should be
10035 done (and what should NOT be done) in order to evaluate an expression
10036 involving such types, and when. This does not cover how the semantic
10037 information is encoded by GNAT as this is covered separatly. For the
10038 document used as the reference for the GNAT encoding, see exp_dbug.ads
10039 in the GNAT sources.
10040
10041 Ideally, we should embed each part of this description next to its
10042 associated code. Unfortunately, the amount of code is so vast right
10043 now that it's hard to see whether the code handling a particular
10044 situation might be duplicated or not. One day, when the code is
10045 cleaned up, this guide might become redundant with the comments
10046 inserted in the code, and we might want to remove it.
10047
10048 2. ``Fixing'' an Entity, the Simple Case:
10049 -----------------------------------------
10050
10051 When evaluating Ada expressions, the tricky issue is that they may
10052 reference entities whose type contents and size are not statically
10053 known. Consider for instance a variant record:
10054
10055 type Rec (Empty : Boolean := True) is record
10056 case Empty is
10057 when True => null;
10058 when False => Value : Integer;
10059 end case;
10060 end record;
10061 Yes : Rec := (Empty => False, Value => 1);
10062 No : Rec := (empty => True);
10063
10064 The size and contents of that record depends on the value of the
10065 descriminant (Rec.Empty). At this point, neither the debugging
10066 information nor the associated type structure in GDB are able to
10067 express such dynamic types. So what the debugger does is to create
10068 "fixed" versions of the type that applies to the specific object.
10069 We also informally refer to this operation as "fixing" an object,
10070 which means creating its associated fixed type.
10071
10072 Example: when printing the value of variable "Yes" above, its fixed
10073 type would look like this:
10074
10075 type Rec is record
10076 Empty : Boolean;
10077 Value : Integer;
10078 end record;
10079
10080 On the other hand, if we printed the value of "No", its fixed type
10081 would become:
10082
10083 type Rec is record
10084 Empty : Boolean;
10085 end record;
10086
10087 Things become a little more complicated when trying to fix an entity
10088 with a dynamic type that directly contains another dynamic type,
10089 such as an array of variant records, for instance. There are
10090 two possible cases: Arrays, and records.
10091
10092 3. ``Fixing'' Arrays:
10093 ---------------------
10094
10095 The type structure in GDB describes an array in terms of its bounds,
10096 and the type of its elements. By design, all elements in the array
10097 have the same type and we cannot represent an array of variant elements
10098 using the current type structure in GDB. When fixing an array,
10099 we cannot fix the array element, as we would potentially need one
10100 fixed type per element of the array. As a result, the best we can do
10101 when fixing an array is to produce an array whose bounds and size
10102 are correct (allowing us to read it from memory), but without having
10103 touched its element type. Fixing each element will be done later,
10104 when (if) necessary.
10105
10106 Arrays are a little simpler to handle than records, because the same
10107 amount of memory is allocated for each element of the array, even if
10108 the amount of space actually used by each element differs from element
10109 to element. Consider for instance the following array of type Rec:
10110
10111 type Rec_Array is array (1 .. 2) of Rec;
10112
10113 The actual amount of memory occupied by each element might be different
10114 from element to element, depending on the value of their discriminant.
10115 But the amount of space reserved for each element in the array remains
10116 fixed regardless. So we simply need to compute that size using
10117 the debugging information available, from which we can then determine
10118 the array size (we multiply the number of elements of the array by
10119 the size of each element).
10120
10121 The simplest case is when we have an array of a constrained element
10122 type. For instance, consider the following type declarations:
10123
10124 type Bounded_String (Max_Size : Integer) is
10125 Length : Integer;
10126 Buffer : String (1 .. Max_Size);
10127 end record;
10128 type Bounded_String_Array is array (1 ..2) of Bounded_String (80);
10129
10130 In this case, the compiler describes the array as an array of
10131 variable-size elements (identified by its XVS suffix) for which
10132 the size can be read in the parallel XVZ variable.
10133
10134 In the case of an array of an unconstrained element type, the compiler
10135 wraps the array element inside a private PAD type. This type should not
10136 be shown to the user, and must be "unwrap"'ed before printing. Note
10137 that we also use the adjective "aligner" in our code to designate
10138 these wrapper types.
10139
10140 In some cases, the size allocated for each element is statically
10141 known. In that case, the PAD type already has the correct size,
10142 and the array element should remain unfixed.
10143
10144 But there are cases when this size is not statically known.
10145 For instance, assuming that "Five" is an integer variable:
10146
10147 type Dynamic is array (1 .. Five) of Integer;
10148 type Wrapper (Has_Length : Boolean := False) is record
10149 Data : Dynamic;
10150 case Has_Length is
10151 when True => Length : Integer;
10152 when False => null;
10153 end case;
10154 end record;
10155 type Wrapper_Array is array (1 .. 2) of Wrapper;
10156
10157 Hello : Wrapper_Array := (others => (Has_Length => True,
10158 Data => (others => 17),
10159 Length => 1));
10160
10161
10162 The debugging info would describe variable Hello as being an
10163 array of a PAD type. The size of that PAD type is not statically
10164 known, but can be determined using a parallel XVZ variable.
10165 In that case, a copy of the PAD type with the correct size should
10166 be used for the fixed array.
10167
10168 3. ``Fixing'' record type objects:
10169 ----------------------------------
10170
10171 Things are slightly different from arrays in the case of dynamic
10172 record types. In this case, in order to compute the associated
10173 fixed type, we need to determine the size and offset of each of
10174 its components. This, in turn, requires us to compute the fixed
10175 type of each of these components.
10176
10177 Consider for instance the example:
10178
10179 type Bounded_String (Max_Size : Natural) is record
10180 Str : String (1 .. Max_Size);
10181 Length : Natural;
10182 end record;
10183 My_String : Bounded_String (Max_Size => 10);
10184
10185 In that case, the position of field "Length" depends on the size
10186 of field Str, which itself depends on the value of the Max_Size
10187 discriminant. In order to fix the type of variable My_String,
10188 we need to fix the type of field Str. Therefore, fixing a variant
10189 record requires us to fix each of its components.
10190
10191 However, if a component does not have a dynamic size, the component
10192 should not be fixed. In particular, fields that use a PAD type
10193 should not fixed. Here is an example where this might happen
10194 (assuming type Rec above):
10195
10196 type Container (Big : Boolean) is record
10197 First : Rec;
10198 After : Integer;
10199 case Big is
10200 when True => Another : Integer;
10201 when False => null;
10202 end case;
10203 end record;
10204 My_Container : Container := (Big => False,
10205 First => (Empty => True),
10206 After => 42);
10207
10208 In that example, the compiler creates a PAD type for component First,
10209 whose size is constant, and then positions the component After just
10210 right after it. The offset of component After is therefore constant
10211 in this case.
10212
10213 The debugger computes the position of each field based on an algorithm
10214 that uses, among other things, the actual position and size of the field
10215 preceding it. Let's now imagine that the user is trying to print
10216 the value of My_Container. If the type fixing was recursive, we would
10217 end up computing the offset of field After based on the size of the
10218 fixed version of field First. And since in our example First has
10219 only one actual field, the size of the fixed type is actually smaller
10220 than the amount of space allocated to that field, and thus we would
10221 compute the wrong offset of field After.
10222
10223 To make things more complicated, we need to watch out for dynamic
10224 components of variant records (identified by the ___XVL suffix in
10225 the component name). Even if the target type is a PAD type, the size
10226 of that type might not be statically known. So the PAD type needs
10227 to be unwrapped and the resulting type needs to be fixed. Otherwise,
10228 we might end up with the wrong size for our component. This can be
10229 observed with the following type declarations:
10230
10231 type Octal is new Integer range 0 .. 7;
10232 type Octal_Array is array (Positive range <>) of Octal;
10233 pragma Pack (Octal_Array);
10234
10235 type Octal_Buffer (Size : Positive) is record
10236 Buffer : Octal_Array (1 .. Size);
10237 Length : Integer;
10238 end record;
10239
10240 In that case, Buffer is a PAD type whose size is unset and needs
10241 to be computed by fixing the unwrapped type.
10242
10243 4. When to ``Fix'' un-``Fixed'' sub-elements of an entity:
10244 ----------------------------------------------------------
10245
10246 Lastly, when should the sub-elements of an entity that remained unfixed
10247 thus far, be actually fixed?
10248
10249 The answer is: Only when referencing that element. For instance
10250 when selecting one component of a record, this specific component
10251 should be fixed at that point in time. Or when printing the value
10252 of a record, each component should be fixed before its value gets
10253 printed. Similarly for arrays, the element of the array should be
10254 fixed when printing each element of the array, or when extracting
10255 one element out of that array. On the other hand, fixing should
10256 not be performed on the elements when taking a slice of an array!
10257
10258 Note that one of the side effects of miscomputing the offset and
10259 size of each field is that we end up also miscomputing the size
10260 of the containing type. This can have adverse results when computing
10261 the value of an entity. GDB fetches the value of an entity based
10262 on the size of its type, and thus a wrong size causes GDB to fetch
10263 the wrong amount of memory. In the case where the computed size is
10264 too small, GDB fetches too little data to print the value of our
10265 entity. Results in this case are unpredictable, as we usually read
10266 past the buffer containing the data =:-o. */
10267
10268 /* Evaluate a subexpression of EXP, at index *POS, and return a value
10269 for that subexpression cast to TO_TYPE. Advance *POS over the
10270 subexpression. */
10271
10272 static value *
10273 ada_evaluate_subexp_for_cast (expression *exp, int *pos,
10274 enum noside noside, struct type *to_type)
10275 {
10276 int pc = *pos;
10277
10278 if (exp->elts[pc].opcode == OP_VAR_MSYM_VALUE
10279 || exp->elts[pc].opcode == OP_VAR_VALUE)
10280 {
10281 (*pos) += 4;
10282
10283 value *val;
10284 if (exp->elts[pc].opcode == OP_VAR_MSYM_VALUE)
10285 {
10286 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10287 return value_zero (to_type, not_lval);
10288
10289 val = evaluate_var_msym_value (noside,
10290 exp->elts[pc + 1].objfile,
10291 exp->elts[pc + 2].msymbol);
10292 }
10293 else
10294 val = evaluate_var_value (noside,
10295 exp->elts[pc + 1].block,
10296 exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol);
10297
10298 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10299 return eval_skip_value (exp);
10300
10301 val = ada_value_cast (to_type, val);
10302
10303 /* Follow the Ada language semantics that do not allow taking
10304 an address of the result of a cast (view conversion in Ada). */
10305 if (VALUE_LVAL (val) == lval_memory)
10306 {
10307 if (value_lazy (val))
10308 value_fetch_lazy (val);
10309 VALUE_LVAL (val) = not_lval;
10310 }
10311 return val;
10312 }
10313
10314 value *val = evaluate_subexp (to_type, exp, pos, noside);
10315 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10316 return eval_skip_value (exp);
10317 return ada_value_cast (to_type, val);
10318 }
10319
10320 /* Implement the evaluate_exp routine in the exp_descriptor structure
10321 for the Ada language. */
10322
10323 static struct value *
10324 ada_evaluate_subexp (struct type *expect_type, struct expression *exp,
10325 int *pos, enum noside noside)
10326 {
10327 enum exp_opcode op;
10328 int tem;
10329 int pc;
10330 int preeval_pos;
10331 struct value *arg1 = NULL, *arg2 = NULL, *arg3;
10332 struct type *type;
10333 int nargs, oplen;
10334 struct value **argvec;
10335
10336 pc = *pos;
10337 *pos += 1;
10338 op = exp->elts[pc].opcode;
10339
10340 switch (op)
10341 {
10342 default:
10343 *pos -= 1;
10344 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
10345
10346 if (noside == EVAL_NORMAL)
10347 arg1 = unwrap_value (arg1);
10348
10349 /* If evaluating an OP_FLOAT and an EXPECT_TYPE was provided,
10350 then we need to perform the conversion manually, because
10351 evaluate_subexp_standard doesn't do it. This conversion is
10352 necessary in Ada because the different kinds of float/fixed
10353 types in Ada have different representations.
10354
10355 Similarly, we need to perform the conversion from OP_LONG
10356 ourselves. */
10357 if ((op == OP_FLOAT || op == OP_LONG) && expect_type != NULL)
10358 arg1 = ada_value_cast (expect_type, arg1);
10359
10360 return arg1;
10361
10362 case OP_STRING:
10363 {
10364 struct value *result;
10365
10366 *pos -= 1;
10367 result = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
10368 /* The result type will have code OP_STRING, bashed there from
10369 OP_ARRAY. Bash it back. */
10370 if (value_type (result)->code () == TYPE_CODE_STRING)
10371 value_type (result)->set_code (TYPE_CODE_ARRAY);
10372 return result;
10373 }
10374
10375 case UNOP_CAST:
10376 (*pos) += 2;
10377 type = exp->elts[pc + 1].type;
10378 return ada_evaluate_subexp_for_cast (exp, pos, noside, type);
10379
10380 case UNOP_QUAL:
10381 (*pos) += 2;
10382 type = exp->elts[pc + 1].type;
10383 return ada_evaluate_subexp (type, exp, pos, noside);
10384
10385 case BINOP_ASSIGN:
10386 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10387 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_AGGREGATE)
10388 {
10389 arg1 = assign_aggregate (arg1, arg1, exp, pos, noside);
10390 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP || noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10391 return arg1;
10392 return ada_value_assign (arg1, arg1);
10393 }
10394 /* Force the evaluation of the rhs ARG2 to the type of the lhs ARG1,
10395 except if the lhs of our assignment is a convenience variable.
10396 In the case of assigning to a convenience variable, the lhs
10397 should be exactly the result of the evaluation of the rhs. */
10398 type = value_type (arg1);
10399 if (VALUE_LVAL (arg1) == lval_internalvar)
10400 type = NULL;
10401 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (type, exp, pos, noside);
10402 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP || noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10403 return arg1;
10404 if (VALUE_LVAL (arg1) == lval_internalvar)
10405 {
10406 /* Nothing. */
10407 }
10408 else if (ada_is_gnat_encoded_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1)))
10409 arg2 = cast_to_fixed (value_type (arg1), arg2);
10410 else if (ada_is_gnat_encoded_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
10411 error
10412 (_("Fixed-point values must be assigned to fixed-point variables"));
10413 else
10414 arg2 = coerce_for_assign (value_type (arg1), arg2);
10415 return ada_value_assign (arg1, arg2);
10416
10417 case BINOP_ADD:
10418 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
10419 arg2 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
10420 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10421 goto nosideret;
10422 if (value_type (arg1)->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
10423 return (value_from_longest
10424 (value_type (arg1),
10425 value_as_long (arg1) + value_as_long (arg2)));
10426 if (value_type (arg2)->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
10427 return (value_from_longest
10428 (value_type (arg2),
10429 value_as_long (arg1) + value_as_long (arg2)));
10430 if ((ada_is_gnat_encoded_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1))
10431 || ada_is_gnat_encoded_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
10432 && value_type (arg1) != value_type (arg2))
10433 error (_("Operands of fixed-point addition must have the same type"));
10434 /* Do the addition, and cast the result to the type of the first
10435 argument. We cannot cast the result to a reference type, so if
10436 ARG1 is a reference type, find its underlying type. */
10437 type = value_type (arg1);
10438 while (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_REF)
10439 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
10440 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
10441 return value_cast (type, value_binop (arg1, arg2, BINOP_ADD));
10442
10443 case BINOP_SUB:
10444 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
10445 arg2 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
10446 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10447 goto nosideret;
10448 if (value_type (arg1)->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
10449 return (value_from_longest
10450 (value_type (arg1),
10451 value_as_long (arg1) - value_as_long (arg2)));
10452 if (value_type (arg2)->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
10453 return (value_from_longest
10454 (value_type (arg2),
10455 value_as_long (arg1) - value_as_long (arg2)));
10456 if ((ada_is_gnat_encoded_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1))
10457 || ada_is_gnat_encoded_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
10458 && value_type (arg1) != value_type (arg2))
10459 error (_("Operands of fixed-point subtraction "
10460 "must have the same type"));
10461 /* Do the substraction, and cast the result to the type of the first
10462 argument. We cannot cast the result to a reference type, so if
10463 ARG1 is a reference type, find its underlying type. */
10464 type = value_type (arg1);
10465 while (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_REF)
10466 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
10467 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
10468 return value_cast (type, value_binop (arg1, arg2, BINOP_SUB));
10469
10470 case BINOP_MUL:
10471 case BINOP_DIV:
10472 case BINOP_REM:
10473 case BINOP_MOD:
10474 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10475 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10476 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10477 goto nosideret;
10478 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10479 {
10480 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
10481 return value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval);
10482 }
10483 else
10484 {
10485 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_double;
10486 if (ada_is_gnat_encoded_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1)))
10487 arg1 = cast_from_fixed (type, arg1);
10488 if (ada_is_gnat_encoded_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
10489 arg2 = cast_from_fixed (type, arg2);
10490 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
10491 return ada_value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
10492 }
10493
10494 case BINOP_EQUAL:
10495 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
10496 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10497 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (value_type (arg1), exp, pos, noside);
10498 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10499 goto nosideret;
10500 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10501 tem = 0;
10502 else
10503 {
10504 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
10505 tem = ada_value_equal (arg1, arg2);
10506 }
10507 if (op == BINOP_NOTEQUAL)
10508 tem = !tem;
10509 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
10510 return value_from_longest (type, (LONGEST) tem);
10511
10512 case UNOP_NEG:
10513 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10514 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10515 goto nosideret;
10516 else if (ada_is_gnat_encoded_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1)))
10517 return value_cast (value_type (arg1), value_neg (arg1));
10518 else
10519 {
10520 unop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1);
10521 return value_neg (arg1);
10522 }
10523
10524 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND:
10525 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR:
10526 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
10527 {
10528 struct value *val;
10529
10530 *pos -= 1;
10531 val = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
10532 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
10533 return value_cast (type, val);
10534 }
10535
10536 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
10537 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
10538 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
10539 {
10540 struct value *val;
10541
10542 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS);
10543 *pos = pc;
10544 val = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
10545
10546 return value_cast (value_type (arg1), val);
10547 }
10548
10549 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
10550 *pos -= 1;
10551
10552 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10553 {
10554 *pos += 4;
10555 goto nosideret;
10556 }
10557
10558 if (SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
10559 /* Only encountered when an unresolved symbol occurs in a
10560 context other than a function call, in which case, it is
10561 invalid. */
10562 error (_("Unexpected unresolved symbol, %s, during evaluation"),
10563 exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol->print_name ());
10564
10565 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10566 {
10567 type = static_unwrap_type (SYMBOL_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol));
10568 /* Check to see if this is a tagged type. We also need to handle
10569 the case where the type is a reference to a tagged type, but
10570 we have to be careful to exclude pointers to tagged types.
10571 The latter should be shown as usual (as a pointer), whereas
10572 a reference should mostly be transparent to the user. */
10573 if (ada_is_tagged_type (type, 0)
10574 || (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_REF
10575 && ada_is_tagged_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), 0)))
10576 {
10577 /* Tagged types are a little special in the fact that the real
10578 type is dynamic and can only be determined by inspecting the
10579 object's tag. This means that we need to get the object's
10580 value first (EVAL_NORMAL) and then extract the actual object
10581 type from its tag.
10582
10583 Note that we cannot skip the final step where we extract
10584 the object type from its tag, because the EVAL_NORMAL phase
10585 results in dynamic components being resolved into fixed ones.
10586 This can cause problems when trying to print the type
10587 description of tagged types whose parent has a dynamic size:
10588 We use the type name of the "_parent" component in order
10589 to print the name of the ancestor type in the type description.
10590 If that component had a dynamic size, the resolution into
10591 a fixed type would result in the loss of that type name,
10592 thus preventing us from printing the name of the ancestor
10593 type in the type description. */
10594 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_NORMAL);
10595
10596 if (type->code () != TYPE_CODE_REF)
10597 {
10598 struct type *actual_type;
10599
10600 actual_type = type_from_tag (ada_value_tag (arg1));
10601 if (actual_type == NULL)
10602 /* If, for some reason, we were unable to determine
10603 the actual type from the tag, then use the static
10604 approximation that we just computed as a fallback.
10605 This can happen if the debugging information is
10606 incomplete, for instance. */
10607 actual_type = type;
10608 return value_zero (actual_type, not_lval);
10609 }
10610 else
10611 {
10612 /* In the case of a ref, ada_coerce_ref takes care
10613 of determining the actual type. But the evaluation
10614 should return a ref as it should be valid to ask
10615 for its address; so rebuild a ref after coerce. */
10616 arg1 = ada_coerce_ref (arg1);
10617 return value_ref (arg1, TYPE_CODE_REF);
10618 }
10619 }
10620
10621 /* Records and unions for which GNAT encodings have been
10622 generated need to be statically fixed as well.
10623 Otherwise, non-static fixing produces a type where
10624 all dynamic properties are removed, which prevents "ptype"
10625 from being able to completely describe the type.
10626 For instance, a case statement in a variant record would be
10627 replaced by the relevant components based on the actual
10628 value of the discriminants. */
10629 if ((type->code () == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
10630 && dynamic_template_type (type) != NULL)
10631 || (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_UNION
10632 && ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XVU") != NULL))
10633 {
10634 *pos += 4;
10635 return value_zero (to_static_fixed_type (type), not_lval);
10636 }
10637 }
10638
10639 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
10640 return ada_to_fixed_value (arg1);
10641
10642 case OP_FUNCALL:
10643 (*pos) += 2;
10644
10645 /* Allocate arg vector, including space for the function to be
10646 called in argvec[0] and a terminating NULL. */
10647 nargs = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
10648 argvec = XALLOCAVEC (struct value *, nargs + 2);
10649
10650 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_VAR_VALUE
10651 && SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
10652 error (_("Unexpected unresolved symbol, %s, during evaluation"),
10653 exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol->print_name ());
10654 else
10655 {
10656 for (tem = 0; tem <= nargs; tem += 1)
10657 argvec[tem] = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10658 argvec[tem] = 0;
10659
10660 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10661 goto nosideret;
10662 }
10663
10664 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type
10665 (desc_base_type (value_type (argvec[0]))))
10666 argvec[0] = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (argvec[0]);
10667 else if (value_type (argvec[0])->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
10668 && TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (value_type (argvec[0]), 0) != 0)
10669 /* This is a packed array that has already been fixed, and
10670 therefore already coerced to a simple array. Nothing further
10671 to do. */
10672 ;
10673 else if (value_type (argvec[0])->code () == TYPE_CODE_REF)
10674 {
10675 /* Make sure we dereference references so that all the code below
10676 feels like it's really handling the referenced value. Wrapping
10677 types (for alignment) may be there, so make sure we strip them as
10678 well. */
10679 argvec[0] = ada_to_fixed_value (coerce_ref (argvec[0]));
10680 }
10681 else if (value_type (argvec[0])->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
10682 && VALUE_LVAL (argvec[0]) == lval_memory)
10683 argvec[0] = value_addr (argvec[0]);
10684
10685 type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (argvec[0]));
10686
10687 /* Ada allows us to implicitly dereference arrays when subscripting
10688 them. So, if this is an array typedef (encoding use for array
10689 access types encoded as fat pointers), strip it now. */
10690 if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
10691 type = ada_typedef_target_type (type);
10692
10693 if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
10694 {
10695 switch (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type))->code ())
10696 {
10697 case TYPE_CODE_FUNC:
10698 type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
10699 break;
10700 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
10701 break;
10702 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
10703 if (noside != EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10704 argvec[0] = ada_value_ind (argvec[0]);
10705 type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
10706 break;
10707 default:
10708 error (_("cannot subscript or call something of type `%s'"),
10709 ada_type_name (value_type (argvec[0])));
10710 break;
10711 }
10712 }
10713
10714 switch (type->code ())
10715 {
10716 case TYPE_CODE_FUNC:
10717 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10718 {
10719 if (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) == NULL)
10720 error_call_unknown_return_type (NULL);
10721 return allocate_value (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
10722 }
10723 return call_function_by_hand (argvec[0], NULL,
10724 gdb::make_array_view (argvec + 1,
10725 nargs));
10726 case TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION:
10727 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10728 /* We don't know anything about what the internal
10729 function might return, but we have to return
10730 something. */
10731 return value_zero (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int,
10732 not_lval);
10733 else
10734 return call_internal_function (exp->gdbarch, exp->language_defn,
10735 argvec[0], nargs, argvec + 1);
10736
10737 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
10738 {
10739 int arity;
10740
10741 arity = ada_array_arity (type);
10742 type = ada_array_element_type (type, nargs);
10743 if (type == NULL)
10744 error (_("cannot subscript or call a record"));
10745 if (arity != nargs)
10746 error (_("wrong number of subscripts; expecting %d"), arity);
10747 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10748 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
10749 return
10750 unwrap_value (ada_value_subscript
10751 (argvec[0], nargs, argvec + 1));
10752 }
10753 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
10754 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10755 {
10756 type = ada_array_element_type (type, nargs);
10757 if (type == NULL)
10758 error (_("element type of array unknown"));
10759 else
10760 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
10761 }
10762 return
10763 unwrap_value (ada_value_subscript
10764 (ada_coerce_to_simple_array (argvec[0]),
10765 nargs, argvec + 1));
10766 case TYPE_CODE_PTR: /* Pointer to array */
10767 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10768 {
10769 type = to_fixed_array_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), NULL, 1);
10770 type = ada_array_element_type (type, nargs);
10771 if (type == NULL)
10772 error (_("element type of array unknown"));
10773 else
10774 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
10775 }
10776 return
10777 unwrap_value (ada_value_ptr_subscript (argvec[0],
10778 nargs, argvec + 1));
10779
10780 default:
10781 error (_("Attempt to index or call something other than an "
10782 "array or function"));
10783 }
10784
10785 case TERNOP_SLICE:
10786 {
10787 struct value *array = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10788 struct value *low_bound_val =
10789 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10790 struct value *high_bound_val =
10791 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10792 LONGEST low_bound;
10793 LONGEST high_bound;
10794
10795 low_bound_val = coerce_ref (low_bound_val);
10796 high_bound_val = coerce_ref (high_bound_val);
10797 low_bound = value_as_long (low_bound_val);
10798 high_bound = value_as_long (high_bound_val);
10799
10800 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10801 goto nosideret;
10802
10803 /* If this is a reference to an aligner type, then remove all
10804 the aligners. */
10805 if (value_type (array)->code () == TYPE_CODE_REF
10806 && ada_is_aligner_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array))))
10807 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array)) =
10808 ada_aligned_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array)));
10809
10810 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (array)))
10811 error (_("cannot slice a packed array"));
10812
10813 /* If this is a reference to an array or an array lvalue,
10814 convert to a pointer. */
10815 if (value_type (array)->code () == TYPE_CODE_REF
10816 || (value_type (array)->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
10817 && VALUE_LVAL (array) == lval_memory))
10818 array = value_addr (array);
10819
10820 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS
10821 && ada_is_array_descriptor_type (ada_check_typedef
10822 (value_type (array))))
10823 return empty_array (ada_type_of_array (array, 0), low_bound,
10824 high_bound);
10825
10826 array = ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (array);
10827
10828 /* If we have more than one level of pointer indirection,
10829 dereference the value until we get only one level. */
10830 while (value_type (array)->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR
10831 && (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array))->code ()
10832 == TYPE_CODE_PTR))
10833 array = value_ind (array);
10834
10835 /* Make sure we really do have an array type before going further,
10836 to avoid a SEGV when trying to get the index type or the target
10837 type later down the road if the debug info generated by
10838 the compiler is incorrect or incomplete. */
10839 if (!ada_is_simple_array_type (value_type (array)))
10840 error (_("cannot take slice of non-array"));
10841
10842 if (ada_check_typedef (value_type (array))->code ()
10843 == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
10844 {
10845 struct type *type0 = ada_check_typedef (value_type (array));
10846
10847 if (high_bound < low_bound || noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10848 return empty_array (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0), low_bound, high_bound);
10849 else
10850 {
10851 struct type *arr_type0 =
10852 to_fixed_array_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0), NULL, 1);
10853
10854 return ada_value_slice_from_ptr (array, arr_type0,
10855 longest_to_int (low_bound),
10856 longest_to_int (high_bound));
10857 }
10858 }
10859 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10860 return array;
10861 else if (high_bound < low_bound)
10862 return empty_array (value_type (array), low_bound, high_bound);
10863 else
10864 return ada_value_slice (array, longest_to_int (low_bound),
10865 longest_to_int (high_bound));
10866 }
10867
10868 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
10869 (*pos) += 2;
10870 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10871 type = check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 1].type);
10872
10873 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10874 goto nosideret;
10875
10876 switch (type->code ())
10877 {
10878 default:
10879 lim_warning (_("Membership test incompletely implemented; "
10880 "always returns true"));
10881 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
10882 return value_from_longest (type, (LONGEST) 1);
10883
10884 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
10885 arg2 = value_from_longest (type, TYPE_LOW_BOUND (type));
10886 arg3 = value_from_longest (type, TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (type));
10887 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
10888 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg3);
10889 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
10890 return
10891 value_from_longest (type,
10892 (value_less (arg1, arg3)
10893 || value_equal (arg1, arg3))
10894 && (value_less (arg2, arg1)
10895 || value_equal (arg2, arg1)));
10896 }
10897
10898 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
10899 (*pos) += 2;
10900 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10901 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10902
10903 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10904 goto nosideret;
10905
10906 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10907 {
10908 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
10909 return value_zero (type, not_lval);
10910 }
10911
10912 tem = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
10913
10914 type = ada_index_type (value_type (arg2), tem, "range");
10915 if (!type)
10916 type = value_type (arg1);
10917
10918 arg3 = value_from_longest (type, ada_array_bound (arg2, tem, 1));
10919 arg2 = value_from_longest (type, ada_array_bound (arg2, tem, 0));
10920
10921 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
10922 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg3);
10923 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
10924 return
10925 value_from_longest (type,
10926 (value_less (arg1, arg3)
10927 || value_equal (arg1, arg3))
10928 && (value_less (arg2, arg1)
10929 || value_equal (arg2, arg1)));
10930
10931 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
10932 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10933 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10934 arg3 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10935
10936 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10937 goto nosideret;
10938
10939 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
10940 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg3);
10941 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
10942 return
10943 value_from_longest (type,
10944 (value_less (arg1, arg3)
10945 || value_equal (arg1, arg3))
10946 && (value_less (arg2, arg1)
10947 || value_equal (arg2, arg1)));
10948
10949 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
10950 case OP_ATR_LAST:
10951 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
10952 {
10953 struct type *type_arg;
10954
10955 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_TYPE)
10956 {
10957 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
10958 arg1 = NULL;
10959 type_arg = check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 2].type);
10960 }
10961 else
10962 {
10963 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10964 type_arg = NULL;
10965 }
10966
10967 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode != OP_LONG)
10968 error (_("Invalid operand to '%s"), ada_attribute_name (op));
10969 tem = longest_to_int (exp->elts[*pos + 2].longconst);
10970 *pos += 4;
10971
10972 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10973 goto nosideret;
10974 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10975 {
10976 if (type_arg == NULL)
10977 type_arg = value_type (arg1);
10978
10979 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type_arg))
10980 type_arg = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (type_arg);
10981
10982 if (!discrete_type_p (type_arg))
10983 {
10984 switch (op)
10985 {
10986 default: /* Should never happen. */
10987 error (_("unexpected attribute encountered"));
10988 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
10989 case OP_ATR_LAST:
10990 type_arg = ada_index_type (type_arg, tem,
10991 ada_attribute_name (op));
10992 break;
10993 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
10994 type_arg = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
10995 break;
10996 }
10997 }
10998
10999 return value_zero (type_arg, not_lval);
11000 }
11001 else if (type_arg == NULL)
11002 {
11003 arg1 = ada_coerce_ref (arg1);
11004
11005 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arg1)))
11006 arg1 = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg1);
11007
11008 if (op == OP_ATR_LENGTH)
11009 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
11010 else
11011 {
11012 type = ada_index_type (value_type (arg1), tem,
11013 ada_attribute_name (op));
11014 if (type == NULL)
11015 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
11016 }
11017
11018 switch (op)
11019 {
11020 default: /* Should never happen. */
11021 error (_("unexpected attribute encountered"));
11022 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
11023 return value_from_longest
11024 (type, ada_array_bound (arg1, tem, 0));
11025 case OP_ATR_LAST:
11026 return value_from_longest
11027 (type, ada_array_bound (arg1, tem, 1));
11028 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
11029 return value_from_longest
11030 (type, ada_array_length (arg1, tem));
11031 }
11032 }
11033 else if (discrete_type_p (type_arg))
11034 {
11035 struct type *range_type;
11036 const char *name = ada_type_name (type_arg);
11037
11038 range_type = NULL;
11039 if (name != NULL && type_arg->code () != TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
11040 range_type = to_fixed_range_type (type_arg, NULL);
11041 if (range_type == NULL)
11042 range_type = type_arg;
11043 switch (op)
11044 {
11045 default:
11046 error (_("unexpected attribute encountered"));
11047 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
11048 return value_from_longest
11049 (range_type, ada_discrete_type_low_bound (range_type));
11050 case OP_ATR_LAST:
11051 return value_from_longest
11052 (range_type, ada_discrete_type_high_bound (range_type));
11053 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
11054 error (_("the 'length attribute applies only to array types"));
11055 }
11056 }
11057 else if (type_arg->code () == TYPE_CODE_FLT)
11058 error (_("unimplemented type attribute"));
11059 else
11060 {
11061 LONGEST low, high;
11062
11063 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type_arg))
11064 type_arg = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (type_arg);
11065
11066 if (op == OP_ATR_LENGTH)
11067 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
11068 else
11069 {
11070 type = ada_index_type (type_arg, tem, ada_attribute_name (op));
11071 if (type == NULL)
11072 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
11073 }
11074
11075 switch (op)
11076 {
11077 default:
11078 error (_("unexpected attribute encountered"));
11079 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
11080 low = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 0);
11081 return value_from_longest (type, low);
11082 case OP_ATR_LAST:
11083 high = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 1);
11084 return value_from_longest (type, high);
11085 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
11086 low = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 0);
11087 high = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 1);
11088 return value_from_longest (type, high - low + 1);
11089 }
11090 }
11091 }
11092
11093 case OP_ATR_TAG:
11094 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
11095 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11096 goto nosideret;
11097
11098 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
11099 return value_zero (ada_tag_type (arg1), not_lval);
11100
11101 return ada_value_tag (arg1);
11102
11103 case OP_ATR_MIN:
11104 case OP_ATR_MAX:
11105 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
11106 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
11107 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
11108 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11109 goto nosideret;
11110 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
11111 return value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval);
11112 else
11113 {
11114 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
11115 return value_binop (arg1, arg2,
11116 op == OP_ATR_MIN ? BINOP_MIN : BINOP_MAX);
11117 }
11118
11119 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
11120 {
11121 struct type *type_arg = check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 2].type);
11122
11123 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
11124 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11125 goto nosideret;
11126
11127 if (!ada_is_modular_type (type_arg))
11128 error (_("'modulus must be applied to modular type"));
11129
11130 return value_from_longest (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type_arg),
11131 ada_modulus (type_arg));
11132 }
11133
11134
11135 case OP_ATR_POS:
11136 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
11137 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
11138 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11139 goto nosideret;
11140 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
11141 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
11142 return value_zero (type, not_lval);
11143 else
11144 return value_pos_atr (type, arg1);
11145
11146 case OP_ATR_SIZE:
11147 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
11148 type = value_type (arg1);
11149
11150 /* If the argument is a reference, then dereference its type, since
11151 the user is really asking for the size of the actual object,
11152 not the size of the pointer. */
11153 if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_REF)
11154 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
11155
11156 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11157 goto nosideret;
11158 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
11159 return value_zero (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int, not_lval);
11160 else
11161 return value_from_longest (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int,
11162 TARGET_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (type));
11163
11164 case OP_ATR_VAL:
11165 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
11166 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
11167 type = exp->elts[pc + 2].type;
11168 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11169 goto nosideret;
11170 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
11171 return value_zero (type, not_lval);
11172 else
11173 return value_val_atr (type, arg1);
11174
11175 case BINOP_EXP:
11176 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
11177 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
11178 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11179 goto nosideret;
11180 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
11181 return value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval);
11182 else
11183 {
11184 /* For integer exponentiation operations,
11185 only promote the first argument. */
11186 if (is_integral_type (value_type (arg2)))
11187 unop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1);
11188 else
11189 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
11190
11191 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
11192 }
11193
11194 case UNOP_PLUS:
11195 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
11196 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11197 goto nosideret;
11198 else
11199 return arg1;
11200
11201 case UNOP_ABS:
11202 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
11203 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11204 goto nosideret;
11205 unop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1);
11206 if (value_less (arg1, value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval)))
11207 return value_neg (arg1);
11208 else
11209 return arg1;
11210
11211 case UNOP_IND:
11212 preeval_pos = *pos;
11213 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
11214 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11215 goto nosideret;
11216 type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg1));
11217 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
11218 {
11219 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type))
11220 /* GDB allows dereferencing GNAT array descriptors. */
11221 {
11222 struct type *arrType = ada_type_of_array (arg1, 0);
11223
11224 if (arrType == NULL)
11225 error (_("Attempt to dereference null array pointer."));
11226 return value_at_lazy (arrType, 0);
11227 }
11228 else if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR
11229 || type->code () == TYPE_CODE_REF
11230 /* In C you can dereference an array to get the 1st elt. */
11231 || type->code () == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
11232 {
11233 /* As mentioned in the OP_VAR_VALUE case, tagged types can
11234 only be determined by inspecting the object's tag.
11235 This means that we need to evaluate completely the
11236 expression in order to get its type. */
11237
11238 if ((type->code () == TYPE_CODE_REF
11239 || type->code () == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
11240 && ada_is_tagged_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), 0))
11241 {
11242 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, &preeval_pos,
11243 EVAL_NORMAL);
11244 type = value_type (ada_value_ind (arg1));
11245 }
11246 else
11247 {
11248 type = to_static_fixed_type
11249 (ada_aligned_type
11250 (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type))));
11251 }
11252 ada_ensure_varsize_limit (type);
11253 return value_zero (type, lval_memory);
11254 }
11255 else if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_INT)
11256 {
11257 /* GDB allows dereferencing an int. */
11258 if (expect_type == NULL)
11259 return value_zero (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int,
11260 lval_memory);
11261 else
11262 {
11263 expect_type =
11264 to_static_fixed_type (ada_aligned_type (expect_type));
11265 return value_zero (expect_type, lval_memory);
11266 }
11267 }
11268 else
11269 error (_("Attempt to take contents of a non-pointer value."));
11270 }
11271 arg1 = ada_coerce_ref (arg1); /* FIXME: What is this for?? */
11272 type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg1));
11273
11274 if (type->code () == TYPE_CODE_INT)
11275 /* GDB allows dereferencing an int. If we were given
11276 the expect_type, then use that as the target type.
11277 Otherwise, assume that the target type is an int. */
11278 {
11279 if (expect_type != NULL)
11280 return ada_value_ind (value_cast (lookup_pointer_type (expect_type),
11281 arg1));
11282 else
11283 return value_at_lazy (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int,
11284 (CORE_ADDR) value_as_address (arg1));
11285 }
11286
11287 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type))
11288 /* GDB allows dereferencing GNAT array descriptors. */
11289 return ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg1);
11290 else
11291 return ada_value_ind (arg1);
11292
11293 case STRUCTOP_STRUCT:
11294 tem = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
11295 (*pos) += 3 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (tem + 1);
11296 preeval_pos = *pos;
11297 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
11298 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11299 goto nosideret;
11300 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
11301 {
11302 struct type *type1 = value_type (arg1);
11303
11304 if (ada_is_tagged_type (type1, 1))
11305 {
11306 type = ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (type1,
11307 &exp->elts[pc + 2].string,
11308 1, 1);
11309
11310 /* If the field is not found, check if it exists in the
11311 extension of this object's type. This means that we
11312 need to evaluate completely the expression. */
11313
11314 if (type == NULL)
11315 {
11316 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, &preeval_pos,
11317 EVAL_NORMAL);
11318 arg1 = ada_value_struct_elt (arg1,
11319 &exp->elts[pc + 2].string,
11320 0);
11321 arg1 = unwrap_value (arg1);
11322 type = value_type (ada_to_fixed_value (arg1));
11323 }
11324 }
11325 else
11326 type =
11327 ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (type1, &exp->elts[pc + 2].string, 1,
11328 0);
11329
11330 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
11331 }
11332 else
11333 {
11334 arg1 = ada_value_struct_elt (arg1, &exp->elts[pc + 2].string, 0);
11335 arg1 = unwrap_value (arg1);
11336 return ada_to_fixed_value (arg1);
11337 }
11338
11339 case OP_TYPE:
11340 /* The value is not supposed to be used. This is here to make it
11341 easier to accommodate expressions that contain types. */
11342 (*pos) += 2;
11343 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11344 goto nosideret;
11345 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
11346 return allocate_value (exp->elts[pc + 1].type);
11347 else
11348 error (_("Attempt to use a type name as an expression"));
11349
11350 case OP_AGGREGATE:
11351 case OP_CHOICES:
11352 case OP_OTHERS:
11353 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
11354 case OP_POSITIONAL:
11355 case OP_NAME:
11356 if (noside == EVAL_NORMAL)
11357 switch (op)
11358 {
11359 case OP_NAME:
11360 error (_("Undefined name, ambiguous name, or renaming used in "
11361 "component association: %s."), &exp->elts[pc+2].string);
11362 case OP_AGGREGATE:
11363 error (_("Aggregates only allowed on the right of an assignment"));
11364 default:
11365 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
11366 _("aggregate apparently mangled"));
11367 }
11368
11369 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, pc, &oplen, &nargs);
11370 *pos += oplen - 1;
11371 for (tem = 0; tem < nargs; tem += 1)
11372 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, noside);
11373 goto nosideret;
11374 }
11375
11376 nosideret:
11377 return eval_skip_value (exp);
11378 }
11379 \f
11380
11381 /* Fixed point */
11382
11383 /* If TYPE encodes an Ada fixed-point type, return the suffix of the
11384 type name that encodes the 'small and 'delta information.
11385 Otherwise, return NULL. */
11386
11387 static const char *
11388 gnat_encoded_fixed_type_info (struct type *type)
11389 {
11390 const char *name = ada_type_name (type);
11391 enum type_code code = (type == NULL) ? TYPE_CODE_UNDEF : type->code ();
11392
11393 if ((code == TYPE_CODE_INT || code == TYPE_CODE_RANGE) && name != NULL)
11394 {
11395 const char *tail = strstr (name, "___XF_");
11396
11397 if (tail == NULL)
11398 return NULL;
11399 else
11400 return tail + 5;
11401 }
11402 else if (code == TYPE_CODE_RANGE && TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) != type)
11403 return gnat_encoded_fixed_type_info (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
11404 else
11405 return NULL;
11406 }
11407
11408 /* Returns non-zero iff TYPE represents an Ada fixed-point type. */
11409
11410 int
11411 ada_is_gnat_encoded_fixed_point_type (struct type *type)
11412 {
11413 return gnat_encoded_fixed_type_info (type) != NULL;
11414 }
11415
11416 /* Return non-zero iff TYPE represents a System.Address type. */
11417
11418 int
11419 ada_is_system_address_type (struct type *type)
11420 {
11421 return (type->name () && strcmp (type->name (), "system__address") == 0);
11422 }
11423
11424 /* Assuming that TYPE is the representation of an Ada fixed-point
11425 type, return the target floating-point type to be used to represent
11426 of this type during internal computation. */
11427
11428 static struct type *
11429 ada_scaling_type (struct type *type)
11430 {
11431 return builtin_type (get_type_arch (type))->builtin_long_double;
11432 }
11433
11434 /* Assuming that TYPE is the representation of an Ada fixed-point
11435 type, return its delta, or NULL if the type is malformed and the
11436 delta cannot be determined. */
11437
11438 struct value *
11439 gnat_encoded_fixed_point_delta (struct type *type)
11440 {
11441 const char *encoding = gnat_encoded_fixed_type_info (type);
11442 struct type *scale_type = ada_scaling_type (type);
11443
11444 long long num, den;
11445
11446 if (sscanf (encoding, "_%lld_%lld", &num, &den) < 2)
11447 return nullptr;
11448 else
11449 return value_binop (value_from_longest (scale_type, num),
11450 value_from_longest (scale_type, den), BINOP_DIV);
11451 }
11452
11453 /* Assuming that ada_is_gnat_encoded_fixed_point_type (TYPE), return
11454 the scaling factor ('SMALL value) associated with the type. */
11455
11456 struct value *
11457 ada_scaling_factor (struct type *type)
11458 {
11459 const char *encoding = gnat_encoded_fixed_type_info (type);
11460 struct type *scale_type = ada_scaling_type (type);
11461
11462 long long num0, den0, num1, den1;
11463 int n;
11464
11465 n = sscanf (encoding, "_%lld_%lld_%lld_%lld",
11466 &num0, &den0, &num1, &den1);
11467
11468 if (n < 2)
11469 return value_from_longest (scale_type, 1);
11470 else if (n == 4)
11471 return value_binop (value_from_longest (scale_type, num1),
11472 value_from_longest (scale_type, den1), BINOP_DIV);
11473 else
11474 return value_binop (value_from_longest (scale_type, num0),
11475 value_from_longest (scale_type, den0), BINOP_DIV);
11476 }
11477
11478 \f
11479
11480 /* Range types */
11481
11482 /* Scan STR beginning at position K for a discriminant name, and
11483 return the value of that discriminant field of DVAL in *PX. If
11484 PNEW_K is not null, put the position of the character beyond the
11485 name scanned in *PNEW_K. Return 1 if successful; return 0 and do
11486 not alter *PX and *PNEW_K if unsuccessful. */
11487
11488 static int
11489 scan_discrim_bound (const char *str, int k, struct value *dval, LONGEST * px,
11490 int *pnew_k)
11491 {
11492 static char *bound_buffer = NULL;
11493 static size_t bound_buffer_len = 0;
11494 const char *pstart, *pend, *bound;
11495 struct value *bound_val;
11496
11497 if (dval == NULL || str == NULL || str[k] == '\0')
11498 return 0;
11499
11500 pstart = str + k;
11501 pend = strstr (pstart, "__");
11502 if (pend == NULL)
11503 {
11504 bound = pstart;
11505 k += strlen (bound);
11506 }
11507 else
11508 {
11509 int len = pend - pstart;
11510
11511 /* Strip __ and beyond. */
11512 GROW_VECT (bound_buffer, bound_buffer_len, len + 1);
11513 strncpy (bound_buffer, pstart, len);
11514 bound_buffer[len] = '\0';
11515
11516 bound = bound_buffer;
11517 k = pend - str;
11518 }
11519
11520 bound_val = ada_search_struct_field (bound, dval, 0, value_type (dval));
11521 if (bound_val == NULL)
11522 return 0;
11523
11524 *px = value_as_long (bound_val);
11525 if (pnew_k != NULL)
11526 *pnew_k = k;
11527 return 1;
11528 }
11529
11530 /* Value of variable named NAME in the current environment. If
11531 no such variable found, then if ERR_MSG is null, returns 0, and
11532 otherwise causes an error with message ERR_MSG. */
11533
11534 static struct value *
11535 get_var_value (const char *name, const char *err_msg)
11536 {
11537 lookup_name_info lookup_name (name, symbol_name_match_type::FULL);
11538
11539 std::vector<struct block_symbol> syms;
11540 int nsyms = ada_lookup_symbol_list_worker (lookup_name,
11541 get_selected_block (0),
11542 VAR_DOMAIN, &syms, 1);
11543
11544 if (nsyms != 1)
11545 {
11546 if (err_msg == NULL)
11547 return 0;
11548 else
11549 error (("%s"), err_msg);
11550 }
11551
11552 return value_of_variable (syms[0].symbol, syms[0].block);
11553 }
11554
11555 /* Value of integer variable named NAME in the current environment.
11556 If no such variable is found, returns false. Otherwise, sets VALUE
11557 to the variable's value and returns true. */
11558
11559 bool
11560 get_int_var_value (const char *name, LONGEST &value)
11561 {
11562 struct value *var_val = get_var_value (name, 0);
11563
11564 if (var_val == 0)
11565 return false;
11566
11567 value = value_as_long (var_val);
11568 return true;
11569 }
11570
11571
11572 /* Return a range type whose base type is that of the range type named
11573 NAME in the current environment, and whose bounds are calculated
11574 from NAME according to the GNAT range encoding conventions.
11575 Extract discriminant values, if needed, from DVAL. ORIG_TYPE is the
11576 corresponding range type from debug information; fall back to using it
11577 if symbol lookup fails. If a new type must be created, allocate it
11578 like ORIG_TYPE was. The bounds information, in general, is encoded
11579 in NAME, the base type given in the named range type. */
11580
11581 static struct type *
11582 to_fixed_range_type (struct type *raw_type, struct value *dval)
11583 {
11584 const char *name;
11585 struct type *base_type;
11586 const char *subtype_info;
11587
11588 gdb_assert (raw_type != NULL);
11589 gdb_assert (raw_type->name () != NULL);
11590
11591 if (raw_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_RANGE)
11592 base_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (raw_type);
11593 else
11594 base_type = raw_type;
11595
11596 name = raw_type->name ();
11597 subtype_info = strstr (name, "___XD");
11598 if (subtype_info == NULL)
11599 {
11600 LONGEST L = ada_discrete_type_low_bound (raw_type);
11601 LONGEST U = ada_discrete_type_high_bound (raw_type);
11602
11603 if (L < INT_MIN || U > INT_MAX)
11604 return raw_type;
11605 else
11606 return create_static_range_type (alloc_type_copy (raw_type), raw_type,
11607 L, U);
11608 }
11609 else
11610 {
11611 static char *name_buf = NULL;
11612 static size_t name_len = 0;
11613 int prefix_len = subtype_info - name;
11614 LONGEST L, U;
11615 struct type *type;
11616 const char *bounds_str;
11617 int n;
11618
11619 GROW_VECT (name_buf, name_len, prefix_len + 5);
11620 strncpy (name_buf, name, prefix_len);
11621 name_buf[prefix_len] = '\0';
11622
11623 subtype_info += 5;
11624 bounds_str = strchr (subtype_info, '_');
11625 n = 1;
11626
11627 if (*subtype_info == 'L')
11628 {
11629 if (!ada_scan_number (bounds_str, n, &L, &n)
11630 && !scan_discrim_bound (bounds_str, n, dval, &L, &n))
11631 return raw_type;
11632 if (bounds_str[n] == '_')
11633 n += 2;
11634 else if (bounds_str[n] == '.') /* FIXME? SGI Workshop kludge. */
11635 n += 1;
11636 subtype_info += 1;
11637 }
11638 else
11639 {
11640 strcpy (name_buf + prefix_len, "___L");
11641 if (!get_int_var_value (name_buf, L))
11642 {
11643 lim_warning (_("Unknown lower bound, using 1."));
11644 L = 1;
11645 }
11646 }
11647
11648 if (*subtype_info == 'U')
11649 {
11650 if (!ada_scan_number (bounds_str, n, &U, &n)
11651 && !scan_discrim_bound (bounds_str, n, dval, &U, &n))
11652 return raw_type;
11653 }
11654 else
11655 {
11656 strcpy (name_buf + prefix_len, "___U");
11657 if (!get_int_var_value (name_buf, U))
11658 {
11659 lim_warning (_("Unknown upper bound, using %ld."), (long) L);
11660 U = L;
11661 }
11662 }
11663
11664 type = create_static_range_type (alloc_type_copy (raw_type),
11665 base_type, L, U);
11666 /* create_static_range_type alters the resulting type's length
11667 to match the size of the base_type, which is not what we want.
11668 Set it back to the original range type's length. */
11669 TYPE_LENGTH (type) = TYPE_LENGTH (raw_type);
11670 type->set_name (name);
11671 return type;
11672 }
11673 }
11674
11675 /* True iff NAME is the name of a range type. */
11676
11677 int
11678 ada_is_range_type_name (const char *name)
11679 {
11680 return (name != NULL && strstr (name, "___XD"));
11681 }
11682 \f
11683
11684 /* Modular types */
11685
11686 /* True iff TYPE is an Ada modular type. */
11687
11688 int
11689 ada_is_modular_type (struct type *type)
11690 {
11691 struct type *subranged_type = get_base_type (type);
11692
11693 return (subranged_type != NULL && type->code () == TYPE_CODE_RANGE
11694 && subranged_type->code () == TYPE_CODE_INT
11695 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (subranged_type));
11696 }
11697
11698 /* Assuming ada_is_modular_type (TYPE), the modulus of TYPE. */
11699
11700 ULONGEST
11701 ada_modulus (struct type *type)
11702 {
11703 return (ULONGEST) TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (type) + 1;
11704 }
11705 \f
11706
11707 /* Ada exception catchpoint support:
11708 ---------------------------------
11709
11710 We support 3 kinds of exception catchpoints:
11711 . catchpoints on Ada exceptions
11712 . catchpoints on unhandled Ada exceptions
11713 . catchpoints on failed assertions
11714
11715 Exceptions raised during failed assertions, or unhandled exceptions
11716 could perfectly be caught with the general catchpoint on Ada exceptions.
11717 However, we can easily differentiate these two special cases, and having
11718 the option to distinguish these two cases from the rest can be useful
11719 to zero-in on certain situations.
11720
11721 Exception catchpoints are a specialized form of breakpoint,
11722 since they rely on inserting breakpoints inside known routines
11723 of the GNAT runtime. The implementation therefore uses a standard
11724 breakpoint structure of the BP_BREAKPOINT type, but with its own set
11725 of breakpoint_ops.
11726
11727 Support in the runtime for exception catchpoints have been changed
11728 a few times already, and these changes affect the implementation
11729 of these catchpoints. In order to be able to support several
11730 variants of the runtime, we use a sniffer that will determine
11731 the runtime variant used by the program being debugged. */
11732
11733 /* Ada's standard exceptions.
11734
11735 The Ada 83 standard also defined Numeric_Error. But there so many
11736 situations where it was unclear from the Ada 83 Reference Manual
11737 (RM) whether Constraint_Error or Numeric_Error should be raised,
11738 that the ARG (Ada Rapporteur Group) eventually issued a Binding
11739 Interpretation saying that anytime the RM says that Numeric_Error
11740 should be raised, the implementation may raise Constraint_Error.
11741 Ada 95 went one step further and pretty much removed Numeric_Error
11742 from the list of standard exceptions (it made it a renaming of
11743 Constraint_Error, to help preserve compatibility when compiling
11744 an Ada83 compiler). As such, we do not include Numeric_Error from
11745 this list of standard exceptions. */
11746
11747 static const char *standard_exc[] = {
11748 "constraint_error",
11749 "program_error",
11750 "storage_error",
11751 "tasking_error"
11752 };
11753
11754 typedef CORE_ADDR (ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_ftype) (void);
11755
11756 /* A structure that describes how to support exception catchpoints
11757 for a given executable. */
11758
11759 struct exception_support_info
11760 {
11761 /* The name of the symbol to break on in order to insert
11762 a catchpoint on exceptions. */
11763 const char *catch_exception_sym;
11764
11765 /* The name of the symbol to break on in order to insert
11766 a catchpoint on unhandled exceptions. */
11767 const char *catch_exception_unhandled_sym;
11768
11769 /* The name of the symbol to break on in order to insert
11770 a catchpoint on failed assertions. */
11771 const char *catch_assert_sym;
11772
11773 /* The name of the symbol to break on in order to insert
11774 a catchpoint on exception handling. */
11775 const char *catch_handlers_sym;
11776
11777 /* Assuming that the inferior just triggered an unhandled exception
11778 catchpoint, this function is responsible for returning the address
11779 in inferior memory where the name of that exception is stored.
11780 Return zero if the address could not be computed. */
11781 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_ftype *unhandled_exception_name_addr;
11782 };
11783
11784 static CORE_ADDR ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr (void);
11785 static CORE_ADDR ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_from_raise (void);
11786
11787 /* The following exception support info structure describes how to
11788 implement exception catchpoints with the latest version of the
11789 Ada runtime (as of 2019-08-??). */
11790
11791 static const struct exception_support_info default_exception_support_info =
11792 {
11793 "__gnat_debug_raise_exception", /* catch_exception_sym */
11794 "__gnat_unhandled_exception", /* catch_exception_unhandled_sym */
11795 "__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure", /* catch_assert_sym */
11796 "__gnat_begin_handler_v1", /* catch_handlers_sym */
11797 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr
11798 };
11799
11800 /* The following exception support info structure describes how to
11801 implement exception catchpoints with an earlier version of the
11802 Ada runtime (as of 2007-03-06) using v0 of the EH ABI. */
11803
11804 static const struct exception_support_info exception_support_info_v0 =
11805 {
11806 "__gnat_debug_raise_exception", /* catch_exception_sym */
11807 "__gnat_unhandled_exception", /* catch_exception_unhandled_sym */
11808 "__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure", /* catch_assert_sym */
11809 "__gnat_begin_handler", /* catch_handlers_sym */
11810 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr
11811 };
11812
11813 /* The following exception support info structure describes how to
11814 implement exception catchpoints with a slightly older version
11815 of the Ada runtime. */
11816
11817 static const struct exception_support_info exception_support_info_fallback =
11818 {
11819 "__gnat_raise_nodefer_with_msg", /* catch_exception_sym */
11820 "__gnat_unhandled_exception", /* catch_exception_unhandled_sym */
11821 "system__assertions__raise_assert_failure", /* catch_assert_sym */
11822 "__gnat_begin_handler", /* catch_handlers_sym */
11823 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_from_raise
11824 };
11825
11826 /* Return nonzero if we can detect the exception support routines
11827 described in EINFO.
11828
11829 This function errors out if an abnormal situation is detected
11830 (for instance, if we find the exception support routines, but
11831 that support is found to be incomplete). */
11832
11833 static int
11834 ada_has_this_exception_support (const struct exception_support_info *einfo)
11835 {
11836 struct symbol *sym;
11837
11838 /* The symbol we're looking up is provided by a unit in the GNAT runtime
11839 that should be compiled with debugging information. As a result, we
11840 expect to find that symbol in the symtabs. */
11841
11842 sym = standard_lookup (einfo->catch_exception_sym, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN);
11843 if (sym == NULL)
11844 {
11845 /* Perhaps we did not find our symbol because the Ada runtime was
11846 compiled without debugging info, or simply stripped of it.
11847 It happens on some GNU/Linux distributions for instance, where
11848 users have to install a separate debug package in order to get
11849 the runtime's debugging info. In that situation, let the user
11850 know why we cannot insert an Ada exception catchpoint.
11851
11852 Note: Just for the purpose of inserting our Ada exception
11853 catchpoint, we could rely purely on the associated minimal symbol.
11854 But we would be operating in degraded mode anyway, since we are
11855 still lacking the debugging info needed later on to extract
11856 the name of the exception being raised (this name is printed in
11857 the catchpoint message, and is also used when trying to catch
11858 a specific exception). We do not handle this case for now. */
11859 struct bound_minimal_symbol msym
11860 = lookup_minimal_symbol (einfo->catch_exception_sym, NULL, NULL);
11861
11862 if (msym.minsym && MSYMBOL_TYPE (msym.minsym) != mst_solib_trampoline)
11863 error (_("Your Ada runtime appears to be missing some debugging "
11864 "information.\nCannot insert Ada exception catchpoint "
11865 "in this configuration."));
11866
11867 return 0;
11868 }
11869
11870 /* Make sure that the symbol we found corresponds to a function. */
11871
11872 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_BLOCK)
11873 {
11874 error (_("Symbol \"%s\" is not a function (class = %d)"),
11875 sym->linkage_name (), SYMBOL_CLASS (sym));
11876 return 0;
11877 }
11878
11879 sym = standard_lookup (einfo->catch_handlers_sym, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN);
11880 if (sym == NULL)
11881 {
11882 struct bound_minimal_symbol msym
11883 = lookup_minimal_symbol (einfo->catch_handlers_sym, NULL, NULL);
11884
11885 if (msym.minsym && MSYMBOL_TYPE (msym.minsym) != mst_solib_trampoline)
11886 error (_("Your Ada runtime appears to be missing some debugging "
11887 "information.\nCannot insert Ada exception catchpoint "
11888 "in this configuration."));
11889
11890 return 0;
11891 }
11892
11893 /* Make sure that the symbol we found corresponds to a function. */
11894
11895 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_BLOCK)
11896 {
11897 error (_("Symbol \"%s\" is not a function (class = %d)"),
11898 sym->linkage_name (), SYMBOL_CLASS (sym));
11899 return 0;
11900 }
11901
11902 return 1;
11903 }
11904
11905 /* Inspect the Ada runtime and determine which exception info structure
11906 should be used to provide support for exception catchpoints.
11907
11908 This function will always set the per-inferior exception_info,
11909 or raise an error. */
11910
11911 static void
11912 ada_exception_support_info_sniffer (void)
11913 {
11914 struct ada_inferior_data *data = get_ada_inferior_data (current_inferior ());
11915
11916 /* If the exception info is already known, then no need to recompute it. */
11917 if (data->exception_info != NULL)
11918 return;
11919
11920 /* Check the latest (default) exception support info. */
11921 if (ada_has_this_exception_support (&default_exception_support_info))
11922 {
11923 data->exception_info = &default_exception_support_info;
11924 return;
11925 }
11926
11927 /* Try the v0 exception suport info. */
11928 if (ada_has_this_exception_support (&exception_support_info_v0))
11929 {
11930 data->exception_info = &exception_support_info_v0;
11931 return;
11932 }
11933
11934 /* Try our fallback exception suport info. */
11935 if (ada_has_this_exception_support (&exception_support_info_fallback))
11936 {
11937 data->exception_info = &exception_support_info_fallback;
11938 return;
11939 }
11940
11941 /* Sometimes, it is normal for us to not be able to find the routine
11942 we are looking for. This happens when the program is linked with
11943 the shared version of the GNAT runtime, and the program has not been
11944 started yet. Inform the user of these two possible causes if
11945 applicable. */
11946
11947 if (ada_update_initial_language (language_unknown) != language_ada)
11948 error (_("Unable to insert catchpoint. Is this an Ada main program?"));
11949
11950 /* If the symbol does not exist, then check that the program is
11951 already started, to make sure that shared libraries have been
11952 loaded. If it is not started, this may mean that the symbol is
11953 in a shared library. */
11954
11955 if (inferior_ptid.pid () == 0)
11956 error (_("Unable to insert catchpoint. Try to start the program first."));
11957
11958 /* At this point, we know that we are debugging an Ada program and
11959 that the inferior has been started, but we still are not able to
11960 find the run-time symbols. That can mean that we are in
11961 configurable run time mode, or that a-except as been optimized
11962 out by the linker... In any case, at this point it is not worth
11963 supporting this feature. */
11964
11965 error (_("Cannot insert Ada exception catchpoints in this configuration."));
11966 }
11967
11968 /* True iff FRAME is very likely to be that of a function that is
11969 part of the runtime system. This is all very heuristic, but is
11970 intended to be used as advice as to what frames are uninteresting
11971 to most users. */
11972
11973 static int
11974 is_known_support_routine (struct frame_info *frame)
11975 {
11976 enum language func_lang;
11977 int i;
11978 const char *fullname;
11979
11980 /* If this code does not have any debugging information (no symtab),
11981 This cannot be any user code. */
11982
11983 symtab_and_line sal = find_frame_sal (frame);
11984 if (sal.symtab == NULL)
11985 return 1;
11986
11987 /* If there is a symtab, but the associated source file cannot be
11988 located, then assume this is not user code: Selecting a frame
11989 for which we cannot display the code would not be very helpful
11990 for the user. This should also take care of case such as VxWorks
11991 where the kernel has some debugging info provided for a few units. */
11992
11993 fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab);
11994 if (access (fullname, R_OK) != 0)
11995 return 1;
11996
11997 /* Check the unit filename against the Ada runtime file naming.
11998 We also check the name of the objfile against the name of some
11999 known system libraries that sometimes come with debugging info
12000 too. */
12001
12002 for (i = 0; known_runtime_file_name_patterns[i] != NULL; i += 1)
12003 {
12004 re_comp (known_runtime_file_name_patterns[i]);
12005 if (re_exec (lbasename (sal.symtab->filename)))
12006 return 1;
12007 if (SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal.symtab) != NULL
12008 && re_exec (objfile_name (SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal.symtab))))
12009 return 1;
12010 }
12011
12012 /* Check whether the function is a GNAT-generated entity. */
12013
12014 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> func_name
12015 = find_frame_funname (frame, &func_lang, NULL);
12016 if (func_name == NULL)
12017 return 1;
12018
12019 for (i = 0; known_auxiliary_function_name_patterns[i] != NULL; i += 1)
12020 {
12021 re_comp (known_auxiliary_function_name_patterns[i]);
12022 if (re_exec (func_name.get ()))
12023 return 1;
12024 }
12025
12026 return 0;
12027 }
12028
12029 /* Find the first frame that contains debugging information and that is not
12030 part of the Ada run-time, starting from FI and moving upward. */
12031
12032 void
12033 ada_find_printable_frame (struct frame_info *fi)
12034 {
12035 for (; fi != NULL; fi = get_prev_frame (fi))
12036 {
12037 if (!is_known_support_routine (fi))
12038 {
12039 select_frame (fi);
12040 break;
12041 }
12042 }
12043
12044 }
12045
12046 /* Assuming that the inferior just triggered an unhandled exception
12047 catchpoint, return the address in inferior memory where the name
12048 of the exception is stored.
12049
12050 Return zero if the address could not be computed. */
12051
12052 static CORE_ADDR
12053 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr (void)
12054 {
12055 return parse_and_eval_address ("e.full_name");
12056 }
12057
12058 /* Same as ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr, except that this function
12059 should be used when the inferior uses an older version of the runtime,
12060 where the exception name needs to be extracted from a specific frame
12061 several frames up in the callstack. */
12062
12063 static CORE_ADDR
12064 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_from_raise (void)
12065 {
12066 int frame_level;
12067 struct frame_info *fi;
12068 struct ada_inferior_data *data = get_ada_inferior_data (current_inferior ());
12069
12070 /* To determine the name of this exception, we need to select
12071 the frame corresponding to RAISE_SYM_NAME. This frame is
12072 at least 3 levels up, so we simply skip the first 3 frames
12073 without checking the name of their associated function. */
12074 fi = get_current_frame ();
12075 for (frame_level = 0; frame_level < 3; frame_level += 1)
12076 if (fi != NULL)
12077 fi = get_prev_frame (fi);
12078
12079 while (fi != NULL)
12080 {
12081 enum language func_lang;
12082
12083 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> func_name
12084 = find_frame_funname (fi, &func_lang, NULL);
12085 if (func_name != NULL)
12086 {
12087 if (strcmp (func_name.get (),
12088 data->exception_info->catch_exception_sym) == 0)
12089 break; /* We found the frame we were looking for... */
12090 }
12091 fi = get_prev_frame (fi);
12092 }
12093
12094 if (fi == NULL)
12095 return 0;
12096
12097 select_frame (fi);
12098 return parse_and_eval_address ("id.full_name");
12099 }
12100
12101 /* Assuming the inferior just triggered an Ada exception catchpoint
12102 (of any type), return the address in inferior memory where the name
12103 of the exception is stored, if applicable.
12104
12105 Assumes the selected frame is the current frame.
12106
12107 Return zero if the address could not be computed, or if not relevant. */
12108
12109 static CORE_ADDR
12110 ada_exception_name_addr_1 (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
12111 struct breakpoint *b)
12112 {
12113 struct ada_inferior_data *data = get_ada_inferior_data (current_inferior ());
12114
12115 switch (ex)
12116 {
12117 case ada_catch_exception:
12118 return (parse_and_eval_address ("e.full_name"));
12119 break;
12120
12121 case ada_catch_exception_unhandled:
12122 return data->exception_info->unhandled_exception_name_addr ();
12123 break;
12124
12125 case ada_catch_handlers:
12126 return 0; /* The runtimes does not provide access to the exception
12127 name. */
12128 break;
12129
12130 case ada_catch_assert:
12131 return 0; /* Exception name is not relevant in this case. */
12132 break;
12133
12134 default:
12135 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type"));
12136 break;
12137 }
12138
12139 return 0; /* Should never be reached. */
12140 }
12141
12142 /* Assuming the inferior is stopped at an exception catchpoint,
12143 return the message which was associated to the exception, if
12144 available. Return NULL if the message could not be retrieved.
12145
12146 Note: The exception message can be associated to an exception
12147 either through the use of the Raise_Exception function, or
12148 more simply (Ada 2005 and later), via:
12149
12150 raise Exception_Name with "exception message";
12151
12152 */
12153
12154 static gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char>
12155 ada_exception_message_1 (void)
12156 {
12157 struct value *e_msg_val;
12158 int e_msg_len;
12159
12160 /* For runtimes that support this feature, the exception message
12161 is passed as an unbounded string argument called "message". */
12162 e_msg_val = parse_and_eval ("message");
12163 if (e_msg_val == NULL)
12164 return NULL; /* Exception message not supported. */
12165
12166 e_msg_val = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (e_msg_val);
12167 gdb_assert (e_msg_val != NULL);
12168 e_msg_len = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (e_msg_val));
12169
12170 /* If the message string is empty, then treat it as if there was
12171 no exception message. */
12172 if (e_msg_len <= 0)
12173 return NULL;
12174
12175 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> e_msg ((char *) xmalloc (e_msg_len + 1));
12176 read_memory_string (value_address (e_msg_val), e_msg.get (), e_msg_len + 1);
12177 e_msg.get ()[e_msg_len] = '\0';
12178
12179 return e_msg;
12180 }
12181
12182 /* Same as ada_exception_message_1, except that all exceptions are
12183 contained here (returning NULL instead). */
12184
12185 static gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char>
12186 ada_exception_message (void)
12187 {
12188 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> e_msg;
12189
12190 try
12191 {
12192 e_msg = ada_exception_message_1 ();
12193 }
12194 catch (const gdb_exception_error &e)
12195 {
12196 e_msg.reset (nullptr);
12197 }
12198
12199 return e_msg;
12200 }
12201
12202 /* Same as ada_exception_name_addr_1, except that it intercepts and contains
12203 any error that ada_exception_name_addr_1 might cause to be thrown.
12204 When an error is intercepted, a warning with the error message is printed,
12205 and zero is returned. */
12206
12207 static CORE_ADDR
12208 ada_exception_name_addr (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
12209 struct breakpoint *b)
12210 {
12211 CORE_ADDR result = 0;
12212
12213 try
12214 {
12215 result = ada_exception_name_addr_1 (ex, b);
12216 }
12217
12218 catch (const gdb_exception_error &e)
12219 {
12220 warning (_("failed to get exception name: %s"), e.what ());
12221 return 0;
12222 }
12223
12224 return result;
12225 }
12226
12227 static std::string ada_exception_catchpoint_cond_string
12228 (const char *excep_string,
12229 enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex);
12230
12231 /* Ada catchpoints.
12232
12233 In the case of catchpoints on Ada exceptions, the catchpoint will
12234 stop the target on every exception the program throws. When a user
12235 specifies the name of a specific exception, we translate this
12236 request into a condition expression (in text form), and then parse
12237 it into an expression stored in each of the catchpoint's locations.
12238 We then use this condition to check whether the exception that was
12239 raised is the one the user is interested in. If not, then the
12240 target is resumed again. We store the name of the requested
12241 exception, in order to be able to re-set the condition expression
12242 when symbols change. */
12243
12244 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an Ada catchpoint
12245 breakpoint location. */
12246
12247 class ada_catchpoint_location : public bp_location
12248 {
12249 public:
12250 ada_catchpoint_location (breakpoint *owner)
12251 : bp_location (owner, bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
12252 {}
12253
12254 /* The condition that checks whether the exception that was raised
12255 is the specific exception the user specified on catchpoint
12256 creation. */
12257 expression_up excep_cond_expr;
12258 };
12259
12260 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an Ada catchpoint. */
12261
12262 struct ada_catchpoint : public breakpoint
12263 {
12264 explicit ada_catchpoint (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind kind)
12265 : m_kind (kind)
12266 {
12267 }
12268
12269 /* The name of the specific exception the user specified. */
12270 std::string excep_string;
12271
12272 /* What kind of catchpoint this is. */
12273 enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind m_kind;
12274 };
12275
12276 /* Parse the exception condition string in the context of each of the
12277 catchpoint's locations, and store them for later evaluation. */
12278
12279 static void
12280 create_excep_cond_exprs (struct ada_catchpoint *c,
12281 enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex)
12282 {
12283 struct bp_location *bl;
12284
12285 /* Nothing to do if there's no specific exception to catch. */
12286 if (c->excep_string.empty ())
12287 return;
12288
12289 /* Same if there are no locations... */
12290 if (c->loc == NULL)
12291 return;
12292
12293 /* Compute the condition expression in text form, from the specific
12294 expection we want to catch. */
12295 std::string cond_string
12296 = ada_exception_catchpoint_cond_string (c->excep_string.c_str (), ex);
12297
12298 /* Iterate over all the catchpoint's locations, and parse an
12299 expression for each. */
12300 for (bl = c->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
12301 {
12302 struct ada_catchpoint_location *ada_loc
12303 = (struct ada_catchpoint_location *) bl;
12304 expression_up exp;
12305
12306 if (!bl->shlib_disabled)
12307 {
12308 const char *s;
12309
12310 s = cond_string.c_str ();
12311 try
12312 {
12313 exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, bl->address,
12314 block_for_pc (bl->address),
12315 0);
12316 }
12317 catch (const gdb_exception_error &e)
12318 {
12319 warning (_("failed to reevaluate internal exception condition "
12320 "for catchpoint %d: %s"),
12321 c->number, e.what ());
12322 }
12323 }
12324
12325 ada_loc->excep_cond_expr = std::move (exp);
12326 }
12327 }
12328
12329 /* Implement the ALLOCATE_LOCATION method in the breakpoint_ops
12330 structure for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
12331
12332 static struct bp_location *
12333 allocate_location_exception (struct breakpoint *self)
12334 {
12335 return new ada_catchpoint_location (self);
12336 }
12337
12338 /* Implement the RE_SET method in the breakpoint_ops structure for all
12339 exception catchpoint kinds. */
12340
12341 static void
12342 re_set_exception (struct breakpoint *b)
12343 {
12344 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) b;
12345
12346 /* Call the base class's method. This updates the catchpoint's
12347 locations. */
12348 bkpt_breakpoint_ops.re_set (b);
12349
12350 /* Reparse the exception conditional expressions. One for each
12351 location. */
12352 create_excep_cond_exprs (c, c->m_kind);
12353 }
12354
12355 /* Returns true if we should stop for this breakpoint hit. If the
12356 user specified a specific exception, we only want to cause a stop
12357 if the program thrown that exception. */
12358
12359 static int
12360 should_stop_exception (const struct bp_location *bl)
12361 {
12362 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
12363 const struct ada_catchpoint_location *ada_loc
12364 = (const struct ada_catchpoint_location *) bl;
12365 int stop;
12366
12367 struct internalvar *var = lookup_internalvar ("_ada_exception");
12368 if (c->m_kind == ada_catch_assert)
12369 clear_internalvar (var);
12370 else
12371 {
12372 try
12373 {
12374 const char *expr;
12375
12376 if (c->m_kind == ada_catch_handlers)
12377 expr = ("GNAT_GCC_exception_Access(gcc_exception)"
12378 ".all.occurrence.id");
12379 else
12380 expr = "e";
12381
12382 struct value *exc = parse_and_eval (expr);
12383 set_internalvar (var, exc);
12384 }
12385 catch (const gdb_exception_error &ex)
12386 {
12387 clear_internalvar (var);
12388 }
12389 }
12390
12391 /* With no specific exception, should always stop. */
12392 if (c->excep_string.empty ())
12393 return 1;
12394
12395 if (ada_loc->excep_cond_expr == NULL)
12396 {
12397 /* We will have a NULL expression if back when we were creating
12398 the expressions, this location's had failed to parse. */
12399 return 1;
12400 }
12401
12402 stop = 1;
12403 try
12404 {
12405 struct value *mark;
12406
12407 mark = value_mark ();
12408 stop = value_true (evaluate_expression (ada_loc->excep_cond_expr.get ()));
12409 value_free_to_mark (mark);
12410 }
12411 catch (const gdb_exception &ex)
12412 {
12413 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
12414 _("Error in testing exception condition:\n"));
12415 }
12416
12417 return stop;
12418 }
12419
12420 /* Implement the CHECK_STATUS method in the breakpoint_ops structure
12421 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
12422
12423 static void
12424 check_status_exception (bpstat bs)
12425 {
12426 bs->stop = should_stop_exception (bs->bp_location_at);
12427 }
12428
12429 /* Implement the PRINT_IT method in the breakpoint_ops structure
12430 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
12431
12432 static enum print_stop_action
12433 print_it_exception (bpstat bs)
12434 {
12435 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
12436 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
12437
12438 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
12439
12440 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
12441 {
12442 uiout->field_string ("reason",
12443 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
12444 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
12445 }
12446
12447 uiout->text (b->disposition == disp_del
12448 ? "\nTemporary catchpoint " : "\nCatchpoint ");
12449 uiout->field_signed ("bkptno", b->number);
12450 uiout->text (", ");
12451
12452 /* ada_exception_name_addr relies on the selected frame being the
12453 current frame. Need to do this here because this function may be
12454 called more than once when printing a stop, and below, we'll
12455 select the first frame past the Ada run-time (see
12456 ada_find_printable_frame). */
12457 select_frame (get_current_frame ());
12458
12459 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) b;
12460 switch (c->m_kind)
12461 {
12462 case ada_catch_exception:
12463 case ada_catch_exception_unhandled:
12464 case ada_catch_handlers:
12465 {
12466 const CORE_ADDR addr = ada_exception_name_addr (c->m_kind, b);
12467 char exception_name[256];
12468
12469 if (addr != 0)
12470 {
12471 read_memory (addr, (gdb_byte *) exception_name,
12472 sizeof (exception_name) - 1);
12473 exception_name [sizeof (exception_name) - 1] = '\0';
12474 }
12475 else
12476 {
12477 /* For some reason, we were unable to read the exception
12478 name. This could happen if the Runtime was compiled
12479 without debugging info, for instance. In that case,
12480 just replace the exception name by the generic string
12481 "exception" - it will read as "an exception" in the
12482 notification we are about to print. */
12483 memcpy (exception_name, "exception", sizeof ("exception"));
12484 }
12485 /* In the case of unhandled exception breakpoints, we print
12486 the exception name as "unhandled EXCEPTION_NAME", to make
12487 it clearer to the user which kind of catchpoint just got
12488 hit. We used ui_out_text to make sure that this extra
12489 info does not pollute the exception name in the MI case. */
12490 if (c->m_kind == ada_catch_exception_unhandled)
12491 uiout->text ("unhandled ");
12492 uiout->field_string ("exception-name", exception_name);
12493 }
12494 break;
12495 case ada_catch_assert:
12496 /* In this case, the name of the exception is not really
12497 important. Just print "failed assertion" to make it clearer
12498 that his program just hit an assertion-failure catchpoint.
12499 We used ui_out_text because this info does not belong in
12500 the MI output. */
12501 uiout->text ("failed assertion");
12502 break;
12503 }
12504
12505 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> exception_message = ada_exception_message ();
12506 if (exception_message != NULL)
12507 {
12508 uiout->text (" (");
12509 uiout->field_string ("exception-message", exception_message.get ());
12510 uiout->text (")");
12511 }
12512
12513 uiout->text (" at ");
12514 ada_find_printable_frame (get_current_frame ());
12515
12516 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
12517 }
12518
12519 /* Implement the PRINT_ONE method in the breakpoint_ops structure
12520 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
12521
12522 static void
12523 print_one_exception (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
12524 {
12525 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
12526 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) b;
12527 struct value_print_options opts;
12528
12529 get_user_print_options (&opts);
12530
12531 if (opts.addressprint)
12532 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
12533
12534 annotate_field (5);
12535 switch (c->m_kind)
12536 {
12537 case ada_catch_exception:
12538 if (!c->excep_string.empty ())
12539 {
12540 std::string msg = string_printf (_("`%s' Ada exception"),
12541 c->excep_string.c_str ());
12542
12543 uiout->field_string ("what", msg);
12544 }
12545 else
12546 uiout->field_string ("what", "all Ada exceptions");
12547
12548 break;
12549
12550 case ada_catch_exception_unhandled:
12551 uiout->field_string ("what", "unhandled Ada exceptions");
12552 break;
12553
12554 case ada_catch_handlers:
12555 if (!c->excep_string.empty ())
12556 {
12557 uiout->field_fmt ("what",
12558 _("`%s' Ada exception handlers"),
12559 c->excep_string.c_str ());
12560 }
12561 else
12562 uiout->field_string ("what", "all Ada exceptions handlers");
12563 break;
12564
12565 case ada_catch_assert:
12566 uiout->field_string ("what", "failed Ada assertions");
12567 break;
12568
12569 default:
12570 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type"));
12571 break;
12572 }
12573 }
12574
12575 /* Implement the PRINT_MENTION method in the breakpoint_ops structure
12576 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
12577
12578 static void
12579 print_mention_exception (struct breakpoint *b)
12580 {
12581 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) b;
12582 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
12583
12584 uiout->text (b->disposition == disp_del ? _("Temporary catchpoint ")
12585 : _("Catchpoint "));
12586 uiout->field_signed ("bkptno", b->number);
12587 uiout->text (": ");
12588
12589 switch (c->m_kind)
12590 {
12591 case ada_catch_exception:
12592 if (!c->excep_string.empty ())
12593 {
12594 std::string info = string_printf (_("`%s' Ada exception"),
12595 c->excep_string.c_str ());
12596 uiout->text (info.c_str ());
12597 }
12598 else
12599 uiout->text (_("all Ada exceptions"));
12600 break;
12601
12602 case ada_catch_exception_unhandled:
12603 uiout->text (_("unhandled Ada exceptions"));
12604 break;
12605
12606 case ada_catch_handlers:
12607 if (!c->excep_string.empty ())
12608 {
12609 std::string info
12610 = string_printf (_("`%s' Ada exception handlers"),
12611 c->excep_string.c_str ());
12612 uiout->text (info.c_str ());
12613 }
12614 else
12615 uiout->text (_("all Ada exceptions handlers"));
12616 break;
12617
12618 case ada_catch_assert:
12619 uiout->text (_("failed Ada assertions"));
12620 break;
12621
12622 default:
12623 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type"));
12624 break;
12625 }
12626 }
12627
12628 /* Implement the PRINT_RECREATE method in the breakpoint_ops structure
12629 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
12630
12631 static void
12632 print_recreate_exception (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
12633 {
12634 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) b;
12635
12636 switch (c->m_kind)
12637 {
12638 case ada_catch_exception:
12639 fprintf_filtered (fp, "catch exception");
12640 if (!c->excep_string.empty ())
12641 fprintf_filtered (fp, " %s", c->excep_string.c_str ());
12642 break;
12643
12644 case ada_catch_exception_unhandled:
12645 fprintf_filtered (fp, "catch exception unhandled");
12646 break;
12647
12648 case ada_catch_handlers:
12649 fprintf_filtered (fp, "catch handlers");
12650 break;
12651
12652 case ada_catch_assert:
12653 fprintf_filtered (fp, "catch assert");
12654 break;
12655
12656 default:
12657 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type"));
12658 }
12659 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
12660 }
12661
12662 /* Virtual tables for various breakpoint types. */
12663 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exception_breakpoint_ops;
12664 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exception_unhandled_breakpoint_ops;
12665 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_assert_breakpoint_ops;
12666 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_handlers_breakpoint_ops;
12667
12668 /* See ada-lang.h. */
12669
12670 bool
12671 is_ada_exception_catchpoint (breakpoint *bp)
12672 {
12673 return (bp->ops == &catch_exception_breakpoint_ops
12674 || bp->ops == &catch_exception_unhandled_breakpoint_ops
12675 || bp->ops == &catch_assert_breakpoint_ops
12676 || bp->ops == &catch_handlers_breakpoint_ops);
12677 }
12678
12679 /* Split the arguments specified in a "catch exception" command.
12680 Set EX to the appropriate catchpoint type.
12681 Set EXCEP_STRING to the name of the specific exception if
12682 specified by the user.
12683 IS_CATCH_HANDLERS_CMD: True if the arguments are for a
12684 "catch handlers" command. False otherwise.
12685 If a condition is found at the end of the arguments, the condition
12686 expression is stored in COND_STRING (memory must be deallocated
12687 after use). Otherwise COND_STRING is set to NULL. */
12688
12689 static void
12690 catch_ada_exception_command_split (const char *args,
12691 bool is_catch_handlers_cmd,
12692 enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind *ex,
12693 std::string *excep_string,
12694 std::string *cond_string)
12695 {
12696 std::string exception_name;
12697
12698 exception_name = extract_arg (&args);
12699 if (exception_name == "if")
12700 {
12701 /* This is not an exception name; this is the start of a condition
12702 expression for a catchpoint on all exceptions. So, "un-get"
12703 this token, and set exception_name to NULL. */
12704 exception_name.clear ();
12705 args -= 2;
12706 }
12707
12708 /* Check to see if we have a condition. */
12709
12710 args = skip_spaces (args);
12711 if (startswith (args, "if")
12712 && (isspace (args[2]) || args[2] == '\0'))
12713 {
12714 args += 2;
12715 args = skip_spaces (args);
12716
12717 if (args[0] == '\0')
12718 error (_("Condition missing after `if' keyword"));
12719 *cond_string = args;
12720
12721 args += strlen (args);
12722 }
12723
12724 /* Check that we do not have any more arguments. Anything else
12725 is unexpected. */
12726
12727 if (args[0] != '\0')
12728 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
12729
12730 if (is_catch_handlers_cmd)
12731 {
12732 /* Catch handling of exceptions. */
12733 *ex = ada_catch_handlers;
12734 *excep_string = exception_name;
12735 }
12736 else if (exception_name.empty ())
12737 {
12738 /* Catch all exceptions. */
12739 *ex = ada_catch_exception;
12740 excep_string->clear ();
12741 }
12742 else if (exception_name == "unhandled")
12743 {
12744 /* Catch unhandled exceptions. */
12745 *ex = ada_catch_exception_unhandled;
12746 excep_string->clear ();
12747 }
12748 else
12749 {
12750 /* Catch a specific exception. */
12751 *ex = ada_catch_exception;
12752 *excep_string = exception_name;
12753 }
12754 }
12755
12756 /* Return the name of the symbol on which we should break in order to
12757 implement a catchpoint of the EX kind. */
12758
12759 static const char *
12760 ada_exception_sym_name (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex)
12761 {
12762 struct ada_inferior_data *data = get_ada_inferior_data (current_inferior ());
12763
12764 gdb_assert (data->exception_info != NULL);
12765
12766 switch (ex)
12767 {
12768 case ada_catch_exception:
12769 return (data->exception_info->catch_exception_sym);
12770 break;
12771 case ada_catch_exception_unhandled:
12772 return (data->exception_info->catch_exception_unhandled_sym);
12773 break;
12774 case ada_catch_assert:
12775 return (data->exception_info->catch_assert_sym);
12776 break;
12777 case ada_catch_handlers:
12778 return (data->exception_info->catch_handlers_sym);
12779 break;
12780 default:
12781 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12782 _("unexpected catchpoint kind (%d)"), ex);
12783 }
12784 }
12785
12786 /* Return the breakpoint ops "virtual table" used for catchpoints
12787 of the EX kind. */
12788
12789 static const struct breakpoint_ops *
12790 ada_exception_breakpoint_ops (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex)
12791 {
12792 switch (ex)
12793 {
12794 case ada_catch_exception:
12795 return (&catch_exception_breakpoint_ops);
12796 break;
12797 case ada_catch_exception_unhandled:
12798 return (&catch_exception_unhandled_breakpoint_ops);
12799 break;
12800 case ada_catch_assert:
12801 return (&catch_assert_breakpoint_ops);
12802 break;
12803 case ada_catch_handlers:
12804 return (&catch_handlers_breakpoint_ops);
12805 break;
12806 default:
12807 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12808 _("unexpected catchpoint kind (%d)"), ex);
12809 }
12810 }
12811
12812 /* Return the condition that will be used to match the current exception
12813 being raised with the exception that the user wants to catch. This
12814 assumes that this condition is used when the inferior just triggered
12815 an exception catchpoint.
12816 EX: the type of catchpoints used for catching Ada exceptions. */
12817
12818 static std::string
12819 ada_exception_catchpoint_cond_string (const char *excep_string,
12820 enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex)
12821 {
12822 int i;
12823 bool is_standard_exc = false;
12824 std::string result;
12825
12826 if (ex == ada_catch_handlers)
12827 {
12828 /* For exception handlers catchpoints, the condition string does
12829 not use the same parameter as for the other exceptions. */
12830 result = ("long_integer (GNAT_GCC_exception_Access"
12831 "(gcc_exception).all.occurrence.id)");
12832 }
12833 else
12834 result = "long_integer (e)";
12835
12836 /* The standard exceptions are a special case. They are defined in
12837 runtime units that have been compiled without debugging info; if
12838 EXCEP_STRING is the not-fully-qualified name of a standard
12839 exception (e.g. "constraint_error") then, during the evaluation
12840 of the condition expression, the symbol lookup on this name would
12841 *not* return this standard exception. The catchpoint condition
12842 may then be set only on user-defined exceptions which have the
12843 same not-fully-qualified name (e.g. my_package.constraint_error).
12844
12845 To avoid this unexcepted behavior, these standard exceptions are
12846 systematically prefixed by "standard". This means that "catch
12847 exception constraint_error" is rewritten into "catch exception
12848 standard.constraint_error".
12849
12850 If an exception named constraint_error is defined in another package of
12851 the inferior program, then the only way to specify this exception as a
12852 breakpoint condition is to use its fully-qualified named:
12853 e.g. my_package.constraint_error. */
12854
12855 for (i = 0; i < sizeof (standard_exc) / sizeof (char *); i++)
12856 {
12857 if (strcmp (standard_exc [i], excep_string) == 0)
12858 {
12859 is_standard_exc = true;
12860 break;
12861 }
12862 }
12863
12864 result += " = ";
12865
12866 if (is_standard_exc)
12867 string_appendf (result, "long_integer (&standard.%s)", excep_string);
12868 else
12869 string_appendf (result, "long_integer (&%s)", excep_string);
12870
12871 return result;
12872 }
12873
12874 /* Return the symtab_and_line that should be used to insert an exception
12875 catchpoint of the TYPE kind.
12876
12877 ADDR_STRING returns the name of the function where the real
12878 breakpoint that implements the catchpoints is set, depending on the
12879 type of catchpoint we need to create. */
12880
12881 static struct symtab_and_line
12882 ada_exception_sal (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
12883 std::string *addr_string, const struct breakpoint_ops **ops)
12884 {
12885 const char *sym_name;
12886 struct symbol *sym;
12887
12888 /* First, find out which exception support info to use. */
12889 ada_exception_support_info_sniffer ();
12890
12891 /* Then lookup the function on which we will break in order to catch
12892 the Ada exceptions requested by the user. */
12893 sym_name = ada_exception_sym_name (ex);
12894 sym = standard_lookup (sym_name, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN);
12895
12896 if (sym == NULL)
12897 error (_("Catchpoint symbol not found: %s"), sym_name);
12898
12899 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_BLOCK)
12900 error (_("Unable to insert catchpoint. %s is not a function."), sym_name);
12901
12902 /* Set ADDR_STRING. */
12903 *addr_string = sym_name;
12904
12905 /* Set OPS. */
12906 *ops = ada_exception_breakpoint_ops (ex);
12907
12908 return find_function_start_sal (sym, 1);
12909 }
12910
12911 /* Create an Ada exception catchpoint.
12912
12913 EX_KIND is the kind of exception catchpoint to be created.
12914
12915 If EXCEPT_STRING is empty, this catchpoint is expected to trigger
12916 for all exceptions. Otherwise, EXCEPT_STRING indicates the name
12917 of the exception to which this catchpoint applies.
12918
12919 COND_STRING, if not empty, is the catchpoint condition.
12920
12921 TEMPFLAG, if nonzero, means that the underlying breakpoint
12922 should be temporary.
12923
12924 FROM_TTY is the usual argument passed to all commands implementations. */
12925
12926 void
12927 create_ada_exception_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12928 enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex_kind,
12929 const std::string &excep_string,
12930 const std::string &cond_string,
12931 int tempflag,
12932 int disabled,
12933 int from_tty)
12934 {
12935 std::string addr_string;
12936 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops = NULL;
12937 struct symtab_and_line sal = ada_exception_sal (ex_kind, &addr_string, &ops);
12938
12939 std::unique_ptr<ada_catchpoint> c (new ada_catchpoint (ex_kind));
12940 init_ada_exception_breakpoint (c.get (), gdbarch, sal, addr_string.c_str (),
12941 ops, tempflag, disabled, from_tty);
12942 c->excep_string = excep_string;
12943 create_excep_cond_exprs (c.get (), ex_kind);
12944 if (!cond_string.empty ())
12945 set_breakpoint_condition (c.get (), cond_string.c_str (), from_tty);
12946 install_breakpoint (0, std::move (c), 1);
12947 }
12948
12949 /* Implement the "catch exception" command. */
12950
12951 static void
12952 catch_ada_exception_command (const char *arg_entry, int from_tty,
12953 struct cmd_list_element *command)
12954 {
12955 const char *arg = arg_entry;
12956 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
12957 int tempflag;
12958 enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex_kind;
12959 std::string excep_string;
12960 std::string cond_string;
12961
12962 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
12963
12964 if (!arg)
12965 arg = "";
12966 catch_ada_exception_command_split (arg, false, &ex_kind, &excep_string,
12967 &cond_string);
12968 create_ada_exception_catchpoint (gdbarch, ex_kind,
12969 excep_string, cond_string,
12970 tempflag, 1 /* enabled */,
12971 from_tty);
12972 }
12973
12974 /* Implement the "catch handlers" command. */
12975
12976 static void
12977 catch_ada_handlers_command (const char *arg_entry, int from_tty,
12978 struct cmd_list_element *command)
12979 {
12980 const char *arg = arg_entry;
12981 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
12982 int tempflag;
12983 enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex_kind;
12984 std::string excep_string;
12985 std::string cond_string;
12986
12987 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
12988
12989 if (!arg)
12990 arg = "";
12991 catch_ada_exception_command_split (arg, true, &ex_kind, &excep_string,
12992 &cond_string);
12993 create_ada_exception_catchpoint (gdbarch, ex_kind,
12994 excep_string, cond_string,
12995 tempflag, 1 /* enabled */,
12996 from_tty);
12997 }
12998
12999 /* Completion function for the Ada "catch" commands. */
13000
13001 static void
13002 catch_ada_completer (struct cmd_list_element *cmd, completion_tracker &tracker,
13003 const char *text, const char *word)
13004 {
13005 std::vector<ada_exc_info> exceptions = ada_exceptions_list (NULL);
13006
13007 for (const ada_exc_info &info : exceptions)
13008 {
13009 if (startswith (info.name, word))
13010 tracker.add_completion (make_unique_xstrdup (info.name));
13011 }
13012 }
13013
13014 /* Split the arguments specified in a "catch assert" command.
13015
13016 ARGS contains the command's arguments (or the empty string if
13017 no arguments were passed).
13018
13019 If ARGS contains a condition, set COND_STRING to that condition
13020 (the memory needs to be deallocated after use). */
13021
13022 static void
13023 catch_ada_assert_command_split (const char *args, std::string &cond_string)
13024 {
13025 args = skip_spaces (args);
13026
13027 /* Check whether a condition was provided. */
13028 if (startswith (args, "if")
13029 && (isspace (args[2]) || args[2] == '\0'))
13030 {
13031 args += 2;
13032 args = skip_spaces (args);
13033 if (args[0] == '\0')
13034 error (_("condition missing after `if' keyword"));
13035 cond_string.assign (args);
13036 }
13037
13038 /* Otherwise, there should be no other argument at the end of
13039 the command. */
13040 else if (args[0] != '\0')
13041 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
13042 }
13043
13044 /* Implement the "catch assert" command. */
13045
13046 static void
13047 catch_assert_command (const char *arg_entry, int from_tty,
13048 struct cmd_list_element *command)
13049 {
13050 const char *arg = arg_entry;
13051 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
13052 int tempflag;
13053 std::string cond_string;
13054
13055 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
13056
13057 if (!arg)
13058 arg = "";
13059 catch_ada_assert_command_split (arg, cond_string);
13060 create_ada_exception_catchpoint (gdbarch, ada_catch_assert,
13061 "", cond_string,
13062 tempflag, 1 /* enabled */,
13063 from_tty);
13064 }
13065
13066 /* Return non-zero if the symbol SYM is an Ada exception object. */
13067
13068 static int
13069 ada_is_exception_sym (struct symbol *sym)
13070 {
13071 const char *type_name = SYMBOL_TYPE (sym)->name ();
13072
13073 return (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_TYPEDEF
13074 && SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_BLOCK
13075 && SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_CONST
13076 && SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_UNRESOLVED
13077 && type_name != NULL && strcmp (type_name, "exception") == 0);
13078 }
13079
13080 /* Given a global symbol SYM, return non-zero iff SYM is a non-standard
13081 Ada exception object. This matches all exceptions except the ones
13082 defined by the Ada language. */
13083
13084 static int
13085 ada_is_non_standard_exception_sym (struct symbol *sym)
13086 {
13087 int i;
13088
13089 if (!ada_is_exception_sym (sym))
13090 return 0;
13091
13092 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (standard_exc); i++)
13093 if (strcmp (sym->linkage_name (), standard_exc[i]) == 0)
13094 return 0; /* A standard exception. */
13095
13096 /* Numeric_Error is also a standard exception, so exclude it.
13097 See the STANDARD_EXC description for more details as to why
13098 this exception is not listed in that array. */
13099 if (strcmp (sym->linkage_name (), "numeric_error") == 0)
13100 return 0;
13101
13102 return 1;
13103 }
13104
13105 /* A helper function for std::sort, comparing two struct ada_exc_info
13106 objects.
13107
13108 The comparison is determined first by exception name, and then
13109 by exception address. */
13110
13111 bool
13112 ada_exc_info::operator< (const ada_exc_info &other) const
13113 {
13114 int result;
13115
13116 result = strcmp (name, other.name);
13117 if (result < 0)
13118 return true;
13119 if (result == 0 && addr < other.addr)
13120 return true;
13121 return false;
13122 }
13123
13124 bool
13125 ada_exc_info::operator== (const ada_exc_info &other) const
13126 {
13127 return addr == other.addr && strcmp (name, other.name) == 0;
13128 }
13129
13130 /* Sort EXCEPTIONS using compare_ada_exception_info as the comparison
13131 routine, but keeping the first SKIP elements untouched.
13132
13133 All duplicates are also removed. */
13134
13135 static void
13136 sort_remove_dups_ada_exceptions_list (std::vector<ada_exc_info> *exceptions,
13137 int skip)
13138 {
13139 std::sort (exceptions->begin () + skip, exceptions->end ());
13140 exceptions->erase (std::unique (exceptions->begin () + skip, exceptions->end ()),
13141 exceptions->end ());
13142 }
13143
13144 /* Add all exceptions defined by the Ada standard whose name match
13145 a regular expression.
13146
13147 If PREG is not NULL, then this regexp_t object is used to
13148 perform the symbol name matching. Otherwise, no name-based
13149 filtering is performed.
13150
13151 EXCEPTIONS is a vector of exceptions to which matching exceptions
13152 gets pushed. */
13153
13154 static void
13155 ada_add_standard_exceptions (compiled_regex *preg,
13156 std::vector<ada_exc_info> *exceptions)
13157 {
13158 int i;
13159
13160 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (standard_exc); i++)
13161 {
13162 if (preg == NULL
13163 || preg->exec (standard_exc[i], 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
13164 {
13165 struct bound_minimal_symbol msymbol
13166 = ada_lookup_simple_minsym (standard_exc[i]);
13167
13168 if (msymbol.minsym != NULL)
13169 {
13170 struct ada_exc_info info
13171 = {standard_exc[i], BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (msymbol)};
13172
13173 exceptions->push_back (info);
13174 }
13175 }
13176 }
13177 }
13178
13179 /* Add all Ada exceptions defined locally and accessible from the given
13180 FRAME.
13181
13182 If PREG is not NULL, then this regexp_t object is used to
13183 perform the symbol name matching. Otherwise, no name-based
13184 filtering is performed.
13185
13186 EXCEPTIONS is a vector of exceptions to which matching exceptions
13187 gets pushed. */
13188
13189 static void
13190 ada_add_exceptions_from_frame (compiled_regex *preg,
13191 struct frame_info *frame,
13192 std::vector<ada_exc_info> *exceptions)
13193 {
13194 const struct block *block = get_frame_block (frame, 0);
13195
13196 while (block != 0)
13197 {
13198 struct block_iterator iter;
13199 struct symbol *sym;
13200
13201 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (block, iter, sym)
13202 {
13203 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym))
13204 {
13205 case LOC_TYPEDEF:
13206 case LOC_BLOCK:
13207 case LOC_CONST:
13208 break;
13209 default:
13210 if (ada_is_exception_sym (sym))
13211 {
13212 struct ada_exc_info info = {sym->print_name (),
13213 SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (sym)};
13214
13215 exceptions->push_back (info);
13216 }
13217 }
13218 }
13219 if (BLOCK_FUNCTION (block) != NULL)
13220 break;
13221 block = BLOCK_SUPERBLOCK (block);
13222 }
13223 }
13224
13225 /* Return true if NAME matches PREG or if PREG is NULL. */
13226
13227 static bool
13228 name_matches_regex (const char *name, compiled_regex *preg)
13229 {
13230 return (preg == NULL
13231 || preg->exec (ada_decode (name).c_str (), 0, NULL, 0) == 0);
13232 }
13233
13234 /* Add all exceptions defined globally whose name name match
13235 a regular expression, excluding standard exceptions.
13236
13237 The reason we exclude standard exceptions is that they need
13238 to be handled separately: Standard exceptions are defined inside
13239 a runtime unit which is normally not compiled with debugging info,
13240 and thus usually do not show up in our symbol search. However,
13241 if the unit was in fact built with debugging info, we need to
13242 exclude them because they would duplicate the entry we found
13243 during the special loop that specifically searches for those
13244 standard exceptions.
13245
13246 If PREG is not NULL, then this regexp_t object is used to
13247 perform the symbol name matching. Otherwise, no name-based
13248 filtering is performed.
13249
13250 EXCEPTIONS is a vector of exceptions to which matching exceptions
13251 gets pushed. */
13252
13253 static void
13254 ada_add_global_exceptions (compiled_regex *preg,
13255 std::vector<ada_exc_info> *exceptions)
13256 {
13257 /* In Ada, the symbol "search name" is a linkage name, whereas the
13258 regular expression used to do the matching refers to the natural
13259 name. So match against the decoded name. */
13260 expand_symtabs_matching (NULL,
13261 lookup_name_info::match_any (),
13262 [&] (const char *search_name)
13263 {
13264 std::string decoded = ada_decode (search_name);
13265 return name_matches_regex (decoded.c_str (), preg);
13266 },
13267 NULL,
13268 VARIABLES_DOMAIN);
13269
13270 for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
13271 {
13272 for (compunit_symtab *s : objfile->compunits ())
13273 {
13274 const struct blockvector *bv = COMPUNIT_BLOCKVECTOR (s);
13275 int i;
13276
13277 for (i = GLOBAL_BLOCK; i <= STATIC_BLOCK; i++)
13278 {
13279 const struct block *b = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (bv, i);
13280 struct block_iterator iter;
13281 struct symbol *sym;
13282
13283 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, sym)
13284 if (ada_is_non_standard_exception_sym (sym)
13285 && name_matches_regex (sym->natural_name (), preg))
13286 {
13287 struct ada_exc_info info
13288 = {sym->print_name (), SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (sym)};
13289
13290 exceptions->push_back (info);
13291 }
13292 }
13293 }
13294 }
13295 }
13296
13297 /* Implements ada_exceptions_list with the regular expression passed
13298 as a regex_t, rather than a string.
13299
13300 If not NULL, PREG is used to filter out exceptions whose names
13301 do not match. Otherwise, all exceptions are listed. */
13302
13303 static std::vector<ada_exc_info>
13304 ada_exceptions_list_1 (compiled_regex *preg)
13305 {
13306 std::vector<ada_exc_info> result;
13307 int prev_len;
13308
13309 /* First, list the known standard exceptions. These exceptions
13310 need to be handled separately, as they are usually defined in
13311 runtime units that have been compiled without debugging info. */
13312
13313 ada_add_standard_exceptions (preg, &result);
13314
13315 /* Next, find all exceptions whose scope is local and accessible
13316 from the currently selected frame. */
13317
13318 if (has_stack_frames ())
13319 {
13320 prev_len = result.size ();
13321 ada_add_exceptions_from_frame (preg, get_selected_frame (NULL),
13322 &result);
13323 if (result.size () > prev_len)
13324 sort_remove_dups_ada_exceptions_list (&result, prev_len);
13325 }
13326
13327 /* Add all exceptions whose scope is global. */
13328
13329 prev_len = result.size ();
13330 ada_add_global_exceptions (preg, &result);
13331 if (result.size () > prev_len)
13332 sort_remove_dups_ada_exceptions_list (&result, prev_len);
13333
13334 return result;
13335 }
13336
13337 /* Return a vector of ada_exc_info.
13338
13339 If REGEXP is NULL, all exceptions are included in the result.
13340 Otherwise, it should contain a valid regular expression,
13341 and only the exceptions whose names match that regular expression
13342 are included in the result.
13343
13344 The exceptions are sorted in the following order:
13345 - Standard exceptions (defined by the Ada language), in
13346 alphabetical order;
13347 - Exceptions only visible from the current frame, in
13348 alphabetical order;
13349 - Exceptions whose scope is global, in alphabetical order. */
13350
13351 std::vector<ada_exc_info>
13352 ada_exceptions_list (const char *regexp)
13353 {
13354 if (regexp == NULL)
13355 return ada_exceptions_list_1 (NULL);
13356
13357 compiled_regex reg (regexp, REG_NOSUB, _("invalid regular expression"));
13358 return ada_exceptions_list_1 (&reg);
13359 }
13360
13361 /* Implement the "info exceptions" command. */
13362
13363 static void
13364 info_exceptions_command (const char *regexp, int from_tty)
13365 {
13366 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
13367
13368 std::vector<ada_exc_info> exceptions = ada_exceptions_list (regexp);
13369
13370 if (regexp != NULL)
13371 printf_filtered
13372 (_("All Ada exceptions matching regular expression \"%s\":\n"), regexp);
13373 else
13374 printf_filtered (_("All defined Ada exceptions:\n"));
13375
13376 for (const ada_exc_info &info : exceptions)
13377 printf_filtered ("%s: %s\n", info.name, paddress (gdbarch, info.addr));
13378 }
13379
13380 /* Operators */
13381 /* Information about operators given special treatment in functions
13382 below. */
13383 /* Format: OP_DEFN (<operator>, <operator length>, <# args>, <binop>). */
13384
13385 #define ADA_OPERATORS \
13386 OP_DEFN (OP_VAR_VALUE, 4, 0, 0) \
13387 OP_DEFN (BINOP_IN_BOUNDS, 3, 2, 0) \
13388 OP_DEFN (TERNOP_IN_RANGE, 1, 3, 0) \
13389 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_FIRST, 1, 2, 0) \
13390 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_LAST, 1, 2, 0) \
13391 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_LENGTH, 1, 2, 0) \
13392 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_IMAGE, 1, 2, 0) \
13393 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_MAX, 1, 3, 0) \
13394 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_MIN, 1, 3, 0) \
13395 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_MODULUS, 1, 1, 0) \
13396 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_POS, 1, 2, 0) \
13397 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_SIZE, 1, 1, 0) \
13398 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_TAG, 1, 1, 0) \
13399 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_VAL, 1, 2, 0) \
13400 OP_DEFN (UNOP_QUAL, 3, 1, 0) \
13401 OP_DEFN (UNOP_IN_RANGE, 3, 1, 0) \
13402 OP_DEFN (OP_OTHERS, 1, 1, 0) \
13403 OP_DEFN (OP_POSITIONAL, 3, 1, 0) \
13404 OP_DEFN (OP_DISCRETE_RANGE, 1, 2, 0)
13405
13406 static void
13407 ada_operator_length (const struct expression *exp, int pc, int *oplenp,
13408 int *argsp)
13409 {
13410 switch (exp->elts[pc - 1].opcode)
13411 {
13412 default:
13413 operator_length_standard (exp, pc, oplenp, argsp);
13414 break;
13415
13416 #define OP_DEFN(op, len, args, binop) \
13417 case op: *oplenp = len; *argsp = args; break;
13418 ADA_OPERATORS;
13419 #undef OP_DEFN
13420
13421 case OP_AGGREGATE:
13422 *oplenp = 3;
13423 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc - 2].longconst);
13424 break;
13425
13426 case OP_CHOICES:
13427 *oplenp = 3;
13428 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc - 2].longconst) + 1;
13429 break;
13430 }
13431 }
13432
13433 /* Implementation of the exp_descriptor method operator_check. */
13434
13435 static int
13436 ada_operator_check (struct expression *exp, int pos,
13437 int (*objfile_func) (struct objfile *objfile, void *data),
13438 void *data)
13439 {
13440 const union exp_element *const elts = exp->elts;
13441 struct type *type = NULL;
13442
13443 switch (elts[pos].opcode)
13444 {
13445 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
13446 case UNOP_QUAL:
13447 type = elts[pos + 1].type;
13448 break;
13449
13450 default:
13451 return operator_check_standard (exp, pos, objfile_func, data);
13452 }
13453
13454 /* Invoke callbacks for TYPE and OBJFILE if they were set as non-NULL. */
13455
13456 if (type && TYPE_OBJFILE (type)
13457 && (*objfile_func) (TYPE_OBJFILE (type), data))
13458 return 1;
13459
13460 return 0;
13461 }
13462
13463 static const char *
13464 ada_op_name (enum exp_opcode opcode)
13465 {
13466 switch (opcode)
13467 {
13468 default:
13469 return op_name_standard (opcode);
13470
13471 #define OP_DEFN(op, len, args, binop) case op: return #op;
13472 ADA_OPERATORS;
13473 #undef OP_DEFN
13474
13475 case OP_AGGREGATE:
13476 return "OP_AGGREGATE";
13477 case OP_CHOICES:
13478 return "OP_CHOICES";
13479 case OP_NAME:
13480 return "OP_NAME";
13481 }
13482 }
13483
13484 /* As for operator_length, but assumes PC is pointing at the first
13485 element of the operator, and gives meaningful results only for the
13486 Ada-specific operators, returning 0 for *OPLENP and *ARGSP otherwise. */
13487
13488 static void
13489 ada_forward_operator_length (struct expression *exp, int pc,
13490 int *oplenp, int *argsp)
13491 {
13492 switch (exp->elts[pc].opcode)
13493 {
13494 default:
13495 *oplenp = *argsp = 0;
13496 break;
13497
13498 #define OP_DEFN(op, len, args, binop) \
13499 case op: *oplenp = len; *argsp = args; break;
13500 ADA_OPERATORS;
13501 #undef OP_DEFN
13502
13503 case OP_AGGREGATE:
13504 *oplenp = 3;
13505 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
13506 break;
13507
13508 case OP_CHOICES:
13509 *oplenp = 3;
13510 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst) + 1;
13511 break;
13512
13513 case OP_STRING:
13514 case OP_NAME:
13515 {
13516 int len = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
13517
13518 *oplenp = 4 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (len + 1);
13519 *argsp = 0;
13520 break;
13521 }
13522 }
13523 }
13524
13525 static int
13526 ada_dump_subexp_body (struct expression *exp, struct ui_file *stream, int elt)
13527 {
13528 enum exp_opcode op = exp->elts[elt].opcode;
13529 int oplen, nargs;
13530 int pc = elt;
13531 int i;
13532
13533 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, elt, &oplen, &nargs);
13534
13535 switch (op)
13536 {
13537 /* Ada attributes ('Foo). */
13538 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
13539 case OP_ATR_LAST:
13540 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
13541 case OP_ATR_IMAGE:
13542 case OP_ATR_MAX:
13543 case OP_ATR_MIN:
13544 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
13545 case OP_ATR_POS:
13546 case OP_ATR_SIZE:
13547 case OP_ATR_TAG:
13548 case OP_ATR_VAL:
13549 break;
13550
13551 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
13552 case UNOP_QUAL:
13553 /* XXX: gdb_sprint_host_address, type_sprint */
13554 fprintf_filtered (stream, _("Type @"));
13555 gdb_print_host_address (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, stream);
13556 fprintf_filtered (stream, " (");
13557 type_print (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, NULL, stream, 0);
13558 fprintf_filtered (stream, ")");
13559 break;
13560 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
13561 fprintf_filtered (stream, " (%d)",
13562 longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 2].longconst));
13563 break;
13564 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
13565 break;
13566
13567 case OP_AGGREGATE:
13568 case OP_OTHERS:
13569 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
13570 case OP_POSITIONAL:
13571 case OP_CHOICES:
13572 break;
13573
13574 case OP_NAME:
13575 case OP_STRING:
13576 {
13577 char *name = &exp->elts[elt + 2].string;
13578 int len = longest_to_int (exp->elts[elt + 1].longconst);
13579
13580 fprintf_filtered (stream, "Text: `%.*s'", len, name);
13581 break;
13582 }
13583
13584 default:
13585 return dump_subexp_body_standard (exp, stream, elt);
13586 }
13587
13588 elt += oplen;
13589 for (i = 0; i < nargs; i += 1)
13590 elt = dump_subexp (exp, stream, elt);
13591
13592 return elt;
13593 }
13594
13595 /* The Ada extension of print_subexp (q.v.). */
13596
13597 static void
13598 ada_print_subexp (struct expression *exp, int *pos,
13599 struct ui_file *stream, enum precedence prec)
13600 {
13601 int oplen, nargs, i;
13602 int pc = *pos;
13603 enum exp_opcode op = exp->elts[pc].opcode;
13604
13605 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, pc, &oplen, &nargs);
13606
13607 *pos += oplen;
13608 switch (op)
13609 {
13610 default:
13611 *pos -= oplen;
13612 print_subexp_standard (exp, pos, stream, prec);
13613 return;
13614
13615 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
13616 fputs_filtered (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol->natural_name (), stream);
13617 return;
13618
13619 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
13620 /* XXX: sprint_subexp */
13621 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13622 fputs_filtered (" in ", stream);
13623 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13624 fputs_filtered ("'range", stream);
13625 if (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst > 1)
13626 fprintf_filtered (stream, "(%ld)",
13627 (long) exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
13628 return;
13629
13630 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
13631 if (prec >= PREC_EQUAL)
13632 fputs_filtered ("(", stream);
13633 /* XXX: sprint_subexp */
13634 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13635 fputs_filtered (" in ", stream);
13636 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_EQUAL);
13637 fputs_filtered (" .. ", stream);
13638 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_EQUAL);
13639 if (prec >= PREC_EQUAL)
13640 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
13641 return;
13642
13643 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
13644 case OP_ATR_LAST:
13645 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
13646 case OP_ATR_IMAGE:
13647 case OP_ATR_MAX:
13648 case OP_ATR_MIN:
13649 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
13650 case OP_ATR_POS:
13651 case OP_ATR_SIZE:
13652 case OP_ATR_TAG:
13653 case OP_ATR_VAL:
13654 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_TYPE)
13655 {
13656 if (exp->elts[*pos + 1].type->code () != TYPE_CODE_VOID)
13657 LA_PRINT_TYPE (exp->elts[*pos + 1].type, "", stream, 0, 0,
13658 &type_print_raw_options);
13659 *pos += 3;
13660 }
13661 else
13662 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13663 fprintf_filtered (stream, "'%s", ada_attribute_name (op));
13664 if (nargs > 1)
13665 {
13666 int tem;
13667
13668 for (tem = 1; tem < nargs; tem += 1)
13669 {
13670 fputs_filtered ((tem == 1) ? " (" : ", ", stream);
13671 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_ABOVE_COMMA);
13672 }
13673 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
13674 }
13675 return;
13676
13677 case UNOP_QUAL:
13678 type_print (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, "", stream, 0);
13679 fputs_filtered ("'(", stream);
13680 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_PREFIX);
13681 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
13682 return;
13683
13684 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
13685 /* XXX: sprint_subexp */
13686 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13687 fputs_filtered (" in ", stream);
13688 LA_PRINT_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, "", stream, 1, 0,
13689 &type_print_raw_options);
13690 return;
13691
13692 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
13693 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13694 fputs_filtered ("..", stream);
13695 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13696 return;
13697
13698 case OP_OTHERS:
13699 fputs_filtered ("others => ", stream);
13700 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13701 return;
13702
13703 case OP_CHOICES:
13704 for (i = 0; i < nargs-1; i += 1)
13705 {
13706 if (i > 0)
13707 fputs_filtered ("|", stream);
13708 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13709 }
13710 fputs_filtered (" => ", stream);
13711 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13712 return;
13713
13714 case OP_POSITIONAL:
13715 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13716 return;
13717
13718 case OP_AGGREGATE:
13719 fputs_filtered ("(", stream);
13720 for (i = 0; i < nargs; i += 1)
13721 {
13722 if (i > 0)
13723 fputs_filtered (", ", stream);
13724 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13725 }
13726 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
13727 return;
13728 }
13729 }
13730
13731 /* Table mapping opcodes into strings for printing operators
13732 and precedences of the operators. */
13733
13734 static const struct op_print ada_op_print_tab[] = {
13735 {":=", BINOP_ASSIGN, PREC_ASSIGN, 1},
13736 {"or else", BINOP_LOGICAL_OR, PREC_LOGICAL_OR, 0},
13737 {"and then", BINOP_LOGICAL_AND, PREC_LOGICAL_AND, 0},
13738 {"or", BINOP_BITWISE_IOR, PREC_BITWISE_IOR, 0},
13739 {"xor", BINOP_BITWISE_XOR, PREC_BITWISE_XOR, 0},
13740 {"and", BINOP_BITWISE_AND, PREC_BITWISE_AND, 0},
13741 {"=", BINOP_EQUAL, PREC_EQUAL, 0},
13742 {"/=", BINOP_NOTEQUAL, PREC_EQUAL, 0},
13743 {"<=", BINOP_LEQ, PREC_ORDER, 0},
13744 {">=", BINOP_GEQ, PREC_ORDER, 0},
13745 {">", BINOP_GTR, PREC_ORDER, 0},
13746 {"<", BINOP_LESS, PREC_ORDER, 0},
13747 {">>", BINOP_RSH, PREC_SHIFT, 0},
13748 {"<<", BINOP_LSH, PREC_SHIFT, 0},
13749 {"+", BINOP_ADD, PREC_ADD, 0},
13750 {"-", BINOP_SUB, PREC_ADD, 0},
13751 {"&", BINOP_CONCAT, PREC_ADD, 0},
13752 {"*", BINOP_MUL, PREC_MUL, 0},
13753 {"/", BINOP_DIV, PREC_MUL, 0},
13754 {"rem", BINOP_REM, PREC_MUL, 0},
13755 {"mod", BINOP_MOD, PREC_MUL, 0},
13756 {"**", BINOP_EXP, PREC_REPEAT, 0},
13757 {"@", BINOP_REPEAT, PREC_REPEAT, 0},
13758 {"-", UNOP_NEG, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
13759 {"+", UNOP_PLUS, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
13760 {"not ", UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
13761 {"not ", UNOP_COMPLEMENT, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
13762 {"abs ", UNOP_ABS, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
13763 {".all", UNOP_IND, PREC_SUFFIX, 1},
13764 {"'access", UNOP_ADDR, PREC_SUFFIX, 1},
13765 {"'size", OP_ATR_SIZE, PREC_SUFFIX, 1},
13766 {NULL, OP_NULL, PREC_SUFFIX, 0}
13767 };
13768 \f
13769 enum ada_primitive_types {
13770 ada_primitive_type_int,
13771 ada_primitive_type_long,
13772 ada_primitive_type_short,
13773 ada_primitive_type_char,
13774 ada_primitive_type_float,
13775 ada_primitive_type_double,
13776 ada_primitive_type_void,
13777 ada_primitive_type_long_long,
13778 ada_primitive_type_long_double,
13779 ada_primitive_type_natural,
13780 ada_primitive_type_positive,
13781 ada_primitive_type_system_address,
13782 ada_primitive_type_storage_offset,
13783 nr_ada_primitive_types
13784 };
13785
13786 static void
13787 ada_language_arch_info (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13788 struct language_arch_info *lai)
13789 {
13790 const struct builtin_type *builtin = builtin_type (gdbarch);
13791
13792 lai->primitive_type_vector
13793 = GDBARCH_OBSTACK_CALLOC (gdbarch, nr_ada_primitive_types + 1,
13794 struct type *);
13795
13796 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_int]
13797 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_int_bit (gdbarch),
13798 0, "integer");
13799 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_long]
13800 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_long_bit (gdbarch),
13801 0, "long_integer");
13802 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_short]
13803 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_short_bit (gdbarch),
13804 0, "short_integer");
13805 lai->string_char_type
13806 = lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_char]
13807 = arch_character_type (gdbarch, TARGET_CHAR_BIT, 0, "character");
13808 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_float]
13809 = arch_float_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_float_bit (gdbarch),
13810 "float", gdbarch_float_format (gdbarch));
13811 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_double]
13812 = arch_float_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_double_bit (gdbarch),
13813 "long_float", gdbarch_double_format (gdbarch));
13814 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_long_long]
13815 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_long_long_bit (gdbarch),
13816 0, "long_long_integer");
13817 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_long_double]
13818 = arch_float_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_long_double_bit (gdbarch),
13819 "long_long_float", gdbarch_long_double_format (gdbarch));
13820 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_natural]
13821 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_int_bit (gdbarch),
13822 0, "natural");
13823 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_positive]
13824 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_int_bit (gdbarch),
13825 0, "positive");
13826 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_void]
13827 = builtin->builtin_void;
13828
13829 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_system_address]
13830 = lookup_pointer_type (arch_type (gdbarch, TYPE_CODE_VOID, TARGET_CHAR_BIT,
13831 "void"));
13832 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_system_address]
13833 ->set_name ("system__address");
13834
13835 /* Create the equivalent of the System.Storage_Elements.Storage_Offset
13836 type. This is a signed integral type whose size is the same as
13837 the size of addresses. */
13838 {
13839 unsigned int addr_length = TYPE_LENGTH
13840 (lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_system_address]);
13841
13842 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_storage_offset]
13843 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, addr_length * HOST_CHAR_BIT, 0,
13844 "storage_offset");
13845 }
13846
13847 lai->bool_type_symbol = NULL;
13848 lai->bool_type_default = builtin->builtin_bool;
13849 }
13850 \f
13851 /* Language vector */
13852
13853 /* Not really used, but needed in the ada_language_defn. */
13854
13855 static void
13856 emit_char (int c, struct type *type, struct ui_file *stream, int quoter)
13857 {
13858 ada_emit_char (c, type, stream, quoter, 1);
13859 }
13860
13861 static int
13862 parse (struct parser_state *ps)
13863 {
13864 warnings_issued = 0;
13865 return ada_parse (ps);
13866 }
13867
13868 static const struct exp_descriptor ada_exp_descriptor = {
13869 ada_print_subexp,
13870 ada_operator_length,
13871 ada_operator_check,
13872 ada_op_name,
13873 ada_dump_subexp_body,
13874 ada_evaluate_subexp
13875 };
13876
13877 /* symbol_name_matcher_ftype adapter for wild_match. */
13878
13879 static bool
13880 do_wild_match (const char *symbol_search_name,
13881 const lookup_name_info &lookup_name,
13882 completion_match_result *comp_match_res)
13883 {
13884 return wild_match (symbol_search_name, ada_lookup_name (lookup_name));
13885 }
13886
13887 /* symbol_name_matcher_ftype adapter for full_match. */
13888
13889 static bool
13890 do_full_match (const char *symbol_search_name,
13891 const lookup_name_info &lookup_name,
13892 completion_match_result *comp_match_res)
13893 {
13894 return full_match (symbol_search_name, ada_lookup_name (lookup_name));
13895 }
13896
13897 /* symbol_name_matcher_ftype for exact (verbatim) matches. */
13898
13899 static bool
13900 do_exact_match (const char *symbol_search_name,
13901 const lookup_name_info &lookup_name,
13902 completion_match_result *comp_match_res)
13903 {
13904 return strcmp (symbol_search_name, ada_lookup_name (lookup_name)) == 0;
13905 }
13906
13907 /* Build the Ada lookup name for LOOKUP_NAME. */
13908
13909 ada_lookup_name_info::ada_lookup_name_info (const lookup_name_info &lookup_name)
13910 {
13911 gdb::string_view user_name = lookup_name.name ();
13912
13913 if (user_name[0] == '<')
13914 {
13915 if (user_name.back () == '>')
13916 m_encoded_name
13917 = user_name.substr (1, user_name.size () - 2).to_string ();
13918 else
13919 m_encoded_name
13920 = user_name.substr (1, user_name.size () - 1).to_string ();
13921 m_encoded_p = true;
13922 m_verbatim_p = true;
13923 m_wild_match_p = false;
13924 m_standard_p = false;
13925 }
13926 else
13927 {
13928 m_verbatim_p = false;
13929
13930 m_encoded_p = user_name.find ("__") != gdb::string_view::npos;
13931
13932 if (!m_encoded_p)
13933 {
13934 const char *folded = ada_fold_name (user_name);
13935 const char *encoded = ada_encode_1 (folded, false);
13936 if (encoded != NULL)
13937 m_encoded_name = encoded;
13938 else
13939 m_encoded_name = user_name.to_string ();
13940 }
13941 else
13942 m_encoded_name = user_name.to_string ();
13943
13944 /* Handle the 'package Standard' special case. See description
13945 of m_standard_p. */
13946 if (startswith (m_encoded_name.c_str (), "standard__"))
13947 {
13948 m_encoded_name = m_encoded_name.substr (sizeof ("standard__") - 1);
13949 m_standard_p = true;
13950 }
13951 else
13952 m_standard_p = false;
13953
13954 /* If the name contains a ".", then the user is entering a fully
13955 qualified entity name, and the match must not be done in wild
13956 mode. Similarly, if the user wants to complete what looks
13957 like an encoded name, the match must not be done in wild
13958 mode. Also, in the standard__ special case always do
13959 non-wild matching. */
13960 m_wild_match_p
13961 = (lookup_name.match_type () != symbol_name_match_type::FULL
13962 && !m_encoded_p
13963 && !m_standard_p
13964 && user_name.find ('.') == std::string::npos);
13965 }
13966 }
13967
13968 /* symbol_name_matcher_ftype method for Ada. This only handles
13969 completion mode. */
13970
13971 static bool
13972 ada_symbol_name_matches (const char *symbol_search_name,
13973 const lookup_name_info &lookup_name,
13974 completion_match_result *comp_match_res)
13975 {
13976 return lookup_name.ada ().matches (symbol_search_name,
13977 lookup_name.match_type (),
13978 comp_match_res);
13979 }
13980
13981 /* A name matcher that matches the symbol name exactly, with
13982 strcmp. */
13983
13984 static bool
13985 literal_symbol_name_matcher (const char *symbol_search_name,
13986 const lookup_name_info &lookup_name,
13987 completion_match_result *comp_match_res)
13988 {
13989 gdb::string_view name_view = lookup_name.name ();
13990
13991 if (lookup_name.completion_mode ()
13992 ? (strncmp (symbol_search_name, name_view.data (),
13993 name_view.size ()) == 0)
13994 : symbol_search_name == name_view)
13995 {
13996 if (comp_match_res != NULL)
13997 comp_match_res->set_match (symbol_search_name);
13998 return true;
13999 }
14000 else
14001 return false;
14002 }
14003
14004 /* Implement the "la_get_symbol_name_matcher" language_defn method for
14005 Ada. */
14006
14007 static symbol_name_matcher_ftype *
14008 ada_get_symbol_name_matcher (const lookup_name_info &lookup_name)
14009 {
14010 if (lookup_name.match_type () == symbol_name_match_type::SEARCH_NAME)
14011 return literal_symbol_name_matcher;
14012
14013 if (lookup_name.completion_mode ())
14014 return ada_symbol_name_matches;
14015 else
14016 {
14017 if (lookup_name.ada ().wild_match_p ())
14018 return do_wild_match;
14019 else if (lookup_name.ada ().verbatim_p ())
14020 return do_exact_match;
14021 else
14022 return do_full_match;
14023 }
14024 }
14025
14026 /* Implement the "la_read_var_value" language_defn method for Ada. */
14027
14028 static struct value *
14029 ada_read_var_value (struct symbol *var, const struct block *var_block,
14030 struct frame_info *frame)
14031 {
14032 /* The only case where default_read_var_value is not sufficient
14033 is when VAR is a renaming... */
14034 if (frame != nullptr)
14035 {
14036 const struct block *frame_block = get_frame_block (frame, NULL);
14037 if (frame_block != nullptr && ada_is_renaming_symbol (var))
14038 return ada_read_renaming_var_value (var, frame_block);
14039 }
14040
14041 /* This is a typical case where we expect the default_read_var_value
14042 function to work. */
14043 return default_read_var_value (var, var_block, frame);
14044 }
14045
14046 static const char *ada_extensions[] =
14047 {
14048 ".adb", ".ads", ".a", ".ada", ".dg", NULL
14049 };
14050
14051 extern const struct language_defn ada_language_defn = {
14052 "ada", /* Language name */
14053 "Ada",
14054 language_ada,
14055 range_check_off,
14056 case_sensitive_on, /* Yes, Ada is case-insensitive, but
14057 that's not quite what this means. */
14058 array_row_major,
14059 macro_expansion_no,
14060 ada_extensions,
14061 &ada_exp_descriptor,
14062 parse,
14063 resolve,
14064 ada_printchar, /* Print a character constant */
14065 ada_printstr, /* Function to print string constant */
14066 emit_char, /* Function to print single char (not used) */
14067 ada_print_type, /* Print a type using appropriate syntax */
14068 ada_print_typedef, /* Print a typedef using appropriate syntax */
14069 ada_value_print_inner, /* la_value_print_inner */
14070 ada_value_print, /* Print a top-level value */
14071 ada_read_var_value, /* la_read_var_value */
14072 NULL, /* Language specific skip_trampoline */
14073 NULL, /* name_of_this */
14074 true, /* la_store_sym_names_in_linkage_form_p */
14075 ada_lookup_symbol_nonlocal, /* Looking up non-local symbols. */
14076 basic_lookup_transparent_type, /* lookup_transparent_type */
14077 ada_la_decode, /* Language specific symbol demangler */
14078 ada_sniff_from_mangled_name,
14079 NULL, /* Language specific
14080 class_name_from_physname */
14081 ada_op_print_tab, /* expression operators for printing */
14082 0, /* c-style arrays */
14083 1, /* String lower bound */
14084 ada_get_gdb_completer_word_break_characters,
14085 ada_collect_symbol_completion_matches,
14086 ada_language_arch_info,
14087 ada_print_array_index,
14088 default_pass_by_reference,
14089 ada_watch_location_expression,
14090 ada_get_symbol_name_matcher, /* la_get_symbol_name_matcher */
14091 ada_iterate_over_symbols,
14092 default_search_name_hash,
14093 &ada_varobj_ops,
14094 NULL,
14095 NULL,
14096 ada_is_string_type,
14097 "(...)" /* la_struct_too_deep_ellipsis */
14098 };
14099
14100 /* Command-list for the "set/show ada" prefix command. */
14101 static struct cmd_list_element *set_ada_list;
14102 static struct cmd_list_element *show_ada_list;
14103
14104 static void
14105 initialize_ada_catchpoint_ops (void)
14106 {
14107 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
14108
14109 initialize_breakpoint_ops ();
14110
14111 ops = &catch_exception_breakpoint_ops;
14112 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
14113 ops->allocate_location = allocate_location_exception;
14114 ops->re_set = re_set_exception;
14115 ops->check_status = check_status_exception;
14116 ops->print_it = print_it_exception;
14117 ops->print_one = print_one_exception;
14118 ops->print_mention = print_mention_exception;
14119 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_exception;
14120
14121 ops = &catch_exception_unhandled_breakpoint_ops;
14122 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
14123 ops->allocate_location = allocate_location_exception;
14124 ops->re_set = re_set_exception;
14125 ops->check_status = check_status_exception;
14126 ops->print_it = print_it_exception;
14127 ops->print_one = print_one_exception;
14128 ops->print_mention = print_mention_exception;
14129 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_exception;
14130
14131 ops = &catch_assert_breakpoint_ops;
14132 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
14133 ops->allocate_location = allocate_location_exception;
14134 ops->re_set = re_set_exception;
14135 ops->check_status = check_status_exception;
14136 ops->print_it = print_it_exception;
14137 ops->print_one = print_one_exception;
14138 ops->print_mention = print_mention_exception;
14139 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_exception;
14140
14141 ops = &catch_handlers_breakpoint_ops;
14142 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
14143 ops->allocate_location = allocate_location_exception;
14144 ops->re_set = re_set_exception;
14145 ops->check_status = check_status_exception;
14146 ops->print_it = print_it_exception;
14147 ops->print_one = print_one_exception;
14148 ops->print_mention = print_mention_exception;
14149 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_exception;
14150 }
14151
14152 /* This module's 'new_objfile' observer. */
14153
14154 static void
14155 ada_new_objfile_observer (struct objfile *objfile)
14156 {
14157 ada_clear_symbol_cache ();
14158 }
14159
14160 /* This module's 'free_objfile' observer. */
14161
14162 static void
14163 ada_free_objfile_observer (struct objfile *objfile)
14164 {
14165 ada_clear_symbol_cache ();
14166 }
14167
14168 void _initialize_ada_language ();
14169 void
14170 _initialize_ada_language ()
14171 {
14172 initialize_ada_catchpoint_ops ();
14173
14174 add_basic_prefix_cmd ("ada", no_class,
14175 _("Prefix command for changing Ada-specific settings."),
14176 &set_ada_list, "set ada ", 0, &setlist);
14177
14178 add_show_prefix_cmd ("ada", no_class,
14179 _("Generic command for showing Ada-specific settings."),
14180 &show_ada_list, "show ada ", 0, &showlist);
14181
14182 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("trust-PAD-over-XVS", class_obscure,
14183 &trust_pad_over_xvs, _("\
14184 Enable or disable an optimization trusting PAD types over XVS types."), _("\
14185 Show whether an optimization trusting PAD types over XVS types is activated."),
14186 _("\
14187 This is related to the encoding used by the GNAT compiler. The debugger\n\
14188 should normally trust the contents of PAD types, but certain older versions\n\
14189 of GNAT have a bug that sometimes causes the information in the PAD type\n\
14190 to be incorrect. Turning this setting \"off\" allows the debugger to\n\
14191 work around this bug. It is always safe to turn this option \"off\", but\n\
14192 this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is recommended to NOT change\n\
14193 this option to \"off\" unless necessary."),
14194 NULL, NULL, &set_ada_list, &show_ada_list);
14195
14196 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("print-signatures", class_vars,
14197 &print_signatures, _("\
14198 Enable or disable the output of formal and return types for functions in the \
14199 overloads selection menu."), _("\
14200 Show whether the output of formal and return types for functions in the \
14201 overloads selection menu is activated."),
14202 NULL, NULL, NULL, &set_ada_list, &show_ada_list);
14203
14204 add_catch_command ("exception", _("\
14205 Catch Ada exceptions, when raised.\n\
14206 Usage: catch exception [ARG] [if CONDITION]\n\
14207 Without any argument, stop when any Ada exception is raised.\n\
14208 If ARG is \"unhandled\" (without the quotes), only stop when the exception\n\
14209 being raised does not have a handler (and will therefore lead to the task's\n\
14210 termination).\n\
14211 Otherwise, the catchpoint only stops when the name of the exception being\n\
14212 raised is the same as ARG.\n\
14213 CONDITION is a boolean expression that is evaluated to see whether the\n\
14214 exception should cause a stop."),
14215 catch_ada_exception_command,
14216 catch_ada_completer,
14217 CATCH_PERMANENT,
14218 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
14219
14220 add_catch_command ("handlers", _("\
14221 Catch Ada exceptions, when handled.\n\
14222 Usage: catch handlers [ARG] [if CONDITION]\n\
14223 Without any argument, stop when any Ada exception is handled.\n\
14224 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name.\n\
14225 CONDITION is a boolean expression that is evaluated to see whether the\n\
14226 exception should cause a stop."),
14227 catch_ada_handlers_command,
14228 catch_ada_completer,
14229 CATCH_PERMANENT,
14230 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
14231 add_catch_command ("assert", _("\
14232 Catch failed Ada assertions, when raised.\n\
14233 Usage: catch assert [if CONDITION]\n\
14234 CONDITION is a boolean expression that is evaluated to see whether the\n\
14235 exception should cause a stop."),
14236 catch_assert_command,
14237 NULL,
14238 CATCH_PERMANENT,
14239 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
14240
14241 varsize_limit = 65536;
14242 add_setshow_uinteger_cmd ("varsize-limit", class_support,
14243 &varsize_limit, _("\
14244 Set the maximum number of bytes allowed in a variable-size object."), _("\
14245 Show the maximum number of bytes allowed in a variable-size object."), _("\
14246 Attempts to access an object whose size is not a compile-time constant\n\
14247 and exceeds this limit will cause an error."),
14248 NULL, NULL, &setlist, &showlist);
14249
14250 add_info ("exceptions", info_exceptions_command,
14251 _("\
14252 List all Ada exception names.\n\
14253 Usage: info exceptions [REGEXP]\n\
14254 If a regular expression is passed as an argument, only those matching\n\
14255 the regular expression are listed."));
14256
14257 add_basic_prefix_cmd ("ada", class_maintenance,
14258 _("Set Ada maintenance-related variables."),
14259 &maint_set_ada_cmdlist, "maintenance set ada ",
14260 0/*allow-unknown*/, &maintenance_set_cmdlist);
14261
14262 add_show_prefix_cmd ("ada", class_maintenance,
14263 _("Show Ada maintenance-related variables."),
14264 &maint_show_ada_cmdlist, "maintenance show ada ",
14265 0/*allow-unknown*/, &maintenance_show_cmdlist);
14266
14267 add_setshow_boolean_cmd
14268 ("ignore-descriptive-types", class_maintenance,
14269 &ada_ignore_descriptive_types_p,
14270 _("Set whether descriptive types generated by GNAT should be ignored."),
14271 _("Show whether descriptive types generated by GNAT should be ignored."),
14272 _("\
14273 When enabled, the debugger will stop using the DW_AT_GNAT_descriptive_type\n\
14274 DWARF attribute."),
14275 NULL, NULL, &maint_set_ada_cmdlist, &maint_show_ada_cmdlist);
14276
14277 decoded_names_store = htab_create_alloc (256, htab_hash_string, streq_hash,
14278 NULL, xcalloc, xfree);
14279
14280 /* The ada-lang observers. */
14281 gdb::observers::new_objfile.attach (ada_new_objfile_observer);
14282 gdb::observers::free_objfile.attach (ada_free_objfile_observer);
14283 gdb::observers::inferior_exit.attach (ada_inferior_exit);
14284 }
This page took 0.405748 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.